summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorAndrew Tridgell <tridge@samba.org>2000-05-12 13:05:25 +0000
committerAndrew Tridgell <tridge@samba.org>2000-05-12 13:05:25 +0000
commitfaa3f49430775fd1bd327237f369f7b5df6fc0c6 (patch)
treeb31814c4d9d1bbbb709d7f680a6483467d3e5b42
parent3fed01f9c311bb81ce3013453a5dc9630201ccf1 (diff)
downloadsamba-faa3f49430775fd1bd327237f369f7b5df6fc0c6.tar.gz
samba-faa3f49430775fd1bd327237f369f7b5df6fc0c6.tar.xz
samba-faa3f49430775fd1bd327237f369f7b5df6fc0c6.zip
- added example config section to winbindd man page
- reran yodldocs with newer version of yodl
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.html93
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html60
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/make_smbcodepage.1.html98
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html145
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html116
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html78
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html5040
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html428
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html243
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html116
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html163
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbrun.1.html56
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html74
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html112
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html108
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html80
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html66
-rw-r--r--docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html126
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/lmhosts.54
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/make_smbcodepage.16
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/nmbd.814
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/nmblookup.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/samba.710
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smb.conf.5100
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbclient.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbd.818
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbpasswd.58
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbpasswd.815
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbrun.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbstatus.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/smbtar.18
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/swat.88
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/testparm.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/testprns.14
-rw-r--r--docs/manpages/winbindd.8162
-rw-r--r--docs/textdocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.txt8
-rw-r--r--docs/yodldocs/winbindd.8.yo122
37 files changed, 4010 insertions, 3699 deletions
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.html b/docs/htmldocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.html
index 409534c99ef..847c6c51891 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.0</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,79 +16,79 @@
<h2>Jeremy Allison, Samba Team</h2>
<h2>7th October 1999</h2>
-
+<h1>Table of Contents </h1><p></p>
<p><hr><p><br>
-<p><br><center>Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.0 </center>
+<p><center>Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.0 </center>
<center>----------------------------------- </center>
-<p><br>In order for a Samba-2 server to join an NT domain, you must first add
+<p>In order for a Samba-2 server to join an NT domain, you must first add
the NetBIOS name of the Samba server to the NT domain on the PDC using
Server Manager for Domains. This creates the machine account in the
domain (PDC) SAM. Note that you should add the Samba server as a "Windows
NT Workstation or Server", <em>NOT</em> as a Primary or backup domain controller.
-<p><br>Assume you have a Samba-2 server with a NetBIOS name of <code>SERV1</code> and are
+<p>Assume you have a Samba-2 server with a NetBIOS name of <code>SERV1</code> and are
joining an NT domain called <code>DOM</code>, which has a PDC with a NetBIOS name
of <code>DOMPDC</code> and two backup domain controllers with NetBIOS names <code>DOMBDC1</code>
and <code>DOMBDC2</code>.
-<p><br>In order to join the domain, first stop all Samba daemons and run the
+<p>In order to join the domain, first stop all Samba daemons and run the
command
-<p><br><code>smbpasswd -j DOM -r DOMPDC</code>
-<p><br>as we are joining the domain DOM and the PDC for that domain (the only
-machine that has write access to the domain SAM database). If this is
+<p><code>smbpasswd -j DOM -r DOMPDC</code>
+<p>as we are joining the domain DOM and the PDC for that domain (the only
+machine that has write access to the domain SAM database) is DOMPDC. If this is
successful you will see the message:
-<p><br><code>smbpasswd: Joined domain DOM.</code>
-<p><br>in your terminal window. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a>
+<p><code>smbpasswd: Joined domain DOM.</code>
+<p>in your terminal window. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a>
man page for more details.
-<p><br>This command goes through the machine account password change
+<p>This command goes through the machine account password change
protocol, then writes the new (random) machine account password for
-this Samba server into the a file in the same directory in which an
-smbpasswd file would be stored (normally :
-<p><br><code>/usr/local/samba/private</code>
-<p><br>The filename looks like this:
-<p><br><code>&lt;NT DOMAIN NAME&gt;.&lt;Samba Server Name&gt;.mac</code>
-<p><br>The <code>.mac</code> suffix stands for machine account password file. So in
+this Samba server into a file in the same directory in which an
+smbpasswd file would be stored - normally :
+<p><code>/usr/local/samba/private</code>
+<p>The filename looks like this:
+<p><code>&lt;NT DOMAIN NAME&gt;.&lt;Samba Server Name&gt;.mac</code>
+<p>The <code>.mac</code> suffix stands for machine account password file. So in
our example above, the file would be called:
-<p><br><code>DOM.SERV1.mac</code>
-<p><br>This file is created and owned by root and is not readable by any
+<p><code>DOM.SERV1.mac</code>
+<p>This file is created and owned by root and is not readable by any
other user. It is the key to the domain-level security for your
system, and should be treated as carefully as a shadow password file.
-<p><br>Now, before restarting the Samba daemons you must edit your
+<p>Now, before restarting the Samba daemons you must edit your
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file to tell Samba it should now
use domain security.
-<p><br>Change (or add) your
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security ="</strong></a>
-<p><br>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section of your
+<p>Change (or add) your
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security ="</strong></a>
+<p>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section of your
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> to read:
-<p><br><code>security = domain</code>
-<p><br>Next change the
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>"workgroup ="</strong></a>
-<p><br>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section to read:
-<p><br><code>workgroup = DOM</code>
-<p><br>as this is the name of the domain we are joining.
-<p><br>You must also have the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypt passwords"</strong></a>
+<p><code>security = domain</code>
+<p>Next change the
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>"workgroup ="</strong></a>
+<p>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section to read:
+<p><code>workgroup = DOM</code>
+<p>as this is the name of the domain we are joining.
+<p>You must also have the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypt passwords"</strong></a>
set to <code>"yes"</code> in order for your users to authenticate to the
NT PDC.
-<p><br>Finally, add (or modify) a:
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server ="</strong></a>
-<p><br>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section to read:
-<p><br><code>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</code>
-<p><br>These are the primary and backup domain controllers Samba will attempt
+<p>Finally, add (or modify) a:
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server ="</strong></a>
+<p>line in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section to read:
+<p><code>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</code>
+<p>These are the primary and backup domain controllers Samba will attempt
to contact in order to authenticate users. Samba will try to contact
each of these servers in order, so you may want to rearrange this list
in order to spread out the authentication load among domain
controllers.
-<p><br>Alternatively, if you want smbd to automatically determine the
+<p>Alternatively, if you want smbd to automatically determine the
list of Domain controllers to use for authentication, you may set this line to be :
-<p><br><code>password server = *</code>
-<p><br>This method, which is new in Samba 2.0.6 and above, allows Samba
+<p><code>password server = *</code>
+<p>This method, which is new in Samba 2.0.6 and above, allows Samba
to use exactly the same mechanism that NT does. This method either broadcasts or
uses a WINS database in order to find domain controllers to
authenticate against.
-<p><br>Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for clients to begin
+<p>Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for clients to begin
using domain security!
-<p><br><center>Why is this better than security = server? </center>
+<p><center>Why is this better than security = server? </center>
<center>------------------------------------------ </center>
-<p><br>Currently, domain security in Samba doesn't free you from having to
+<p>Currently, domain security in Samba doesn't free you from having to
create local Unix users to represent the users attaching to your
server. This means that if domain user <code>DOM\fred</code> attaches to your
domain security Samba server, there needs to be a local Unix user fred
@@ -95,14 +96,14 @@ to represent that user in the Unix filesystem. This is very similar to
the older Samba security mode <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a>, where Samba would pass
through the authentication request to a Windows NT server in the same
way as a Windows 95 or Windows 98 server would.
-<p><br>The advantage to domain-level security is that the authentication in
+<p>The advantage to domain-level security is that the authentication in
domain-level security is passed down the authenticated RPC channel in
exactly the same way that an NT server would do it. This means Samba
servers now participate in domain trust relationships in exactly the
same way NT servers do (i.e., you can add Samba servers into a
resource domain and have the authentication passed on from a resource
domain PDC to an account domain PDC.
-<p><br>In addition, with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> every Samba daemon on a
+<p>In addition, with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> every Samba daemon on a
server has to keep a connection open to the authenticating server for
as long as that daemon lasts. This can drain the connection resources
on a Microsoft NT server and cause it to run out of available
@@ -110,7 +111,7 @@ connections. With <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"securit
daemons connect to the PDC/BDC only for as long as is necessary to
authenticate the user, and then drop the connection, thus conserving
PDC connection resources.
-<p><br>And finally, acting in the same manner as an NT server authenticating
+<p>And finally, acting in the same manner as an NT server authenticating
to a PDC means that as part of the authentication reply, the Samba
server gets the user identification information such as the user SID,
the list of NT groups the user belongs to, etc. All this information
@@ -120,7 +121,7 @@ users will be necessary, and Samba will generate Unix uids and gids
from the information passed back from the PDC when a user is
authenticated, making a Samba server truly plug and play in an NT
domain environment. Watch for this code soon.
-<p><br><em>NOTE:</em> Much of the text of this document was first published in the
+<p><em>NOTE:</em> Much of the text of this document was first published in the
Web magazine <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com"><strong>"LinuxWorld"</strong></a> as the article <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html"><strong>"Doing the NIS/NT Samba"</strong></a>.
</body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
index ece68eb5114..af88b4aded0 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>lmhosts (5)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,79 +16,78 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
lmhosts - The Samba NetBIOS hosts file
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br>lmhosts is the <strong>Samba</strong> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p>lmhosts is the <strong>Samba</strong> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This file is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>lmhosts</strong> is the <strong>Samba</strong> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
+<p>This file is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>lmhosts</strong> is the <strong>Samba</strong> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
is very similar to the <strong>/etc/hosts</strong> file format, except that the
hostname component must correspond to the NetBIOS naming format.
-<p><br><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
+<p><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
<h2>FILE FORMAT</h2>
-<p><br>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name. The two
+<p>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name. The two
fields on each line are separated from each other by white space. Any
entry beginning with # is ignored. Each line in the lmhosts file
contains the following information :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>IP Address</strong> - in dotted decimal format.
-<p><br><li > <strong>NetBIOS Name</strong> - This name format is a maximum fifteen
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>IP Address</strong> - in dotted decimal format.
+<p><li > <strong>NetBIOS Name</strong> - This name format is a maximum fifteen
character host name, with an optional trailing <code>'#'</code> character
followed by the NetBIOS name type as two hexadecimal digits.
-<p><br>If the trailing <code>'#'</code> is omitted then the given IP address will be
+<p>If the trailing <code>'#'</code> is omitted then the given IP address will be
returned for all names that match the given name, whatever the NetBIOS
name type in the lookup.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>An example follows :
-<p><br># <br>
+<p></dl>
+<p>An example follows :
+<p># <br>
# Sample Samba lmhosts file. <br>
# <br>
192.9.200.1 TESTPC <br>
192.9.200.20 NTSERVER#20 <br>
192.9.200.21 SAMBASERVER <br>
-<p><br>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first and third will
+<p>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first and third will
be returned for any queries for the names <code>"TESTPC"</code> and
<code>"SAMBASERVER"</code> respectively, whatever the type component of the
NetBIOS name requested.
-<p><br>The second mapping will be returned only when the <code>"0x20"</code> name type
+<p>The second mapping will be returned only when the <code>"0x20"</code> name type
for a name <code>"NTSERVER"</code> is queried. Any other name type will not be
resolved.
-<p><br>The default location of the <strong>lmhosts</strong> file is in the same directory
+<p>The default location of the <strong>lmhosts</strong> file is in the same directory
as the <a href="smb.conf.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>,
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>,
<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusR"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>,
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusR"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/make_smbcodepage.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/make_smbcodepage.1.html
index 3fa9a1c5357..558a559f03b 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/make_smbcodepage.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/make_smbcodepage.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>make_smbcodepage (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,45 +16,44 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
make_codepage - Construct a codepage file for Samba
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> [<a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#cord">c|d</a>] <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#codepage">codepage</a> <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#inputfile">inputfile</a> <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#outputfile">outputfile</a>
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> [<a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#cord">c|d</a>] <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#codepage">codepage</a> <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#inputfile">inputfile</a> <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html#outputfile">outputfile</a>
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> compiles or de-compiles codepage files for use
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> compiles or de-compiles codepage files for use
with the internationalization features of Samba 2.0
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="cord"></a>
-<li><strong>c|d</strong> This tells <strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> if it is compiling (<strong>c</strong>) a text
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="cord"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>c|d</strong><dd> This tells <strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> if it is compiling (<strong>c</strong>) a text
format code page file to binary, or (<strong>d</strong>) de-compiling a binary codepage
file to text.
-<p><br><a name="codepage"></a>
-<li><strong>codepage</strong> This is the codepage we are processing (a number, e.g. 850).
-<p><br><a name="inputfile"></a>
-<li><strong>inputfile</strong> This is the input file to process. In the '<strong>c</strong>' case this
+<p><a name="codepage"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>codepage</strong><dd> This is the codepage we are processing (a number, e.g. 850).
+<p><a name="inputfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>inputfile</strong><dd> This is the input file to process. In the '<strong>c</strong>' case this
will be a text codepage definition file such as the ones found in the
Samba <em>source/codepages</em> directory. In the '<strong>d</strong>' case this will be the
binary format codepage definition file normally found in the
<em>lib/codepages</em> directory in the Samba install directory path.
-<p><br><a name="outputfile"></a>
-<li><strong>outputfile</strong> This is the output file to produce.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="SambaCodepageFiles"></a>
+<p><a name="outputfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>outputfile</strong><dd> This is the output file to produce.
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="SambaCodepageFiles"></a>
<h2>Samba Codepage Files</h2>
-<p><br>A text Samba codepage definition file is a description that tells
+<p>A text Samba codepage definition file is a description that tells
Samba how to map from upper to lower case for characters greater than
ascii 127 in the specified DOS code page. Note that for certain DOS
codepages (437 for example) mapping from lower to upper case may be
@@ -61,10 +61,10 @@ non-symmetrical. For example, in code page 437 lower case a acute maps to
a plain upper case A when going from lower to upper case, but
plain upper case A maps to plain lower case a when lower casing a
character.
-<p><br>A binary Samba codepage definition file is a binary representation of
+<p>A binary Samba codepage definition file is a binary representation of
the same information, including a value that specifies what codepage
this file is describing.
-<p><br>As Samba does not yet use UNICODE (current for Samba version 2.0) you
+<p>As Samba does not yet use UNICODE (current for Samba version 2.0) you
must specify the client code page that your DOS and Windows clients
are using if you wish to have case insensitivity done correctly for
your particular language. The default codepage Samba uses is 850
@@ -74,70 +74,70 @@ provided in the Samba distribution for codepages 437 (USA), 737
866 (Cyrillic), 932 (Kanji SJIS), 936 (Simplified Chinese), 949
(Hangul) and 950 (Traditional Chinese). Users are encouraged to write
text codepage definition files for their own code pages and donate
-them to <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. All codepage files in the
+them to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. All codepage files in the
Samba <em>source/codepages</em> directory are compiled and installed when a
<em>'make install'</em> command is issued there.
-<p><br>The client codepage used by the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> server is
+<p>The client codepage used by the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> server is
configured using the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code
page</strong></a> parameter in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="FILES"></a>
+<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>codepage_def.&lt;codepage&gt;</strong>
-<p><br>These are the input (text) codepage files provided in the Samba
+<p><strong>codepage_def.&lt;codepage&gt;</strong>
+<p>These are the input (text) codepage files provided in the Samba
<em>source/codepages</em> directory.
-<p><br>A text codepage definition file consists of multiple lines
+<p>A text codepage definition file consists of multiple lines
containing four fields. These fields are :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>lower</strong>: which is the (hex) lower case character mapped on this
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>lower</strong>: which is the (hex) lower case character mapped on this
line.
-<p><br><li > <strong>upper</strong>: which is the (hex) upper case character that the lower
+<p><li > <strong>upper</strong>: which is the (hex) upper case character that the lower
case character will map to.
-<p><br><li > <strong>map upper to lower</strong> which is a boolean value (put either True
+<p><li > <strong>map upper to lower</strong> which is a boolean value (put either True
or False here) which tells Samba if it is to map the given upper case
character to the given lower case character when lower casing a
filename.
-<p><br><li > <strong>map lower to upper</strong> which is a boolean value (put either True
+<p><li > <strong>map lower to upper</strong> which is a boolean value (put either True
or False here) which tells Samba if it is to map the given lower case
character to the given upper case character when upper casing a
filename.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><strong>codepage.&lt;codepage&gt;</strong> These are the output (binary) codepage files
+<p></dl>
+<p><strong>codepage.&lt;codepage&gt;</strong> These are the output (binary) codepage files
produced and placed in the Samba destination <em>lib/codepage</em>
directory.
-<p><br><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
+<p><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
<h2>INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>The location of the server and its support files is a matter for
+<p>The location of the server and its support files is a matter for
individual system administrators. The following are thus suggestions
only.
-<p><br>It is recommended that the <strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> program be installed
+<p>It is recommended that the <strong>make_smbcodepage</strong> program be installed
under the <em>/usr/local/samba</em> hierarchy, in a directory readable by
all, writeable only by root. The program itself should be executable
by all. The program should NOT be setuid or setgid!
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf(5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf(5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
index 03fd3588e26..12f8178cfa3 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>nmbd</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,30 +16,29 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
nmbd - NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS over IP
naming services to clients
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>nmbd</strong> [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusD">-D</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minuso">-o</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusV">-V</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusH">-H lmhosts file</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusl">-l log file basename</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusn">-n primary NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusp">-p port number</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusi">-i NetBIOS scope</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>nmbd</strong> [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusD">-D</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minuso">-o</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusV">-V</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusH">-H lmhosts file</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusl">-l log file basename</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusn">-n primary NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minusp">-p port number</a>] [<a href="nmbd.8.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>nmbd</strong> is a server that understands and can reply to NetBIOS over IP
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>nmbd</strong> is a server that understands and can reply to NetBIOS over IP
name service requests, like those produced by SMBD/CIFS clients such
as Windows 95/98, Windows NT and LanManager clients. It also
participates in the browsing protocols which make up the Windows
"Network Neighborhood" view.
-<p><br>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to locate an SMB/CIFS
+<p>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to locate an SMB/CIFS
server. That is, they wish to know what IP number a specified host is
using.
-<p><br>Amongst other services, <strong>nmbd</strong> will listen for such requests,
+<p>Amongst other services, <strong>nmbd</strong> will listen for such requests,
and if its own NetBIOS name is specified it will respond with the IP
number of the host it is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by
default the primary DNS name of the host it is running on, but this
@@ -46,37 +46,37 @@ can be overridden with the <strong>-n</strong> option (see <a href="nmbd.8.html#
<strong>nmbd</strong> will reply to broadcast queries for its own name(s). Additional
names for <strong>nmbd</strong> to respond on can be set via parameters in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf(5)</strong></a> configuration file.
-<p><br><strong>nmbd</strong> can also be used as a WINS (Windows Internet Name Server)
+<p><strong>nmbd</strong> can also be used as a WINS (Windows Internet Name Server)
server. What this basically means is that it will act as a WINS
database server, creating a database from name registration requests
that it receives and replying to queries from clients for these names.
-<p><br>In addition, <strong>nmbd</strong> can act as a WINS proxy, relaying broadcast queries
+<p>In addition, <strong>nmbd</strong> can act as a WINS proxy, relaying broadcast queries
from clients that do not understand how to talk the WINS protocol to a
WIN server.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusD"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-D</strong></strong> If specified, this parameter causes <strong>nmbd</strong> to operate
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minusD"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-D</strong></strong><dd> If specified, this parameter causes <strong>nmbd</strong> to operate
as a daemon. That is, it detaches itself and runs in the background,
fielding requests on the appropriate port. By default, <strong>nmbd</strong> will
NOT operate as a daemon. nmbd can also be operated from the inetd
meta-daemon, although this is not recommended.
-<p><br><a name="minusa"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong> If this parameter is specified, each new connection will
+<p><a name="minusa"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong><dd> If this parameter is specified, each new connection will
append log messages to the log file. This is the default.
-<p><br><a name="minuso"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-o</strong></strong> If this parameter is specified, the log files will be
+<p><a name="minuso"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-o</strong></strong><dd> If this parameter is specified, the log files will be
overwritten when opened. By default, the log files will be appended
to.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> Prints the help information (usage) for <strong>nmbd</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="minusV"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-V</strong></strong> Prints the version number for <strong>nmbd</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="minusH"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-H filename</strong></strong> NetBIOS lmhosts file.
-<p><br>The lmhosts file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that is
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> Prints the help information (usage) for <strong>nmbd</strong>.
+<p><a name="minusV"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-V</strong></strong><dd> Prints the version number for <strong>nmbd</strong>.
+<p><a name="minusH"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-H filename</strong></strong><dd> NetBIOS lmhosts file.
+<p>The lmhosts file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that is
loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name resolution mechanism
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a> described in
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> to resolve any
@@ -84,92 +84,85 @@ NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note that the contents of
this file are <em>NOT</em> used by <strong>nmbd</strong> to answer any name queries. Adding
a line to this file affects name NetBIOS resolution from this host
<em>ONLY</em>.
-<p><br>The default path to this file is compiled into Samba as part of the
+<p>The default path to this file is compiled into Samba as part of the
build process. Common defaults are <em>/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</em>,
<em>/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</em> or <em>/etc/lmhosts</em>. See the
<a href="lmhosts.5.html"><strong>lmhosts (5)</strong></a> man page for details on the contents of this file.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
-<p><br>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
-<p><br>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong><dd> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
+<p>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
+<p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
about the activities of the server. At level 0, only critical errors
and serious warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of information about
operations carried out.
-<p><br>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
+<p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are
designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
-<p><br>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
+<p>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
level</strong></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minusl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-l logfile</strong></strong> The <strong>-l</strong> parameter specifies a path and base
+<p><a name="minusl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-l logfile</strong></strong><dd> The <strong>-l</strong> parameter specifies a path and base
filename into which operational data from the running nmbd server will
be logged. The actual log file name is generated by appending the
extension ".nmb" to the specified base name. For example, if the name
specified was "log" then the file log.nmb would contain the debugging
data.
-<p><br>The default log file path is compiled into Samba as part of the
+<p>The default log file path is compiled into Samba as part of the
build process. Common defaults are <em>/usr/local/samba/var/log.nmb</em>,
<em>/usr/samba/var/log.nmb</em> or <em>/var/log/log.nmb</em>.
-<p><br><a name="minusn"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-n primary NetBIOS name</strong></strong> This option allows you to override
+<p><a name="minusn"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-n primary NetBIOS name</strong></strong><dd> This option allows you to override
the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical to
setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>NetBIOS name</strong></a> parameter
in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file
but will override the setting in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minusp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-p UDP port number</strong></strong> UDP port number is a positive integer value.
-<p><br>This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137) that
+<p><a name="minusp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-p UDP port number</strong></strong><dd> UDP port number is a positive integer value.
+<p>This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137) that
<strong>nmbd</strong> responds to name queries on. Don't use this option unless you are
an expert, in which case you won't need help!
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong> The default configuration file name is
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong><dd> The default configuration file name is
set at build time, typically as <em>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</em>, but
this may be changed when Samba is autoconfigured.
-<p><br>The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
+<p>The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
server. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> for more information.
-<p><br><a name="minusi"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <strong>nmbd</strong> will use
-to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the
-use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes
-are <em>very</em> rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
-system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
-communicate with.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="FILES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
-<p><br>If the server is to be run by the inetd meta-daemon, this file must
+<p><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
+<p>If the server is to be run by the inetd meta-daemon, this file must
contain suitable startup information for the meta-daemon.
-<p><br><strong>/etc/rc</strong>
-<p><br>(or whatever initialization script your system uses).
-<p><br>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to
+<p><strong>/etc/rc</strong>
+<p>(or whatever initialization script your system uses).
+<p>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to
contain an appropriate startup sequence for the server.
-<p><br><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
-<p><br>This is the default location of the
+<p><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
+<p>This is the default location of the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> server configuration
file. Other common places that systems install this file are
<em>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</em> and <em>/etc/smb.conf</em>.
-<p><br>When run as a <strong>WINS</strong> server (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>
+<p>When run as a <strong>WINS</strong> server (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>
parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> man page), <strong>nmbd</strong> will
store the WINS database in the file <code>wins.dat</code> in the <code>var/locks</code> directory
configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.
-<p><br>If <strong>nmbd</strong> is acting as a <strong>browse master</strong> (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>local master</strong></a>
+<p>If <strong>nmbd</strong> is acting as a <strong>browse master</strong> (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>local master</strong></a>
parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> man page), <strong>nmbd</strong> will
store the browsing database in the file <code>browse.dat</code> in the <code>var/locks</code> directory
configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.
-<p><br><a name="SIGNALS"></a>
+<p><a name="SIGNALS"></a>
<h2>SIGNALS</h2>
-<p><br>To shut down an <strong>nmbd</strong> process it is recommended that SIGKILL (-9)
+<p>To shut down an <strong>nmbd</strong> process it is recommended that SIGKILL (-9)
<em>NOT</em> be used, except as a last resort, as this may leave the name
database in an inconsistent state. The correct way to terminate
<strong>nmbd</strong> is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for it to die on
its own.
-<p><br><strong>nmbd</strong> will accept SIGHUP, which will cause it to dump out it's
+<p><strong>nmbd</strong> will accept SIGHUP, which will cause it to dump out it's
namelists into the file <code>namelist.debug</code> in the
<em>/usr/local/samba/var/locks</em> directory (or the <em>var/locks</em>
directory configured under wherever Samba was configured to install
@@ -179,34 +172,34 @@ by sending it a SIGUSR1 (<code>kill -USR1 &lt;nmbd-pid&gt;</code>) and lowered b
SIGUSR2 (<code>kill -USR2 &lt;nmbd-pid&gt;</code>). This is to allow transient
problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running at a normally low log
level.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
+<p><strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>,
<a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm (1)</strong></a>, <a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns
(1)</strong></a>, and the Internet RFC's <strong>rfc1001.txt</strong>,
<strong>rfc1002.txt</strong>. In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is
available as a link from the Web page :
<a href="http://samba.org/cifs/">http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
index 2c3e80c76e2..57effe149d3 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>nmblookup (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,139 +16,138 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
nmblookup - NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS names
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>nmblookup</strong> [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusM">-M</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusR">-R</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusS">-S</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusr">-r</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusA">-A</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusB">-B broadcast address</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusU">-U unicast address</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minuss">-s smb config file</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusi">-i NetBIOS scope</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusT">-T</a>] <a href="nmblookup.1.html#name">name</a>
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>nmblookup</strong> [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusM">-M</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusR">-R</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusS">-S</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusr">-r</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusA">-A</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusB">-B broadcast address</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusU">-U unicast address</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minuss">-s smb config file</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusi">-i NetBIOS scope</a>] [<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusT">-T</a>] <a href="nmblookup.1.html#name">name</a>
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>nmblookup</strong> is used to query NetBIOS names and map them to IP
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>nmblookup</strong> is used to query NetBIOS names and map them to IP
addresses in a network using NetBIOS over TCP/IP queries. The options
allow the name queries to be directed at a particular IP broadcast area
or to a particular machine. All queries are done over UDP.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusM"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-M</strong></strong> Searches for a master browser by looking up the
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minusM"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-M</strong></strong><dd> Searches for a master browser by looking up the
NetBIOS name <a href="nmblookup.1.html#name"><strong>name</strong></a> with a type of 0x1d. If <a href="nmblookup.1.html#name"><strong>name</strong></a>
is <code>"-"</code> then it does a lookup on the special name <code>__MSBROWSE__</code>.
-<p><br><a name="minusR"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-R</strong></strong> Set the recursion desired bit in the packet to do a
+<p><a name="minusR"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-R</strong></strong><dd> Set the recursion desired bit in the packet to do a
recursive lookup. This is used when sending a name query to a machine
running a WINS server and the user wishes to query the names in the
WINS server. If this bit is unset the normal (broadcast responding)
NetBIOS processing code on a machine is used instead. See rfc1001,
rfc1002 for details.
-<p><br><a name="minusS"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-S</strong></strong> Once the name query has returned an IP address then do a
+<p><a name="minusS"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-S</strong></strong><dd> Once the name query has returned an IP address then do a
node status query as well. A node status query returns the NetBIOS names
registered by a host.
-<p><br><a name="minusr"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-r</strong></strong> Try and bind to UDP port 137 to send and receive UDP
+<p><a name="minusr"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-r</strong></strong><dd> Try and bind to UDP port 137 to send and receive UDP
datagrams. The reason for this option is a bug in Windows 95 where it
ignores the source port of the requesting packet and only replies to
UDP port 137. Unfortunately, on most UNIX systems root privilage is
needed to bind to this port, and in addition, if the
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> daemon is running on this machine it also
binds to this port.
-<p><br><a name="minusA"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-A</strong></strong> Interpret &lt;name&gt; as an IP Address and do a node status
+<p><a name="minusA"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-A</strong></strong><dd> Interpret &lt;name&gt; as an IP Address and do a node status
query on this address.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> Print a help (usage) message.
-<p><br><a name="minusB"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-B broadcast address</strong></strong> Send the query to the given broadcast
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> Print a help (usage) message.
+<p><a name="minusB"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-B broadcast address</strong></strong><dd> Send the query to the given broadcast
address. Without this option the default behavior of nmblookup is to
send the query to the broadcast address of the network
interfaces as either auto-detected or defined in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a> parameter of the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minusU"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-U unicast address</strong></strong> Do a unicast query to the specified
+<p><a name="minusU"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-U unicast address</strong></strong><dd> Do a unicast query to the specified
address or host <code>"unicast address"</code>. This option (along with the
<a href="nmblookup.1.html#minusR"><strong>-R</strong></a> option) is needed to query a WINS server.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
-<p><br>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
-<p><br>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged about the
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong><dd> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
+<p>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
+<p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged about the
activities of <strong>nmblookup</strong>. At level 0, only critical errors and
serious warnings will be logged.
-<p><br>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
+<p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are
designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
-<p><br>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
+<p>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
level</strong></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s smb.conf</strong></strong> This parameter specifies the pathname to the
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s smb.conf</strong></strong><dd> This parameter specifies the pathname to the
Samba configuration file, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>.
This file controls all aspects of
the Samba setup on the machine.
-<p><br><a name="minusi"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <strong>nmblookup</strong> will use
+<p><a name="minusi"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong><dd> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <strong>nmblookup</strong> will use
to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the
use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes
are <em>very</em> rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
communicate with.
-<p><br><a name="minusT"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-T</strong></strong> This causes any IP addresses found in the lookup to be
+<p><a name="minusT"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-T</strong></strong><dd> This causes any IP addresses found in the lookup to be
looked up via a reverse DNS lookup into a DNS name, and printed out
before each <code>"IP address NetBIOS name"</code> pair that is the normal
output.
-<p><br><a name="name"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>name</strong></strong> This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending upon
+<p><a name="name"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>name</strong></strong><dd> This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending upon
the previous options this may be a NetBIOS name or IP address. If a
NetBIOS name then the different name types may be specified by
appending <code>#&lt;type&gt;</code> to the name. This name may also be <code>"*"</code>,
which will return all registered names within a broadcast area.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="EXAMPLES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="EXAMPLES"></a>
<h2>EXAMPLES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>nmblookup</strong> can be used to query a WINS server (in the same way
+<p><strong>nmblookup</strong> can be used to query a WINS server (in the same way
<strong>nslookup</strong> is used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server,
<strong>nmblookup</strong> must be called like this:
-<p><br><code>nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</code>
-<p><br>For example, running :
-<p><br><code>nmblookup -U samba.org -R IRIX#1B'</code>
-<p><br>would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain master
+<p><code>nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</code>
+<p>For example, running :
+<p><code>nmblookup -U samba.org -R IRIX#1B'</code>
+<p>would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain master
browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
+<p><a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
-<p><br></body>
+<p></body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
index f197ccfa32c..2e65ea42e2e 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html
@@ -2,9 +2,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>Samba (7)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -14,105 +15,104 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
Samba - A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
<strong>Samba</strong>
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs that implements
+<p>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs that implements
the Server Message Block(commonly abbreviated as SMB) protocol for
UNIX systems. This protocol is sometimes also referred to as the
Common Internet File System (CIFS), LanManager or NetBIOS protocol.
-<p><br><a name="COMPONENTS"></a>
+<p><a name="COMPONENTS"></a>
<h2>COMPONENTS</h2>
-<p><br>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each component is
+<p>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each component is
described in a separate manual page. It is strongly recommended that
you read the documentation that comes with Samba and the manual pages
of those components that you use. If the manual pages aren't clear
enough then please send a patch or bug report
-to <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong>
+to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p><dl>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong>
(8)</a> daemon provides the file and print services to SMB
clients, such as Windows 95/98, Windows NT, Windows for Workgroups or
LanManager. The configuration file for this daemon is described in
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong>
(8)</a> daemon provides NetBIOS nameserving and browsing
support. The configuration file for this daemon is described in
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong>
(1)</a> program implements a simple ftp-like
client. This is useful for accessing SMB shares on other compatible
servers (such as Windows NT), and can also be used to allow a UNIX box
to print to a printer attached to any SMB server (such as a PC running
Windows NT).
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm
(1)</strong></a> utility allows you to test your <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> configuration file.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> the <a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> the <a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns
(1)</strong></a> utility allows you to test the printers defined
in your printcap file.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong>
(1)</a> utility allows you list current connections to the
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a> server.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="nmblookup.1.html"><strong>nmblookup</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> the
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="nmblookup.1.html"><strong>nmblookup</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> the
<a href="nmblookup.1.html"><strong>nmblookup (1)</strong></a> utility allows NetBIOS name
queries to be made from the UNIX machine.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html"><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html"><strong>make_smbcodepage</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The
<a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html"><strong>make_smbcodepage (1)</strong></a> utility allows
you to create SMB code page definition files for your <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd
(8)</strong></a> server.
-<p><br><li><strong><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a></strong> <br> <br> The <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a></strong><dd> <br> <br> The <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd
(8)</strong></a> utility allows you to change SMB encrypted
passwords on Samba and Windows NT(tm) servers.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="AVAILABILITY"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="AVAILABILITY"></a>
<h2>AVAILABILITY</h2>
-<p><br>The Samba software suite is licensed under the GNU Public License
+<p>The Samba software suite is licensed under the GNU Public License
(GPL). A copy of that license should have come with the package in the
file COPYING. You are encouraged to distribute copies of the Samba
suite, but please obey the terms of this license.
-<p><br>The latest version of the Samba suite can be obtained via anonymous
+<p>The latest version of the Samba suite can be obtained via anonymous
ftp from samba.org in the directory pub/samba/. It is
also available on several mirror sites worldwide.
-<p><br>You may also find useful information about Samba on the newsgroup
+<p>You may also find useful information about Samba on the newsgroup
comp.protocols.smb and the Samba mailing list. Details on how to join
the mailing list are given in the README file that comes with Samba.
-<p><br>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Netscape or Mosaic) then
+<p>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Netscape or Mosaic) then
you will also find lots of useful information, including back issues
of the Samba mailing list, at
<a href="http://samba.org/samba/">http://samba.org/samba/</a>.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="CONTRIBUTIONS"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="CONTRIBUTIONS"></a>
<h2>CONTRIBUTIONS</h2>
-<p><br>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project, then I suggest you
+<p>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project, then I suggest you
join the Samba mailing list at <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. See the
Web page at
<a href="http://samba.org/listproc">http://samba.org/listproc</a>
for details on how to do this.
-<p><br>If you have patches to submit or bugs to report then you may mail them
-directly to <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Note, however, that due to
+<p>If you have patches to submit or bugs to report then you may mail them
+directly to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Note, however, that due to
the enormous popularity of this package the Samba Team may take some
time to respond to mail. We prefer patches in <em>diff -u</em> format.
-<p><br><a name="CREDITS"></a>
+<p><a name="CREDITS"></a>
<h2>CREDITS</h2>
-<p><br>Contributors to the project are now too numerous to mention here but
+<p>Contributors to the project are now too numerous to mention here but
all deserve the thanks of all Samba users. To see a full list, look at
<a href="ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/change-log">ftp://samba.org/pub/samba/alpha/change-log</a>
for the pre-CVS changes and at
@@ -120,21 +120,21 @@ for the pre-CVS changes and at
for the contributors to Samba post-CVS. CVS is the Open Source source
code control system used by the Samba Team to develop Samba. The
project would have been unmanageable without it.
-<p><br>In addition, several commercial organizations now help fund the Samba
+<p>In addition, several commercial organizations now help fund the Samba
Team with money and equipment. For details see the Samba Web pages at
<a href="http://samba.org/samba/samba-thanks.html">http://samba.org/samba/samba-thanks.html</a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
</body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
index adda876afdf..d01333bf048 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html
@@ -3,6 +3,7 @@
+
<html><head><title>smb.conf (5)</title>
<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
@@ -15,81 +16,80 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smb.conf - The configuration file for the Samba suite
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smb.conf</strong> The <strong>smb.conf</strong> file is a configuration file for the
+<p><strong>smb.conf</strong> The <strong>smb.conf</strong> file is a configuration file for the
Samba suite. <strong>smb.conf</strong> contains runtime configuration information
for the Samba programs. The <strong>smb.conf</strong> file is designed to be
configured and administered by the <a href="swat.8.html"><strong>swat (8)</strong></a>
program. The complete description of the file format and possible
parameters held within are here for reference purposes.
-<p><br><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
+<p><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
<h2>FILE FORMAT</h2>
-<p><br>The file consists of sections and parameters. A section begins with
+<p>The file consists of sections and parameters. A section begins with
the name of the section in square brackets and continues until the
next section begins. Sections contain parameters of the form
-<p><br><code>'name = value'</code>
-<p><br>The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated line
+<p><code>'name = value'</code>
+<p>The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated line
represents either a comment, a section name or a parameter.
-<p><br>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.
-<p><br>Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant. Whitespace
+<p>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.
+<p>Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant. Whitespace
before or after the first equals sign is discarded. Leading, trailing
and internal whitespace in section and parameter names is
irrelevant. Leading and trailing whitespace in a parameter value is
discarded. Internal whitespace within a parameter value is retained
verbatim.
-<p><br>Any line beginning with a semicolon (';') or a hash ('#') character is
+<p>Any line beginning with a semicolon (';') or a hash ('#') character is
ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.
-<p><br>Any line ending in a <code>'\'</code> is "continued" on the next line in the
+<p>Any line ending in a <code>'\'</code> is "continued" on the next line in the
customary UNIX fashion.
-<p><br>The values following the equals sign in parameters are all either a
+<p>The values following the equals sign in parameters are all either a
string (no quotes needed) or a boolean, which may be given as yes/no,
0/1 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean values, but is
preserved in string values. Some items such as create modes are
numeric.
-<p><br><a name="SECTIONDESCRIPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="SECTIONDESCRIPTIONS"></a>
<h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br>Each section in the configuration file (except for the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section) describes a shared resource (known
+<p>Each section in the configuration file (except for the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section) describes a shared resource (known
as a <em>"share"</em>). The section name is the name of the shared resource
and the parameters within the section define the shares attributes.
-<p><br>There are three special sections, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a>, which are
-described under <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#SPECIALSECTIONS"><strong>'special sections'</strong></a>. The
+<p>There are three special sections, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a>, which are
+described under <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SPECIALSECTIONS"><strong>'special sections'</strong></a>. The
following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.
-<p><br>A share consists of a directory to which access is being given plus
+<p>A share consists of a directory to which access is being given plus
a description of the access rights which are granted to the user of
the service. Some housekeeping options are also specifiable.
-<p><br>Sections are either filespace services (used by the client as an
+<p>Sections are either filespace services (used by the client as an
extension of their native file systems) or printable services (used by
the client to access print services on the host running the server).
-<p><br>Sections may be designated <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest</strong></a> services, in which
+<p>Sections may be designated <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest</strong></a> services, in which
case no password is required to access them. A specified UNIX
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a> is used to define access
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a> is used to define access
privileges in this case.
-<p><br>Sections other than guest services will require a password to access
+<p>Sections other than guest services will require a password to access
them. The client provides the username. As older clients only provide
passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list of usernames to
-check against the password using the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user="</strong></a> option in
+check against the password using the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user="</strong></a> option in
the share definition. For modern clients such as Windows 95/98 and
Windows NT, this should not be necessary.
-<p><br>Note that the access rights granted by the server are masked by the
+<p>Note that the access rights granted by the server are masked by the
access rights granted to the specified or guest UNIX user by the host
system. The server does not grant more access than the host system
grants.
-<p><br>The following sample section defines a file space share. The user has
+<p>The following sample section defines a file space share. The user has
write access to the path <code>/home/bar</code>. The share is accessed via
the share name "foo":
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
[foo]
@@ -99,12 +99,12 @@ the share name "foo":
</pre>
-<p><br>The following sample section defines a printable share. The share
+<p>The following sample section defines a printable share. The share
is readonly, but printable. That is, the only write access permitted
is via calls to open, write to and close a spool file. The
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>'guest ok'</strong></a> parameter means access will be permitted
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>'guest ok'</strong></a> parameter means access will be permitted
as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
[aprinter]
path = /usr/spool/public
@@ -114,93 +114,93 @@ as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="SPECIALSECTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="SPECIALSECTIONS"></a>
<h2>SPECIAL SECTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="global"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>The [global] section</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Parameters in this section apply to the server as a whole, or are
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="global"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>The [global] section</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Parameters in this section apply to the server as a whole, or are
defaults for sections which do not specifically define certain
-items. See the notes under <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#PARAMETERS"><strong>'PARAMETERS'</strong></a> for more
+items. See the notes under <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PARAMETERS"><strong>'PARAMETERS'</strong></a> for more
information.
-<p><br><a name="homes"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>The [homes] section</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If a section called <code>'homes'</code> is included in the configuration file,
+<p><a name="homes"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>The [homes] section</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If a section called <code>'homes'</code> is included in the configuration file,
services connecting clients to their home directories can be created
on the fly by the server.
-<p><br>When the connection request is made, the existing sections are
+<p>When the connection request is made, the existing sections are
scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no match is found, the
requested section name is treated as a user name and looked up in the
local password file. If the name exists and the correct password has
been given, a share is created by cloning the [homes] section.
-<p><br>Some modifications are then made to the newly created share:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > The share name is changed from <code>'homes'</code> to the located
+<p>Some modifications are then made to the newly created share:
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > The share name is changed from <code>'homes'</code> to the located
username
-<p><br><li > If no path was given, the path is set to the user's home
+<p><li > If no path was given, the path is set to the user's home
directory.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>If you decide to use a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path=</strong></a> line in your [homes]
-section then you may find it useful to use the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p>If you decide to use a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path=</strong></a> line in your [homes]
+section then you may find it useful to use the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>
macro. For example :
-<p><br><code>path=/data/pchome/%S</code>
-<p><br>would be useful if you have different home directories for your PCs
+<p><code>path=/data/pchome/%S</code>
+<p>would be useful if you have different home directories for your PCs
than for UNIX access.
-<p><br>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number of clients access
+<p>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number of clients access
to their home directories with a minimum of fuss.
-<p><br>A similar process occurs if the requested section name is <code>"homes"</code>,
+<p>A similar process occurs if the requested section name is <code>"homes"</code>,
except that the share name is not changed to that of the requesting
user. This method of using the [homes] section works well if different
users share a client PC.
-<p><br>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters a normal service
+<p>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters a normal service
section can specify, though some make more sense than others. The
following is a typical and suitable [homes] section:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
[homes]
writeable = yes
</pre>
-<p><br>An important point is that if guest access is specified in the [homes]
+<p>An important point is that if guest access is specified in the [homes]
section, all home directories will be visible to all clients
<strong>without a password</strong>. In the very unlikely event that this is
-actually desirable, it would be wise to also specify <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read only
+actually desirable, it would be wise to also specify <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read only
access</strong></a>.
-<p><br>Note that the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a> flag for auto home
+<p>Note that the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a> flag for auto home
directories will be inherited from the global browseable flag, not the
[homes] browseable flag. This is useful as it means setting
browseable=no in the [homes] section will hide the [homes] share but
make any auto home directories visible.
-<p><br><a name="printers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>The [printers] section</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This section works like <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>, but for printers.
-<p><br>If a <strong>[printers]</strong> section occurs in the configuration file, users are
+<p><a name="printers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>The [printers] section</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This section works like <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>, but for printers.
+<p>If a <strong>[printers]</strong> section occurs in the configuration file, users are
able to connect to any printer specified in the local host's printcap
file.
-<p><br>When a connection request is made, the existing sections are
+<p>When a connection request is made, the existing sections are
scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no match is found, but a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> section exists, it is used as described
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> section exists, it is used as described
above. Otherwise, the requested section name is treated as a printer
name and the appropriate printcap file is scanned to see if the
requested section name is a valid printer share name. If a match is
found, a new printer share is created by cloning the <strong>[printers]</strong>
section.
-<p><br>A few modifications are then made to the newly created share:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > The share name is set to the located printer name
-<p><br><li > If no printer name was given, the printer name is set to the
+<p>A few modifications are then made to the newly created share:
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > The share name is set to the located printer name
+<p><li > If no printer name was given, the printer name is set to the
located printer name
-<p><br><li > If the share does not permit guest access and no username was
+<p><li > If the share does not permit guest access and no username was
given, the username is set to the located printer name.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Note that the <strong>[printers]</strong> service MUST be printable - if you specify
+<p></dl>
+<p>Note that the <strong>[printers]</strong> service MUST be printable - if you specify
otherwise, the server will refuse to load the configuration file.
-<p><br>Typically the path specified would be that of a world-writeable spool
+<p>Typically the path specified would be that of a world-writeable spool
directory with the sticky bit set on it. A typical <strong>[printers]</strong> entry
would look like this:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
[printers]
path = /usr/spool/public
@@ -209,499 +209,499 @@ would look like this:
</pre>
-<p><br>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file are legitimate
+<p>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file are legitimate
printer names as far as the server is concerned. If your printing
subsystem doesn't work like that, you will have to set up a
pseudo-printcap. This is a file consisting of one or more lines like
this:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
alias|alias|alias|alias...
</pre>
-<p><br>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for your printing
-subsystem. In the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section, specify the new
+<p>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for your printing
+subsystem. In the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section, specify the new
file as your printcap. The server will then only recognize names
found in your pseudo-printcap, which of course can contain whatever
aliases you like. The same technique could be used simply to limit
access to a subset of your local printers.
-<p><br>An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the first entry
+<p>An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the first entry
of a printcap record. Records are separated by newlines, components
(if there are more than one) are separated by vertical bar symbols
("|").
-<p><br>NOTE: On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what printers are
-defined on the system you may be able to use <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>"printcap name =
+<p>NOTE: On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what printers are
+defined on the system you may be able to use <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>"printcap name =
lpstat"</strong></a> to automatically obtain a list of
-printers. See the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>"printcap name"</strong></a> option for
+printers. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>"printcap name"</strong></a> option for
more details.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="PARAMETERS"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="PARAMETERS"></a>
<h2>PARAMETERS</h2>
-<p><br>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.
-<p><br>Some parameters are specific to the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section
-(e.g., <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>). Some parameters are usable in
-all sections (e.g., <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>create mode</strong></a>). All others are
+<p>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.
+<p>Some parameters are specific to the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section
+(e.g., <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>). Some parameters are usable in
+all sections (e.g., <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>create mode</strong></a>). All others are
permissible only in normal sections. For the purposes of the following
-descriptions the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> sections will be considered normal.
+descriptions the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> sections will be considered normal.
The letter <code>'G'</code> in parentheses indicates that a parameter is
-specific to the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section. The letter <code>'S'</code>
+specific to the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section. The letter <code>'S'</code>
indicates that a parameter can be specified in a service specific
section. Note that all <code>'S'</code> parameters can also be specified in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section - in which case they will define
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section - in which case they will define
the default behavior for all services.
-<p><br>Parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may not
+<p>Parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may not
create best bedfellows, but at least you can find them! Where there
are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer to the
preferred synonym.
-<p><br><a name="VARIABLESUBSTITUTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="VARIABLESUBSTITUTIONS"></a>
<h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2>
-<p><br>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file can take
-substitutions. For example the option <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong><code>"path =
+<p>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file can take
+substitutions. For example the option <a href="smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong><code>"path =
/tmp/%u"</code></strong></a> would be interpreted as <code>"path = /tmp/john"</code> if
the user connected with the username john.
-<p><br>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, but
+<p>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, but
there are some general substitutions which apply whenever they might
be relevant. These are:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="percentS"></a>
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="percentS"></a>
<li > <strong>%S</strong> = the name of the current service, if any.
-<p><br><a name="percentP"></a>
+<p><a name="percentP"></a>
<li > <strong>%P</strong> = the root directory of the current service, if any.
-<p><br><a name="percentu"></a>
+<p><a name="percentu"></a>
<li > <strong>%u</strong> = user name of the current service, if any.
-<p><br><a name="percentg"></a>
-<li > <strong>%g</strong> = primary group name of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="percentU"></a>
+<p><a name="percentg"></a>
+<li > <strong>%g</strong> = primary group name of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="percentU"></a>
<li > <strong>%U</strong> = session user name (the user name that
the client wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).
-<p><br><a name="percentG"></a>
-<li > <strong>%G</strong> = primary group name of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%U</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="percentH"></a>
-<li > <strong>%H</strong> = the home directory of the user given by <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="percentv"></a>
+<p><a name="percentG"></a>
+<li > <strong>%G</strong> = primary group name of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%U</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="percentH"></a>
+<li > <strong>%H</strong> = the home directory of the user given by <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="percentv"></a>
<li > <strong>%v</strong> = the Samba version.
-<p><br><a name="percenth"></a>
+<p><a name="percenth"></a>
<li > <strong>%h</strong> = the internet hostname that Samba is running on.
-<p><br><a name="percentm"></a>
+<p><a name="percentm"></a>
<li > <strong>%m</strong> = the NetBIOS name of the client machine (very useful).
-<p><br><a name="percentL"></a>
+<p><a name="percentL"></a>
<li > <strong>%L</strong> = the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you to change your
config based on what the client calls you. Your server can have a "dual
personality".
-<p><br><a name="percentM"></a>
+<p><a name="percentM"></a>
<li > <strong>%M</strong> = the internet name of the client machine.
-<p><br><a name="percentN"></a>
+<p><a name="percentN"></a>
<li > <strong>%N</strong> = the name of your NIS home directory server. This is
obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. If you have not compiled Samba
with the <strong>--with-automount</strong> option then this value will be the same
-as <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentL"><strong>%L</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="percentp"></a>
+as <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentL"><strong>%L</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="percentp"></a>
<li > <strong>%p</strong> = the path of the service's home directory, obtained from your NIS
auto.map entry. The NIS auto.map entry is split up as "%N:%p".
-<p><br><a name="percentR"></a>
+<p><a name="percentR"></a>
<li > <strong>%R</strong> = the selected protocol level after protocol
negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS, LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.
-<p><br><a name="percentd"></a>
+<p><a name="percentd"></a>
<li > <strong>%d</strong> = The process id of the current server process.
-<p><br><a name="percenta"></a>
+<p><a name="percenta"></a>
<li > <strong>%a</strong> = the architecture of the remote
machine. Only some are recognized, and those may not be 100%
reliable. It currently recognizes Samba, WfWg, WinNT and
Win95. Anything else will be known as "UNKNOWN". If it gets it wrong
then sending a level 3 log to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>
should allow it to be fixed.
-<p><br><a name="percentI"></a>
+<p><a name="percentI"></a>
<li > <strong>%I</strong> = The IP address of the client machine.
-<p><br><a name="percentT"></a>
+<p><a name="percentT"></a>
<li > <strong>%T</strong> = the current date and time.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>There are some quite creative things that can be done with these
+<p></dl>
+<p>There are some quite creative things that can be done with these
substitutions and other smb.conf options.
-<p><br><a name="NAMEMANGLING"></a>
+<p><a name="NAMEMANGLING"></a>
<h2>NAME MANGLING</h2>
-<p><br>Samba supports <em>"name mangling"</em> so that DOS and Windows clients can
+<p>Samba supports <em>"name mangling"</em> so that DOS and Windows clients can
use files that don't conform to the 8.3 format. It can also be set to
adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.
-<p><br>There are several options that control the way mangling is performed,
+<p>There are several options that control the way mangling is performed,
and they are grouped here rather than listed separately. For the
defaults look at the output of the testparm program.
-<p><br>All of these options can be set separately for each service (or
+<p>All of these options can be set separately for each service (or
globally, of course).
-<p><br>The options are:
-<p><br><a name="manglecaseoption"></a>
+<p>The options are:
+<p><a name="manglecaseoption"></a>
<strong>"mangle case = yes/no"</strong> controls if names that have characters that
aren't of the "default" case are mangled. For example, if this is yes
then a name like <code>"Mail"</code> would be mangled. Default <em>no</em>.
-<p><br><a name="casesensitiveoption"></a>
+<p><a name="casesensitiveoption"></a>
<strong>"case sensitive = yes/no"</strong> controls whether filenames are case
sensitive. If they aren't then Samba must do a filename search and
match on passed names. Default <em>no</em>.
-<p><br><a name="defaultcaseoption"></a>
+<p><a name="defaultcaseoption"></a>
<strong>"default case = upper/lower"</strong> controls what the default case is for new
filenames. Default <em>lower</em>.
-<p><br><a name="preservecaseoption"></a>
+<p><a name="preservecaseoption"></a>
<strong>"preserve case = yes/no"</strong> controls if new files are created with the
case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the <code>"default"</code>
case. Default <em>Yes</em>.
-<p><br><a name="shortpreservecaseoption"></a>
-<p><br><strong>"short preserve case = yes/no"</strong> controls if new files which conform
+<p><a name="shortpreservecaseoption"></a>
+<p><strong>"short preserve case = yes/no"</strong> controls if new files which conform
to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are
created upper case, or if they are forced to be the <code>"default"</code>
-case. This option can be use with <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preservecaseoption"><strong>"preserve case =
+case. This option can be use with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preservecaseoption"><strong>"preserve case =
yes"</strong></a> to permit long filenames to retain their
case, while short names are lowered. Default <em>Yes</em>.
-<p><br>By default, Samba 2.0 has the same semantics as a Windows NT
+<p>By default, Samba 2.0 has the same semantics as a Windows NT
server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.
-<p><br><a name="NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"></a>
+<p><a name="NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"></a>
<h2>NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</h2>
-<p><br>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect to a
+<p>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect to a
service. The server follows the following steps in determining if it
will allow a connection to a specified service. If all the steps fail
then the connection request is rejected. If one of the steps pass then
the following steps are not checked.
-<p><br>If the service is marked <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only = yes"</strong></a> then
+<p>If the service is marked <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only = yes"</strong></a> then
steps 1 to 5 are skipped.
-<p><br><ol>
-<p><br><li> Step 1: If the client has passed a username/password pair and
+<p><ol>
+<p><li> Step 1: If the client has passed a username/password pair and
that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX system's password
programs then the connection is made as that username. Note that this
includes the <code>\\server\service%username</code> method of passing a
username.
-<p><br><li> Step 2: If the client has previously registered a username with
+<p><li> Step 2: If the client has previously registered a username with
the system and now supplies a correct password for that username then
the connection is allowed.
-<p><br><li> Step 3: The client's netbios name and any previously used user
+<p><li> Step 3: The client's netbios name and any previously used user
names are checked against the supplied password, if they match then
the connection is allowed as the corresponding user.
-<p><br><li> Step 4: If the client has previously validated a
+<p><li> Step 4: If the client has previously validated a
username/password pair with the server and the client has passed the
validation token then that username is used. This step is skipped if
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#revalidate"><strong>"revalidate = yes"</strong></a> for this service.
-<p><br><li> Step 5: If a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user = "</strong></a> field is given in the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#revalidate"><strong>"revalidate = yes"</strong></a> for this service.
+<p><li> Step 5: If a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user = "</strong></a> field is given in the
smb.conf file for the service and the client has supplied a password,
and that password matches (according to the UNIX system's password
-checking) with one of the usernames from the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a>
+checking) with one of the usernames from the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a>
field then the connection is made as the username in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user="</strong></a> line. If one of the username in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a> list begins with a <code>'@'</code> then that name
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user="</strong></a> line. If one of the username in the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a> list begins with a <code>'@'</code> then that name
expands to a list of names in the group of the same name.
-<p><br><li> Step 6: If the service is a guest service then a connection is
-made as the username given in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account
+<p><li> Step 6: If the service is a guest service then a connection is
+made as the username given in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account
="</strong></a> for the service, irrespective of the supplied
password.
-<p><br></ol>
-<p><br><a name="COMPLETELISTOFGLOBALPARAMETERS"></a>
+<p></ol>
+<p><a name="COMPLETELISTOFGLOBALPARAMETERS"></a>
<h2>COMPLETE LIST OF GLOBAL PARAMETERS</h2>
-<p><br>Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of each
+<p>Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of each
parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user script</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#allowtrusteddomains"><strong>allow trusted domains</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#announceas"><strong>announce as</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#announceversion"><strong>announce version</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#autoservices"><strong>auto services</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#bindinterfacesonly"><strong>bind interfaces only</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#browselist"><strong>browse list</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#changenotifytimeout"><strong>change notify timeout</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#characterset"><strong>character set</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#codingsystem"><strong>coding system</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#configfile"><strong>config file</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#deadtime"><strong>deadtime</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debughirestimestamp"><strong>debug hires timestamp</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debugpid"><strong>debug pid</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debuguid"><strong>debug uid</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>debug level</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#default"><strong>default</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#defaultservice"><strong>default service</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#deleteuserscript"><strong>delete user script</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#dfreecommand"><strong>dfree command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#dnsproxy"><strong>dns proxy</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainadmingroup"><strong>domain admin group</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainadminusers"><strong>domain admin users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domaingroups"><strong>domain groups</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainguestgroup"><strong>domain guest group</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainguestusers"><strong>domain guest users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>domain logons</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainmaster"><strong>domain master</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>encrypt passwords</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#getwdcache"><strong>getwd cache</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homedirmap"><strong>homedir map</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsequiv"><strong>hosts equiv</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#keepalive"><strong>keepalive</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>kernel oplocks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldapfilter"><strong>ldap filter</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldapport"><strong>ldap port</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldaproot"><strong>ldap root</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldaprootpasswd"><strong>ldap root passwd</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldapserver"><strong>ldap server</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldapsuffix"><strong>ldap suffix</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>lm announce</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>lm interval</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#loadprinters"><strong>load printers</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>local master</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lockdir"><strong>lock dir</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>lock directory</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logfile"><strong>log file</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log level</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logondrive"><strong>logon drive</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logonhome"><strong>logon home</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logonpath"><strong>logon path</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logonscript"><strong>logon script</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lpqcachetime"><strong>lpq cache time</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#machinepasswordtimeout"><strong>machine password timeout</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#mangledstack"><strong>mangled stack</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>map to guest</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxdisksize"><strong>max disk size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize"><strong>max log size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxmux"><strong>max mux</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxopenfiles"><strong>max open files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxpacket"><strong>max packet</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxttl"><strong>max ttl</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxwinsttl"><strong>max wins ttl</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxxmit"><strong>max xmit</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#messagecommand"><strong>message command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minpasswdlength"><strong>min passwd length</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minpasswordlength"><strong>min password length</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minwinsttl"><strong>min wins ttl</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>netbios aliases</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>netbios name</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosscope"><strong>netbios scope</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>nis homedir</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ntaclsupport"><strong>nt acl support</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ntpipesupport"><strong>nt pipe support</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ntsmbsupport"><strong>nt smb support</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nullpasswords"><strong>null passwords</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#olelockingcompatibility"><strong>ole locking compatibility</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplockbreakwaittime"><strong>oplock break wait time</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oslevel"><strong>os level</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#packetsize"><strong>packet size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#panicaction"><strong>panic action</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>passwd chat</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>passwd chat debug</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>passwd program</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordlevel"><strong>password level</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password server</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preferedmaster"><strong>prefered master</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preferredmaster"><strong>preferred master</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preload"><strong>preload</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcap"><strong>printcap</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>printcap name</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>printer driver file</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#protocol"><strong>protocol</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readbmpx"><strong>read bmpx</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readprediction"><strong>read prediction</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readraw"><strong>read raw</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readsize"><strong>read size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#remoteannounce"><strong>remote announce</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#remotebrowsesync"><strong>remote browse sync</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#restrictanonymous"><strong>restrict anonymous</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#root"><strong>root</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootdir"><strong>root dir</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>root directory</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#serverstring"><strong>server string</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sharedmemsize"><strong>shared mem size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#smbpasswdfile"><strong>smb passwd file</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#smbrun"><strong>smbrun</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#socketaddress"><strong>socket address</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>socket options</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sourceenvironment"><strong>source environment</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ssl"><strong>ssl</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertDir"><strong>ssl CA certDir</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertFile"><strong>ssl CA certFile</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslciphers"><strong>ssl ciphers</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslclientcert"><strong>ssl client cert</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslclientkey"><strong>ssl client key</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslcompatibility"><strong>ssl compatibility</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>ssl hosts</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>ssl hosts resign</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireclientcert"><strong>ssl require clientcert</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireservercert"><strong>ssl require servercert</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslservercert"><strong>ssl server cert</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslserverkey"><strong>ssl server key</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslversion"><strong>ssl version</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#statcache"><strong>stat cache</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#statcachesize"><strong>stat cache size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#stripdot"><strong>strip dot</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#syslog"><strong>syslog</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#syslogonly"><strong>syslog only</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#templatehomedir"><strong>template homedir</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#templateshell"><strong>template shell</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#timeoffset"><strong>time offset</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#timeserver"><strong>time server</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#timestamplogs"><strong>timestamp logs</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>unix password sync</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixrealname"><strong>unix realname</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#updateencrypted"><strong>update encrypted</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#userhosts"><strong>use rhosts</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#usernamelevel"><strong>username level</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>username map</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#utmpdirectory"><strong>utmp directory</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>valid chars</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winbindcachetime"><strong>winbind cache time</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winbindgid"><strong>winbind gid</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winbinduid"><strong>winbind uid</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winshook"><strong>wins hook</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winsproxy"><strong>wins proxy</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins server</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeraw"><strong>write raw</strong></a>
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="COMPLETELISTOFSERVICEPARAMETERS"></a>
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user script</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#allowtrusteddomains"><strong>allow trusted domains</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#announceas"><strong>announce as</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#announceversion"><strong>announce version</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#autoservices"><strong>auto services</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#bindinterfacesonly"><strong>bind interfaces only</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#browselist"><strong>browse list</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#changenotifytimeout"><strong>change notify timeout</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#characterset"><strong>character set</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#codingsystem"><strong>coding system</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#configfile"><strong>config file</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#deadtime"><strong>deadtime</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debughirestimestamp"><strong>debug hires timestamp</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debugpid"><strong>debug pid</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debuguid"><strong>debug uid</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>debug level</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#default"><strong>default</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#defaultservice"><strong>default service</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#deleteuserscript"><strong>delete user script</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#dfreecommand"><strong>dfree command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#dnsproxy"><strong>dns proxy</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainadmingroup"><strong>domain admin group</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainadminusers"><strong>domain admin users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domaingroups"><strong>domain groups</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainguestgroup"><strong>domain guest group</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainguestusers"><strong>domain guest users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>domain logons</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainmaster"><strong>domain master</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>encrypt passwords</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#getwdcache"><strong>getwd cache</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homedirmap"><strong>homedir map</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsequiv"><strong>hosts equiv</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#keepalive"><strong>keepalive</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>kernel oplocks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldapfilter"><strong>ldap filter</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldapport"><strong>ldap port</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldaproot"><strong>ldap root</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldaprootpasswd"><strong>ldap root passwd</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldapserver"><strong>ldap server</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldapsuffix"><strong>ldap suffix</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>lm announce</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>lm interval</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loadprinters"><strong>load printers</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>local master</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lockdir"><strong>lock dir</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>lock directory</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logfile"><strong>log file</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log level</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logondrive"><strong>logon drive</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logonhome"><strong>logon home</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logonpath"><strong>logon path</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logonscript"><strong>logon script</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lpqcachetime"><strong>lpq cache time</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#machinepasswordtimeout"><strong>machine password timeout</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#mangledstack"><strong>mangled stack</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>map to guest</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxdisksize"><strong>max disk size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize"><strong>max log size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxmux"><strong>max mux</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxopenfiles"><strong>max open files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxpacket"><strong>max packet</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxttl"><strong>max ttl</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxwinsttl"><strong>max wins ttl</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxxmit"><strong>max xmit</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#messagecommand"><strong>message command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minpasswdlength"><strong>min passwd length</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minpasswordlength"><strong>min password length</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minwinsttl"><strong>min wins ttl</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>netbios aliases</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>netbios name</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosscope"><strong>netbios scope</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>nis homedir</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ntaclsupport"><strong>nt acl support</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ntpipesupport"><strong>nt pipe support</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ntsmbsupport"><strong>nt smb support</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nullpasswords"><strong>null passwords</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#olelockingcompatibility"><strong>ole locking compatibility</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplockbreakwaittime"><strong>oplock break wait time</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oslevel"><strong>os level</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#packetsize"><strong>packet size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#panicaction"><strong>panic action</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>passwd chat</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>passwd chat debug</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>passwd program</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordlevel"><strong>password level</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password server</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preferedmaster"><strong>prefered master</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preferredmaster"><strong>preferred master</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preload"><strong>preload</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcap"><strong>printcap</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>printcap name</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>printer driver file</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#protocol"><strong>protocol</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readbmpx"><strong>read bmpx</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readprediction"><strong>read prediction</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readraw"><strong>read raw</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readsize"><strong>read size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#remoteannounce"><strong>remote announce</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#remotebrowsesync"><strong>remote browse sync</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#restrictanonymous"><strong>restrict anonymous</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#root"><strong>root</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootdir"><strong>root dir</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>root directory</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#serverstring"><strong>server string</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sharedmemsize"><strong>shared mem size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#smbpasswdfile"><strong>smb passwd file</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#smbrun"><strong>smbrun</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketaddress"><strong>socket address</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>socket options</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sourceenvironment"><strong>source environment</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ssl"><strong>ssl</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertDir"><strong>ssl CA certDir</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertFile"><strong>ssl CA certFile</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslciphers"><strong>ssl ciphers</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslclientcert"><strong>ssl client cert</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslclientkey"><strong>ssl client key</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslcompatibility"><strong>ssl compatibility</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>ssl hosts</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>ssl hosts resign</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireclientcert"><strong>ssl require clientcert</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireservercert"><strong>ssl require servercert</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslservercert"><strong>ssl server cert</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslserverkey"><strong>ssl server key</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslversion"><strong>ssl version</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#statcache"><strong>stat cache</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#statcachesize"><strong>stat cache size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#stripdot"><strong>strip dot</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#syslog"><strong>syslog</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#syslogonly"><strong>syslog only</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#templatehomedir"><strong>template homedir</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#templateshell"><strong>template shell</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#timeoffset"><strong>time offset</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#timeserver"><strong>time server</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#timestamplogs"><strong>timestamp logs</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>unix password sync</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixrealname"><strong>unix realname</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#updateencrypted"><strong>update encrypted</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#userhosts"><strong>use rhosts</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#usernamelevel"><strong>username level</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>username map</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#utmpdirectory"><strong>utmp directory</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>valid chars</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winbindcachetime"><strong>winbind cache time</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winbindgid"><strong>winbind gid</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winbinduid"><strong>winbind uid</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winshook"><strong>wins hook</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsproxy"><strong>wins proxy</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins server</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeraw"><strong>write raw</strong></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="COMPLETELISTOFSERVICEPARAMETERS"></a>
<h2>COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</h2>
-<p><br>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section of each
+<p>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section of each
parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#adminusers"><strong>admin users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>allow hosts</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#alternatepermissions"><strong>alternate permissions</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#available"><strong>available</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#blockinglocks"><strong>blocking locks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#browsable"><strong>browsable</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>case sensitive</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesignames"><strong>casesignames</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#comment"><strong>comment</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#copy"><strong>copy</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>create mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#defaultcase"><strong>default case</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#deletereadonly"><strong>delete readonly</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#deletevetofiles"><strong>delete veto files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#denyhosts"><strong>deny hosts</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directory"><strong>directory</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>directory mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security mask</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#dontdescend"><strong>dont descend</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#dosfiletimeresolution"><strong>dos filetime resolution</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#dosfiletimes"><strong>dos filetimes</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#exec"><strong>exec</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#fakedirectorycreatetimes"><strong>fake directory create times</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#fakeoplocks"><strong>fake oplocks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#followsymlinks"><strong>follow symlinks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>force create mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>force directory mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>force group</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security mode</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>force user</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#fstype"><strong>fstype</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#group"><strong>group</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest ok</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>guest only</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hidedotfiles"><strong>hide dot files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>hide files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>hosts deny</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#include"><strong>include</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>inherit permissions</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>invalid users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>level2 oplocks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#locking"><strong>locking</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>lppause command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lpqcommand"><strong>lpq command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lpresumecommand"><strong>lpresume command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lprmcommand"><strong>lprm command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#magicoutput"><strong>magic output</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>magic script</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglecase"><strong>mangle case</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglelocks"><strong>mangle locks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#mangledmap"><strong>mangled map</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglednames"><strong>mangled names</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglingchar"><strong>mangling char</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maparchive"><strong>map archive</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maphidden"><strong>map hidden</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#mapsystem"><strong>map system</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxconnections"><strong>max connections</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minprintspace"><strong>min print space</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#onlyguest"><strong>only guest</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#onlyuser"><strong>only user</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplockcontentionlimit"><strong>oplock contention limit</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>postexec</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#postscript"><strong>postscript</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>preexec close</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preservecase"><strong>preserve case</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcommand"><strong>print command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printok"><strong>print ok</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>printable</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printer"><strong>printer</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriver"><strong>printer driver</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverlocation"><strong>printer driver location</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printername"><strong>printer name</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#public"><strong>public</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#queuepausecommand"><strong>queuepause command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#queueresumecommand"><strong>queueresume command</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readlist"><strong>read list</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read only</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#revalidate"><strong>revalidate</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootpostexec"><strong>root postexec</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexec"><strong>root preexec</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexecclose"><strong>root preexec close</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#setdirectory"><strong>set directory</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sharemodes"><strong>share modes</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#shortpreservecase"><strong>short preserve case</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#status"><strong>status</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#strictlocking"><strong>strict locking</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>strict sync</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#syncalways"><strong>sync always</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>username</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#users"><strong>users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#utmp"><strong>utmp</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>valid users</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>veto files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetooplockfiles"><strong>veto oplock files</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#volume"><strong>volume</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>wide links</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writable"><strong>writable</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writecachesize"><strong>write cache size</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writelist"><strong>write list</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeok"><strong>write ok</strong></a>
-<p><br><li > <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>writeable</strong></a>
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="EXPLANATIONOFEACHPARAMETER"></a>
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#adminusers"><strong>admin users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>allow hosts</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#alternatepermissions"><strong>alternate permissions</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#available"><strong>available</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#blockinglocks"><strong>blocking locks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#browsable"><strong>browsable</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>case sensitive</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesignames"><strong>casesignames</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#comment"><strong>comment</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#copy"><strong>copy</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>create mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#defaultcase"><strong>default case</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#deletereadonly"><strong>delete readonly</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#deletevetofiles"><strong>delete veto files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#denyhosts"><strong>deny hosts</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directory"><strong>directory</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>directory mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security mask</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#dontdescend"><strong>dont descend</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#dosfiletimeresolution"><strong>dos filetime resolution</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#dosfiletimes"><strong>dos filetimes</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#exec"><strong>exec</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#fakedirectorycreatetimes"><strong>fake directory create times</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#fakeoplocks"><strong>fake oplocks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#followsymlinks"><strong>follow symlinks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>force create mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>force directory mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>force group</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security mode</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>force user</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#fstype"><strong>fstype</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#group"><strong>group</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest ok</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>guest only</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hidedotfiles"><strong>hide dot files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>hide files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>hosts deny</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#include"><strong>include</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>inherit permissions</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>invalid users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>level2 oplocks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#locking"><strong>locking</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>lppause command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lpqcommand"><strong>lpq command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lpresumecommand"><strong>lpresume command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lprmcommand"><strong>lprm command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#magicoutput"><strong>magic output</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>magic script</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglecase"><strong>mangle case</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglelocks"><strong>mangle locks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#mangledmap"><strong>mangled map</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglednames"><strong>mangled names</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglingchar"><strong>mangling char</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maparchive"><strong>map archive</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maphidden"><strong>map hidden</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#mapsystem"><strong>map system</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxconnections"><strong>max connections</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minprintspace"><strong>min print space</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#onlyguest"><strong>only guest</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#onlyuser"><strong>only user</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplockcontentionlimit"><strong>oplock contention limit</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>postexec</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#postscript"><strong>postscript</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>preexec close</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preservecase"><strong>preserve case</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcommand"><strong>print command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printok"><strong>print ok</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>printable</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printer"><strong>printer</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriver"><strong>printer driver</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverlocation"><strong>printer driver location</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printername"><strong>printer name</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#public"><strong>public</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#queuepausecommand"><strong>queuepause command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#queueresumecommand"><strong>queueresume command</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readlist"><strong>read list</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read only</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#revalidate"><strong>revalidate</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootpostexec"><strong>root postexec</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexec"><strong>root preexec</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexecclose"><strong>root preexec close</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#setdirectory"><strong>set directory</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sharemodes"><strong>share modes</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#shortpreservecase"><strong>short preserve case</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#status"><strong>status</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#strictlocking"><strong>strict locking</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>strict sync</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#syncalways"><strong>sync always</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>username</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#users"><strong>users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#utmp"><strong>utmp</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>valid users</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>veto files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetooplockfiles"><strong>veto oplock files</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#volume"><strong>volume</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>wide links</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writable"><strong>writable</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writecachesize"><strong>write cache size</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writelist"><strong>write list</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeok"><strong>write ok</strong></a>
+<p><li > <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>writeable</strong></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="EXPLANATIONOFEACHPARAMETER"></a>
<h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="adduserscript"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>add user script (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <em>AS ROOT</em> by
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="adduserscript"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>add user script (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <em>AS ROOT</em> by
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a> under special circumstances decribed
below.
-<p><br>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are created for all
+<p>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are created for all
users accessing files on this server. For sites that use Windows NT
account databases as their primary user database creating these users
and keeping the user list in sync with the Windows NT PDC is an
onerous task. This option allows <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to create
the required UNIX users <em>ON DEMAND</em> when a user accesses the Samba
server.
-<p><br>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> must be set to
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a> and <strong>"add user script"</strong>
+<p>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> must be set to
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a> and <strong>"add user script"</strong>
must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX user
given one argument of <strong>%u</strong>, which expands into the UNIX user name to
create.
-<p><br>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, at
+<p>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, at
<em>"login"</em>(session setup in the SMB protocol) time,
-<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> contacts the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
+<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> contacts the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
server</strong></a> and attempts to authenticate the given user
with the given password. If the authentication succeeds then
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX
@@ -709,61 +709,61 @@ password database to map the Windows user into. If this lookup fails,
and <strong>"add user script"</strong> is set then <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will
call the specified script <em>AS ROOT</em>, expanding any <strong>%u</strong> argument
to be the user name to create.
-<p><br>If this script successfully creates the user then
+<p>If this script successfully creates the user then
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will continue on as though the UNIX user
already existed. In this way, UNIX users are dynamically created to
match existing Windows NT accounts.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
-server</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#deleteuserscript"><strong>delete user
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
+server</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#deleteuserscript"><strong>delete user
script</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> add user script = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> add user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/add_user %u</code>
-<p><br><a name="adminusers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>admin users (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of users who will be granted administrative privileges
+<p><a name="adminusers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>admin users (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of users who will be granted administrative privileges
on the share. This means that they will do all file operations as the
super-user (root).
-<p><br>You should use this option very carefully, as any user in this list
+<p>You should use this option very carefully, as any user in this list
will be able to do anything they like on the share, irrespective of
file permissions.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong> <br>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong> <br>
<code> no admin users</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong> <br>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong> <br>
<code> admin users = jason</code>
-<p><br><a name="allowhosts"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>allow hosts (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="allowtrusteddomains"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>allow trusted domains (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option only takes effect when the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>
+<p><a name="allowhosts"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>allow hosts (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="allowtrusteddomains"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>allow trusted domains (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option only takes effect when the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a>
option is set to <strong>server</strong> or <strong>domain</strong>. If it is set to no,
then attempts to connect to a resource from a domain or workgroup other than
the one which smbd is running in will fail, even if that domain
is trusted by the remote server doing the authentication.
-<p><br>This is useful if you only want your Samba server to serve resources
+<p>This is useful if you only want your Samba server to serve resources
to users in the domain it is a member of. As an example, suppose that there are
two domains DOMA and DOMB. DOMB is trusted by DOMA, which contains
the Samba server. Under normal circumstances, a user with an account
in DOMB can then access the resources of a UNIX account with the same
account name on the Samba server even if they do not have an account
in DOMA. This can make implementing a security boundary difficult.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> allow trusted domains = Yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> allow trusted domains = No</code>
-<p><br><a name="alternatepermissions"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>alternate permissions (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a deprecated parameter. It no longer has any effect in Samba2.0.
+<p><a name="alternatepermissions"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>alternate permissions (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a deprecated parameter. It no longer has any effect in Samba2.0.
In previous versions of Samba it affected the way the DOS "read only"
attribute was mapped for a file. In Samba2.0 a file is marked "read only"
if the UNIX file does not have the 'w' bit set for the owner of the file,
regardless if the owner of the file is the currently logged on user or not.
-<p><br><a name="announceas"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>announce as (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies what type of server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
+<p><a name="announceas"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>announce as (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies what type of server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse list. By default
this is set to Windows NT. The valid options are : "NT", which is a
synonym for "NT Server", "NT Server", "NT Workstation", "Win95" or
@@ -771,49 +771,49 @@ synonym for "NT Server", "NT Server", "NT Workstation", "Win95" or
and Windows for Workgroups respectively. Do not change this parameter
unless you have a specific need to stop Samba appearing as an NT server
as this may prevent Samba servers from participating as browser servers correctly.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> announce as = NT Server</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example</strong>
+<p><strong>Example</strong>
<code> announce as = Win95</code>
-<p><br><a name="announceversion"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>announce version (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies the major and minor version numbers that nmbd will use
+<p><a name="announceversion"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>announce version (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies the major and minor version numbers that nmbd will use
when announcing itself as a server. The default is 4.2. Do not change
this parameter unless you have a specific need to set a Samba server
to be a downlevel server.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> announce version = 4.2</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> announce version = 2.0</code>
-<p><br><a name="autoservices"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>auto services (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of services that you want to be automatically added to
+<p><a name="autoservices"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>auto services (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of services that you want to be automatically added to
the browse lists. This is most useful for homes and printers services
that would otherwise not be visible.
-<p><br>Note that if you just want all printers in your printcap file loaded
-then the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#loadprinters"><strong>"load printers"</strong></a> option is easier.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>Note that if you just want all printers in your printcap file loaded
+then the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loadprinters"><strong>"load printers"</strong></a> option is easier.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> no auto services</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> auto services = fred lp colorlp</code>
-<p><br><a name="available"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>available (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter lets you <em>'turn off'</em> a service. If <code>'available = no'</code>,
+<p><a name="available"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>available (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter lets you <em>'turn off'</em> a service. If <code>'available = no'</code>,
then <em>ALL</em> attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures
are logged.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> available = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> available = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="bindinterfacesonly"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>bind interfaces only (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This global parameter allows the Samba admin to limit what interfaces
+<p><a name="bindinterfacesonly"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>bind interfaces only (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This global parameter allows the Samba admin to limit what interfaces
on a machine will serve smb requests. If affects file service
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> and name service <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>
in slightly different ways.
-<p><br>For name service it causes <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to bind to ports
+<p>For name service it causes <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to bind to ports
137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a>
parameter. <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> also binds to the 'all
addresses' interface (0.0.0.0) on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes
of reading broadcast messages. If this option is not set then
@@ -822,376 +822,376 @@ sockets. If <strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong> is set then
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will check the source address of any
packets coming in on the broadcast sockets and discard any that don't
match the broadcast addresses of the interfaces in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter list. As unicast packets
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter list. As unicast packets
are received on the other sockets it allows <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>
to refuse to serve names to machines that send packets that arrive
through any interfaces not listed in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>"interfaces"</strong></a> list. IP Source address spoofing
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>"interfaces"</strong></a> list. IP Source address spoofing
does defeat this simple check, however so it must not be used
seriously as a security feature for <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br>For file service it causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to bind only to
-the interface list given in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a>
+<p>For file service it causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to bind only to
+the interface list given in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a>
parameter. This restricts the networks that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will serve to packets coming in those interfaces. Note that you
should not use this parameter for machines that are serving PPP or
other intermittent or non-broadcast network interfaces as it will not
cope with non-permanent interfaces.
-<p><br>If <strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong> is set then unless the network address
-<em>127.0.0.1</em> is added to the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter
+<p>If <strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong> is set then unless the network address
+<em>127.0.0.1</em> is added to the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter
list <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> and
<a href="swat.8.html"><strong>swat</strong></a> may not work as expected due to the
reasons covered below.
-<p><br>To change a users SMB password, the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a>
+<p>To change a users SMB password, the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a>
by default connects to the <em>"localhost" - 127.0.0.1</em> address as an SMB
client to issue the password change request. If <strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong>
is set then unless the network address <em>127.0.0.1</em> is added to the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter list then
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>'interfaces'</strong></a> parameter list then
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> will fail to connect in it's
default mode. <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> can be forced to
use the primary IP interface of the local host by using its
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr"><strong>"-r remote machine"</strong></a> parameter, with
<strong>"remote machine"</strong> set to the IP name of the primary interface
of the local host.
-<p><br>The <a href="swat.8.html"><strong>swat</strong></a> status page tries to connect with
+<p>The <a href="swat.8.html"><strong>swat</strong></a> status page tries to connect with
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> at the address
<em>127.0.0.1</em> to determine if they are running. Not adding <em>127.0.0.1</em> will cause
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to always show
"not running" even if they really are. This can prevent
<a href="swat.8.html"><strong>swat</strong></a> from starting/stopping/restarting
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> bind interfaces only = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> bind interfaces only = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="blockinglocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>blocking locks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> when
+<p><a name="blockinglocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>blocking locks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> when
given a request by a client to obtain a byte range lock on a region
of an open file, and the request has a time limit associated with it.
-<p><br>If this parameter is set and the lock range requested cannot be
+<p>If this parameter is set and the lock range requested cannot be
immediately satisfied, Samba 2.0 will internally queue the lock
request, and periodically attempt to obtain the lock until the
timeout period expires.
-<p><br>If this parameter is set to "False", then Samba 2.0 will behave
+<p>If this parameter is set to "False", then Samba 2.0 will behave
as previous versions of Samba would and will fail the lock
request immediately if the lock range cannot be obtained.
-<p><br>This parameter can be set per share.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>This parameter can be set per share.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> blocking locks = True</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> blocking locks = False</code>
-<p><br><a name="browsable"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>browsable (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="browselist"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>browse list(G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will serve a browse
+<p><a name="browsable"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>browsable (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#browseable"><strong>browseable</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="browselist"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>browse list(G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will serve a browse
list to a client doing a NetServerEnum call. Normally set to true. You
should never need to change this.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> browse list = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="browseable"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>browseable</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether this share is seen in the list of available
+<p><a name="browseable"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>browseable</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether this share is seen in the list of available
shares in a net view and in the browse list.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> browseable = Yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> browseable = No</code>
-<p><br><a name="casesensitive"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>case sensitive (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>See the discussion in the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>NAME MANGLING</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="casesignames"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>casesignames (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="changenotifytimeout"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>change notify timeout (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>One of the new NT SMB requests that Samba 2.0 supports is the
+<p><a name="casesensitive"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>case sensitive (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>See the discussion in the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>NAME MANGLING</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="casesignames"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>casesignames (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="changenotifytimeout"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>change notify timeout (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>One of the new NT SMB requests that Samba 2.0 supports is the
"ChangeNotify" requests. This SMB allows a client to tell a server to
<em>"watch"</em> a particular directory for any changes and only reply to
the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of
a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> daemon only performs such a scan on each
requested directory once every <strong>change notify timeout</strong> seconds.
-<p><br><strong>change notify timeout</strong> is specified in units of seconds.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>change notify timeout</strong> is specified in units of seconds.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> change notify timeout = 60</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> change notify timeout = 300</code>
-<p><br>Would change the scan time to every 5 minutes.
-<p><br><a name="characterset"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>character set (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This allows a smbd to map incoming filenames from a DOS Code page (see
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> parameter) to several
+<p>Would change the scan time to every 5 minutes.
+<p><a name="characterset"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>character set (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This allows a smbd to map incoming filenames from a DOS Code page (see
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> parameter) to several
built in UNIX character sets. The built in code page translations are:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>ISO8859-1</strong> Western European UNIX character set. The parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>ISO8859-1</strong> Western European UNIX character set. The parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
page 850 if the <strong>character set</strong> parameter is set to iso8859-1
in order for the conversion to the UNIX character set to be done
correctly.
-<p><br><li > <strong>ISO8859-2</strong> Eastern European UNIX character set. The parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
+<p><li > <strong>ISO8859-2</strong> Eastern European UNIX character set. The parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
page 852 if the <strong>character set</strong> parameter is set to ISO8859-2
in order for the conversion to the UNIX character set to be done
correctly.
-<p><br><li > <strong>ISO8859-5</strong> Russian Cyrillic UNIX character set. The parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
+<p><li > <strong>ISO8859-5</strong> Russian Cyrillic UNIX character set. The parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
page 866 if the <strong>character set</strong> parameter is set to ISO8859-5
in order for the conversion to the UNIX character set to be done
correctly.
-<p><br><li > <strong>ISO8859-7</strong> Greek UNIX character set. The parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
+<p><li > <strong>ISO8859-7</strong> Greek UNIX character set. The parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code
page 737 if the <strong>character set</strong> parameter is set to ISO8859-7
in order for the conversion to the UNIX character set to be done
correctly.
-<p><br><li > <strong>KOI8-R</strong> Alternate mapping for Russian Cyrillic UNIX
-character set. The parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code
+<p><li > <strong>KOI8-R</strong> Alternate mapping for Russian Cyrillic UNIX
+character set. The parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code
page</strong></a> <em>MUST</em> be set to code page 866 if the
<strong>character set</strong> parameter is set to KOI8-R in order for the
conversion to the UNIX character set to be done correctly.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><em>BUG</em>. These MSDOS code page to UNIX character set mappings should
+<p></dl>
+<p><em>BUG</em>. These MSDOS code page to UNIX character set mappings should
be dynamic, like the loading of MS DOS code pages, not static.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a>. Normally this
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>client code page</strong></a>. Normally this
parameter is not set, meaning no filename translation is done.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> character set = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> character set = ISO8859-1</code>
-<p><br><a name="clientcodepage"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>client code page (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the DOS code page that the clients accessing
+<p><a name="clientcodepage"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>client code page (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the DOS code page that the clients accessing
Samba are using. To determine what code page a Windows or DOS client
is using, open a DOS command prompt and type the command "chcp". This
will output the code page. The default for USA MS-DOS, Windows 95, and
Windows NT releases is code page 437. The default for western european
releases of the above operating systems is code page 850.
-<p><br>This parameter tells <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> which of the
+<p>This parameter tells <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> which of the
<code>codepage.XXX</code> files to dynamically load on startup. These files,
described more fully in the manual page <a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html"><strong>make_smbcodepage
(1)</strong></a>, tell <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> how
to map lower to upper case characters to provide the case insensitivity
of filenames that Windows clients expect.
-<p><br>Samba currently ships with the following code page files :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 437 - MS-DOS Latin US</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 737 - Windows '95 Greek</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 850 - MS-DOS Latin 1</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 852 - MS-DOS Latin 2</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 861 - MS-DOS Icelandic</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 866 - MS-DOS Cyrillic</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 932 - MS-DOS Japanese SJIS</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 936 - MS-DOS Simplified Chinese</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 949 - MS-DOS Korean Hangul</strong>
-<p><br><li > <strong>Code Page 950 - MS-DOS Traditional Chinese</strong>
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Thus this parameter may have any of the values 437, 737, 850, 852,
+<p>Samba currently ships with the following code page files :
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 437 - MS-DOS Latin US</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 737 - Windows '95 Greek</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 850 - MS-DOS Latin 1</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 852 - MS-DOS Latin 2</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 861 - MS-DOS Icelandic</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 866 - MS-DOS Cyrillic</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 932 - MS-DOS Japanese SJIS</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 936 - MS-DOS Simplified Chinese</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 949 - MS-DOS Korean Hangul</strong>
+<p><li > <strong>Code Page 950 - MS-DOS Traditional Chinese</strong>
+<p></dl>
+<p>Thus this parameter may have any of the values 437, 737, 850, 852,
861, 932, 936, 949, or 950. If you don't find the codepage you need,
read the comments in one of the other codepage files and the
<a href="make_smbcodepage.1.html"><strong>make_smbcodepage (1)</strong></a> man page and
write one. Please remember to donate it back to the Samba user
community.
-<p><br>This parameter co-operates with the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid
+<p>This parameter co-operates with the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid
chars"</strong></a> parameter in determining what characters are
valid in filenames and how capitalization is done. If you set both
-this parameter and the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> parameter
+this parameter and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> parameter
the <strong>"client code page"</strong> parameter <em>MUST</em> be set before the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> parameter in the <strong>smb.conf</strong>
-file. The <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> string will then augment
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> parameter in the <strong>smb.conf</strong>
+file. The <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a> string will then augment
the character settings in the "client code page" parameter.
-<p><br>If not set, <strong>"client code page"</strong> defaults to 850.
-<p><br>See also : <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>If not set, <strong>"client code page"</strong> defaults to 850.
+<p>See also : <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validchars"><strong>"valid chars"</strong></a>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> client code page = 850</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> client code page = 936</code>
-<p><br><a name="codingsystem"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>codingsystem (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is used to determine how incoming Shift-JIS Japanese
-characters are mapped from the incoming <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code
+<p><a name="codingsystem"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>codingsystem (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is used to determine how incoming Shift-JIS Japanese
+characters are mapped from the incoming <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code
page"</strong></a> used by the client, into file names in the
-UNIX filesystem. Only useful if <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code
+UNIX filesystem. Only useful if <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code
page"</strong></a> is set to 932 (Japanese Shift-JIS).
-<p><br>The options are :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>SJIS</strong> Shift-JIS. Does no conversion of the incoming filename.
-<p><br><li > <strong>JIS8, J8BB, J8BH, J8@B, J8@J, J8@H </strong> Convert from incoming
+<p>The options are :
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>SJIS</strong> Shift-JIS. Does no conversion of the incoming filename.
+<p><li > <strong>JIS8, J8BB, J8BH, J8@B, J8@J, J8@H </strong> Convert from incoming
Shift-JIS to eight bit JIS code with different shift-in, shift out
codes.
-<p><br><li > <strong>JIS7, J7BB, J7BH, J7@B, J7@J, J7@H </strong> Convert from incoming
+<p><li > <strong>JIS7, J7BB, J7BH, J7@B, J7@J, J7@H </strong> Convert from incoming
Shift-JIS to seven bit JIS code with different shift-in, shift out
codes.
-<p><br><li > <strong>JUNET, JUBB, JUBH, JU@B, JU@J, JU@H </strong> Convert from incoming
+<p><li > <strong>JUNET, JUBB, JUBH, JU@B, JU@J, JU@H </strong> Convert from incoming
Shift-JIS to JUNET code with different shift-in, shift out codes.
-<p><br><li > <strong>EUC</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to EUC code.
-<p><br><li > <strong>HEX</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to a 3 byte hex
+<p><li > <strong>EUC</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to EUC code.
+<p><li > <strong>HEX</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to a 3 byte hex
representation, i.e. <code>:AB</code>.
-<p><br><li > <strong>CAP</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to the 3 byte hex
+<p><li > <strong>CAP</strong> Convert an incoming Shift-JIS character to the 3 byte hex
representation used by the Columbia AppleTalk Program (CAP),
i.e. <code>:AB</code>. This is used for compatibility between Samba and CAP.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="comment"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>comment (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a text field that is seen next to a share when a client does a
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="comment"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>comment (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a text field that is seen next to a share when a client does a
queries the server, either via the network neighborhood or via "net
view" to list what shares are available.
-<p><br>If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the machine
+<p>If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the machine
name then see the server string command.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> No comment string</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> comment = Fred's Files</code>
-<p><br><a name="configfile"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>config file (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This allows you to override the config file to use, instead of the
+<p><a name="configfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>config file (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This allows you to override the config file to use, instead of the
default (usually <strong>smb.conf</strong>). There is a chicken and egg problem
here as this option is set in the config file!
-<p><br>For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed when the
+<p>For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed when the
parameters are loaded then it will reload them from the new config
file.
-<p><br>This option takes the usual substitutions, which can be very useful.
-<p><br>If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded (allowing you
+<p>This option takes the usual substitutions, which can be very useful.
+<p>If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded (allowing you
to special case the config files of just a few clients).
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> config file = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</code>
-<p><br><a name="copy"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>copy (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter allows you to <em>'clone'</em> service entries. The specified
+<p><a name="copy"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>copy (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter allows you to <em>'clone'</em> service entries. The specified
service is simply duplicated under the current service's name. Any
parameters specified in the current section will override those in the
section being copied.
-<p><br>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and create similar
+<p>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and create similar
services easily. Note that the service being copied must occur earlier
in the configuration file than the service doing the copying.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> copy = otherservice</code>
-<p><br><a name="createmask"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>create mask (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>A synonym for this parameter is <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>'create mode'</strong></a>.
-<p><br>When a file is created, the necessary permissions are calculated
+<p><a name="createmask"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>create mask (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>A synonym for this parameter is <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>'create mode'</strong></a>.
+<p>When a file is created, the necessary permissions are calculated
according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions, and the
resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this parameter.
This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for the UNIX modes
of a file. Any bit <em>*not*</em> set here will be removed from the modes set
on a file when it is created.
-<p><br>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group' and 'other'
+<p>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group' and 'other'
write and execute bits from the UNIX modes.
-<p><br>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created from
+<p>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created from
this parameter with the value of the "force create mode" parameter
which is set to 000 by default.
-<p><br>This parameter does not affect directory modes. See the parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>'directory mode'</strong></a> for details.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> parameter
+<p>This parameter does not affect directory modes. See the parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>'directory mode'</strong></a> for details.
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> parameter
for forcing particular mode bits to be set on created files. See also
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>"directory mode"</strong></a> parameter for masking
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymode"><strong>"directory mode"</strong></a> parameter for masking
mode bits on created directories.
-See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> create mask = 0744</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> create mask = 0775</code>
-<p><br><a name="createmode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>create mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="deadtime"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>deadtime (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer) represents the number
+<p><a name="createmode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>create mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="deadtime"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>deadtime (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer) represents the number
of minutes of inactivity before a connection is considered dead, and
it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes effect if the number of
open files is zero.
-<p><br>This is useful to stop a server's resources being exhausted by a large
+<p>This is useful to stop a server's resources being exhausted by a large
number of inactive connections.
-<p><br>Most clients have an auto-reconnect feature when a connection is
+<p>Most clients have an auto-reconnect feature when a connection is
broken so in most cases this parameter should be transparent to users.
-<p><br>Using this parameter with a timeout of a few minutes is recommended
+<p>Using this parameter with a timeout of a few minutes is recommended
for most systems.
-<p><br>A deadtime of zero indicates that no auto-disconnection should be
+<p>A deadtime of zero indicates that no auto-disconnection should be
performed.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> deadtime = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> deadtime = 15</code>
-<p><br><a name="debughirestimestamp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>debug hires timestamp (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages are needed with a
+<p><a name="debughirestimestamp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>debug hires timestamp (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages are needed with a
resolution of higher that seconds, this boolean parameter adds
microsecond resolution to the timestamp message header when turned on.
-<p><br>Note that the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
+<p>Note that the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
must be on for this to have an effect.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> debug hires timestamp = No</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> debug hires timestamp = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="debugtimestamp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>debug timestamp (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Samba2.0 debug log messages are timestamped by default. If you are
-running at a high <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a> these timestamps
+<p><a name="debugtimestamp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>debug timestamp (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Samba2.0 debug log messages are timestamped by default. If you are
+running at a high <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a> these timestamps
can be distracting. This boolean parameter allows timestamping to be turned
off.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> debug timestamp = Yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> debug timestamp = No</code>
-<p><br><a name="debugpid"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>debug pid (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>When using only one log file for more then one forked smbd-process
+<p><a name="debugpid"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>debug pid (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>When using only one log file for more then one forked smbd-process
there may be hard to follow which process outputs which message.
This boolean parameter is adds the process-id to the timestamp message
headers in the logfile when turned on.
-<p><br>Note that the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
+<p>Note that the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
must be on for this to have an effect.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> debug pid = No</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> debug pid = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="debuguid"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>debug uid (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime run as the connected
+<p><a name="debuguid"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>debug uid (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime run as the connected
user, this boolean parameter inserts the current euid, egid, uid
and gid to the timestamp message headers in the log file if turned on.
-<p><br>Note that the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
+<p>Note that the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debugtimestamp"><strong>debug timestamp</strong></a>
must be on for this to have an effect.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> debug uid = No</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> debug uid = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="debuglevel"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>debug level (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The value of the parameter (an integer) allows the debug level
+<p><a name="debuglevel"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>debug level (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The value of the parameter (an integer) allows the debug level
(logging level) to be specified in the <strong>smb.conf</strong> file. This is to
give greater flexibility in the configuration of the system.
-<p><br>The default will be the debug level specified on the command line
+<p>The default will be the debug level specified on the command line
or level zero if none was specified.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> debug level = 3</code>
-<p><br><a name="default"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>default (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>A synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#defaultservice"><strong>default service</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="defaultcase"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>default case (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>See the section on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a>. Also note
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#shortpreservecase"><strong>"short preserve case"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><a name="defaultservice"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>default service (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the name of a service which will be connected
+<p><a name="default"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>default (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>A synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#defaultservice"><strong>default service</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="defaultcase"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>default case (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>See the section on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a>. Also note
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#shortpreservecase"><strong>"short preserve case"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><a name="defaultservice"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>default service (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the name of a service which will be connected
to if the service actually requested cannot be found. Note that the
square brackets are <em>NOT</em> given in the parameter value (see example
below).
-<p><br>There is no default value for this parameter. If this parameter is not
+<p>There is no default value for this parameter. If this parameter is not
given, attempting to connect to a nonexistent service results in an
error.
-<p><br>Typically the default service would be a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest ok</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read-only</strong></a> service.
-<p><br>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed to equal that
+<p>Typically the default service would be a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>guest ok</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>read-only</strong></a> service.
+<p>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed to equal that
of the requested service, this is very useful as it allows you to use
-macros like <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a> to make a wildcard service.
-<p><br>Note also that any <code>'_'</code> characters in the name of the service used
+macros like <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a> to make a wildcard service.
+<p>Note also that any <code>'_'</code> characters in the name of the service used
in the default service will get mapped to a <code>'/'</code>. This allows for
interesting things.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<pre>
default service = pub
@@ -1201,34 +1201,34 @@ interesting things.
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="deleteuserscript"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>delete user script (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <em>AS ROOT</em> by
+<p><a name="deleteuserscript"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>delete user script (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <em>AS ROOT</em> by
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a> under special circumstances decribed
below.
-<p><br>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are created for all
+<p>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are created for all
users accessing files on this server. For sites that use Windows NT
account databases as their primary user database creating these users
and keeping the user list in sync with the Windows NT PDC is an
onerous task. This option allows <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to delete
the required UNIX users <em>ON DEMAND</em> when a user accesses the Samba
server and the Windows NT user no longer exists.
-<p><br>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> must be set to
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a> and <strong>"delete user
+<p>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> must be set to
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a> and <strong>"delete user
script"</strong> must be set to a full pathname for a script that will delete
a UNIX user given one argument of <strong>%u</strong>, which expands into the UNIX
user name to delete. <em>NOTE</em> that this is different to the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user script</strong></a> which will work with the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> option as well as
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>. The reason for this
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user script</strong></a> which will work with the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> option as well as
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>. The reason for this
is only when Samba is a domain member does it get the information
on an attempted user logon that a user no longer exists. In the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> mode a missing user
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>security=server</strong></a> mode a missing user
is treated the same as an invalid password logon attempt. Deleting
the user in this circumstance would not be a good idea.
-<p><br>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, at
+<p>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server, at
<em>"login"</em>(session setup in the SMB protocol) time,
-<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> contacts the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
+<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> contacts the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password
server</strong></a> and attempts to authenticate the given user
with the given password. If the authentication fails with the specific
Domain error code meaning that the user no longer exists then
@@ -1237,265 +1237,265 @@ password database that matches the Windows user account. If this lookup succeeds
and <strong>"delete user script"</strong> is set then <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will
call the specified script <em>AS ROOT</em>, expanding any <strong>%u</strong> argument
to be the user name to delete.
-<p><br>This script should delete the given UNIX username. In this way, UNIX
+<p>This script should delete the given UNIX username. In this way, UNIX
users are dynamically deleted to match existing Windows NT accounts.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password server</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>password server</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#adduserscript"><strong>add user
script</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> delete user script = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> delete user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/del_user %u</code>
-<p><br><a name="deletereadonly"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>delete readonly (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted. This is not
+<p><a name="deletereadonly"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>delete readonly (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted. This is not
normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.
-<p><br>This option may be useful for running applications such as rcs, where
+<p>This option may be useful for running applications such as rcs, where
UNIX file ownership prevents changing file permissions, and DOS
semantics prevent deletion of a read only file.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> delete readonly = No</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> delete readonly = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="deletevetofiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>delete veto files (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option is used when Samba is attempting to delete a directory
-that contains one or more vetoed directories (see the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>'veto
+<p><a name="deletevetofiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>delete veto files (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option is used when Samba is attempting to delete a directory
+that contains one or more vetoed directories (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>'veto
files'</strong></a> option). If this option is set to False (the
default) then if a vetoed directory contains any non-vetoed files or
directories then the directory delete will fail. This is usually what
you want.
-<p><br>If this option is set to True, then Samba will attempt to recursively
+<p>If this option is set to True, then Samba will attempt to recursively
delete any files and directories within the vetoed directory. This can
be useful for integration with file serving systems such as <strong>NetAtalk</strong>,
which create meta-files within directories you might normally veto
DOS/Windows users from seeing (e.g. <code>.AppleDouble</code>)
-<p><br>Setting <code>'delete veto files = True'</code> allows these directories to be
+<p>Setting <code>'delete veto files = True'</code> allows these directories to be
transparently deleted when the parent directory is deleted (so long
as the user has permissions to do so).
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>veto files</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>veto files</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> delete veto files = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> delete veto files = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="denyhosts"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>deny hosts (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>hosts deny</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="dfreecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>dfree command (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The dfree command setting should only be used on systems where a
+<p><a name="denyhosts"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>deny hosts (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>hosts deny</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="dfreecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>dfree command (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The dfree command setting should only be used on systems where a
problem occurs with the internal disk space calculations. This has
been known to happen with Ultrix, but may occur with other operating
systems. The symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry
Ignore" at the end of each directory listing.
-<p><br>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to
+<p>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to
calculate the total disk space and amount available with an external
routine. The example below gives a possible script that might fulfill
this function.
-<p><br>The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating a
+<p>The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating a
directory in the filesystem being queried. This will typically consist
of the string <code>"./"</code>. The script should return two integers in
ascii. The first should be the total disk space in blocks, and the
second should be the number of available blocks. An optional third
return value can give the block size in bytes. The default blocksize
is 1024 bytes.
-<p><br>Note: Your script should <em>NOT</em> be setuid or setgid and should be
+<p>Note: Your script should <em>NOT</em> be setuid or setgid and should be
owned by (and writeable only by) root!
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> By default internal routines for determining the disk capacity
and remaining space will be used.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> dfree command = /usr/local/samba/bin/dfree</code>
-<p><br>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:
+<p><pre>
#!/bin/sh
df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}'
</pre>
-<p><br>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):
-<p><br><pre>
+<p>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):
+<p><pre>
#!/bin/sh
/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}'
</pre>
-<p><br>Note that you may have to replace the command names with full
+<p>Note that you may have to replace the command names with full
path names on some systems.
-<p><br><a name="directory"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>directory (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="directorymask"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>directory mask (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is the octal modes which are used when converting DOS
+<p><a name="directory"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>directory (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="directorymask"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>directory mask (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is the octal modes which are used when converting DOS
modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX directories.
-<p><br>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are calculated
+<p>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are calculated
according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions, and the
resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this parameter.
This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for the UNIX modes
of a directory. Any bit <em>*not*</em> set here will be removed from the
modes set on a directory when it is created.
-<p><br>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group' and 'other'
+<p>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group' and 'other'
write bits from the UNIX mode, allowing only the user who owns the
directory to modify it.
-<p><br>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created from
+<p>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created from
this parameter with the value of the "force directory mode"
parameter. This parameter is set to 000 by default (i.e. no extra mode
bits are added).
-<p><br>See the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a> parameter
+<p>See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a> parameter
to cause particular mode bits to always be set on created directories.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>"create mode"</strong></a> parameter for masking
-mode bits on created files, and the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>"directory security mask"</strong></a>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmode"><strong>"create mode"</strong></a> parameter for masking
+mode bits on created files, and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>"directory security mask"</strong></a>
parameter.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> directory mask = 0755</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> directory mask = 0775</code>
-<p><br><a name="directorymode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>directory mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="directorysecuritymask"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>directory security mask (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified
+<p><a name="directorymode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>directory mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="directorysecuritymask"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>directory security mask (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified
when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permission on a
directory using the native NT security dialog box.
-<p><br>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the changed
+<p>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the changed
permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in this mask from
being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this mask may be treated
as a set of bits the user is not allowed to change.
-<p><br>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a> parameter. To allow a user to
+<p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>directory mask</strong></a> parameter. To allow a user to
modify all the user/group/world permissions on a directory, set this
parameter to 0777.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
+<p><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
means can easily bypass this restriction, so it is primarily
useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
most normal systems will probably want to set it to 0777.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
-mode</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security
-mask</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security mode</strong></a>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
+mode</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security
+mask</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security mode</strong></a>
parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> directory security mask = &lt;same as directory mask&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> directory security mask = 0777</code>
-<p><br><a name="dnsproxy"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>dns proxy (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Specifies that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
+<p><a name="dnsproxy"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>dns proxy (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Specifies that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
server and finding that a NetBIOS name has not been registered, should
treat the NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS name and do a lookup
with the DNS server for that name on behalf of the name-querying
client.
-<p><br>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15 characters, so
+<p>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15 characters, so
the DNS name (or DNS alias) can likewise only be 15 characters,
maximum.
-<p><br><a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> spawns a second copy of itself to do the
+<p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> spawns a second copy of itself to do the
DNS name lookup requests, as doing a name lookup is a blocking action.
-<p><br>See also the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>wins support</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> dns proxy = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="domainadmingroup"></a>
+<p><a name="domainadmingroup"></a>
<strong>domain admin group (G)</strong>
-<p><br>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
+<p>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
Samba NT Domain Controller Code. It may be removed in a later release.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list <strong>Samba-ntdom</strong> available by sending email to
<a href="mailto:listproc@samba.org"><em>listproc@samba.org</em></a>
-<p><br><a name="domainadminusers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain admin users (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
+<p><a name="domainadminusers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain admin users (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
Samba NT Domain Controller Code. It may be removed in a later release.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list <strong>Samba-ntdom</strong> available by sending email to
<a href="mailto:listproc@samba.org"><em>listproc@samba.org</em></a>
-<p><br><a name="domaingroups"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain groups (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
+<p><a name="domaingroups"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain groups (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
Samba NT Domain Controller Code. It may be removed in a later release.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list <strong>Samba-ntdom</strong> available by sending email to
<a href="mailto:listproc@samba.org"><em>listproc@samba.org</em></a>
-<p><br><a name="domainguestgroup"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain guest group (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
+<p><a name="domainguestgroup"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain guest group (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
Samba NT Domain Controller Code. It may be removed in a later release.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list <strong>Samba-ntdom</strong> available by sending email to
<a href="mailto:listproc@samba.org"><em>listproc@samba.org</em></a>
-<p><br><a name="domainguestusers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain guest users (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
+<p><a name="domainguestusers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain guest users (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is an <strong>EXPERIMENTAL</strong> parameter that is part of the unfinished
Samba NT Domain Controller Code. It may be removed in a later release.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list <strong>Samba-ntdom</strong> available by sending email to
<a href="mailto:listproc@samba.org"><em>listproc@samba.org</em></a>
-<p><br><a name="domainlogons"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain logons (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If set to true, the Samba server will serve Windows 95/98 Domain
-logons for the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> it is in. For more
+<p><a name="domainlogons"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain logons (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If set to true, the Samba server will serve Windows 95/98 Domain
+logons for the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> it is in. For more
details on setting up this feature see the file DOMAINS.txt in the
Samba documentation directory <code>docs/</code> shipped with the source code.
-<p><br>Note that Win95/98 Domain logons are <em>NOT</em> the same as Windows
+<p>Note that Win95/98 Domain logons are <em>NOT</em> the same as Windows
NT Domain logons. NT Domain logons require a Primary Domain Controller
(PDC) for the Domain. It is intended that in a future release Samba
will be able to provide this functionality for Windows NT clients
also.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> domain logons = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="domainmaster"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>domain master (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Tell <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to enable WAN-wide browse list
+<p><a name="domainmaster"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>domain master (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Tell <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to enable WAN-wide browse list
collation. Setting this option causes <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to
claim a special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a
domain master browser for its given
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a>. Local master browsers in the same
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> on broadcast-isolated subnets will give
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a>. Local master browsers in the same
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> on broadcast-isolated subnets will give
this <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> their local browse lists, and then
ask <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> for a complete copy of the browse list
for the whole wide area network. Browser clients will then contact
their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse
list, instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet.
-<p><br>Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be able to
-claim this <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> specific special NetBIOS
+<p>Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be able to
+claim this <a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> specific special NetBIOS
name that identifies them as domain master browsers for that
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> by default (i.e. there is no way to
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> by default (i.e. there is no way to
prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting to do this). This means that
if this parameter is set and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> claims the
-special name for a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> before a Windows NT
+special name for a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> before a Windows NT
PDC is able to do so then cross subnet browsing will behave strangely
and may fail.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> domain master = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="dontdescend"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>dont descend (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>There are certain directories on some systems (e.g., the <code>/proc</code> tree
+<p><a name="dontdescend"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>dont descend (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>There are certain directories on some systems (e.g., the <code>/proc</code> tree
under Linux) that are either not of interest to clients or are
infinitely deep (recursive). This parameter allows you to specify a
comma-delimited list of directories that the server should always show
as empty.
-<p><br>Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format of the "dont
+<p>Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format of the "dont
descend" entries. For example you may need <code>"./proc"</code> instead of
just <code>"/proc"</code>. Experimentation is the best policy :-)
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none (i.e., all directories are OK to descend)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> dont descend = /proc,/dev</code>
-<p><br><a name="dosfiletimeresolution"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>dos filetime resolution (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest granularity on
+<p><a name="dosfiletimeresolution"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>dos filetime resolution (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest granularity on
time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter for a share
causes Samba to round the reported time down to the nearest two second
boundary when a query call that requires one second resolution is made
to <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++
+<p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++
when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a share,
Visual C++ uses two different time reading calls to check if a file
has changed since it was last read. One of these calls uses a
@@ -1505,52 +1505,52 @@ timestamp of an odd number of seconds then the two timestamps will not
match and Visual C++ will keep reporting the file has changed. Setting
this option causes the two timestamps to match, and Visual C++ is
happy.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> dos filetime resolution = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> dos filetime resolution = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="dosfiletimes"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>dos filetimes (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a file they can change
+<p><a name="dosfiletimes"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>dos filetimes (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a file they can change
the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics, only the owner of the file
or root may change the timestamp. By default, Samba runs with POSIX
semantics and refuses to change the timestamp on a file if the user
smbd is acting on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option
to True allows DOS semantics and smbd will change the file timestamp as
DOS requires.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> dos filetimes = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> dos filetimes = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="encryptpasswords"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>encrypt passwords (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords will be negotiated
+<p><a name="encryptpasswords"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>encrypt passwords (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords will be negotiated
with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and above and also
Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords unless a
registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in Samba see the
file ENCRYPTION.txt in the Samba documentation directory <code>docs/</code>
shipped with the source code.
-<p><br>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
+<p>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> must either have access to a local
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd (5)</strong></a> file (see the
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a> program for information on
how to set up and maintain this file), or set the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security=</strong></a> parameter to either
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"server"</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"domain"</strong></a> which causes
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security=</strong></a> parameter to either
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"server"</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"domain"</strong></a> which causes
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to authenticate against another server.
-<p><br><a name="exec"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>exec (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="fakedirectorycreatetimes"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>fake directory create times (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create time for all files
+<p><a name="exec"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>exec (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="fakedirectorycreatetimes"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>fake directory create times (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create time for all files
and directories. This is not the same as the ctime - status change
time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default reports the earliest of
the various times Unix does keep. Setting this parameter for a share
causes Samba to always report midnight 1-1-1980 as the create time for
directories.
-<p><br>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++
+<p>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++
when used against Samba shares. Visual C++ generated makefiles have
the object directory as a dependency for each object file, and a make
rule to create the directory. Also, when NMAKE compares timestamps it
@@ -1558,121 +1558,121 @@ uses the creation time when examining a directory. Thus the object
directory will be created if it does not exist, but once it does exist
it will always have an earlier timestamp than the object files it
contains.
-<p><br>However, Unix time semantics mean that the create time reported by
+<p>However, Unix time semantics mean that the create time reported by
Samba will be updated whenever a file is created or deleted in the
directory. NMAKE therefore finds all object files in the object
directory bar the last one built are out of date compared to the
directory and rebuilds them. Enabling this option ensures directories
always predate their contents and an NMAKE build will proceed as
expected.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> fake directory create times = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> fake directory create times = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="fakeoplocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>fake oplocks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission from a server to
+<p><a name="fakeoplocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>fake oplocks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission from a server to
locally cache file operations. If a server grants an oplock
(opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume that it is the
only one accessing the file and it will aggressively cache file
data. With some oplock types the client may even cache file open/close
operations. This can give enormous performance benefits.
-<p><br>When you set <code>"fake oplocks = yes"</code> <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will
+<p>When you set <code>"fake oplocks = yes"</code> <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will
always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using the
file.
-<p><br>It is generally much better to use the real <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
+<p>It is generally much better to use the real <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
support rather than this parameter.
-<p><br>If you enable this option on all read-only shares or shares that you
+<p>If you enable this option on all read-only shares or shares that you
know will only be accessed from one client at a time such as
physically read-only media like CDROMs, you will see a big performance
improvement on many operations. If you enable this option on shares
where multiple clients may be accessing the files read-write at the
same time you can get data corruption. Use this option carefully!
-<p><br>This option is disabled by default.
-<p><br><a name="followsymlinks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>follow symlinks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter allows the Samba administrator to stop
+<p>This option is disabled by default.
+<p><a name="followsymlinks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>follow symlinks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter allows the Samba administrator to stop
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> from following symbolic links in a
particular share. Setting this parameter to <em>"No"</em> prevents any file
or directory that is a symbolic link from being followed (the user
will get an error). This option is very useful to stop users from
adding a symbolic link to <code>/etc/passwd</code> in their home directory for
instance. However it will slow filename lookups down slightly.
-<p><br>This option is enabled (i.e. <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will follow
+<p>This option is enabled (i.e. <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will follow
symbolic links) by default.
-<p><br><a name="forcecreatemode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force create mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will
+<p><a name="forcecreatemode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force create mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will
<em>*always*</em> be set on a file by Samba. This is done by bitwise
'OR'ing these bits onto the mode bits of a file that is being created
or having its permissions changed. The default for this parameter is
(in octal) 000. The modes in this parameter are bitwise 'OR'ed onto
-the file mode after the mask set in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create
+the file mode after the mask set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create
mask"</strong></a> parameter is applied.
-<p><br>See also the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> for details
+<p>See also the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> for details
on masking mode bits on files.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> force create mode = 000</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force create mode = 0755</code>
-<p><br>would force all created files to have read and execute permissions set
+<p>would force all created files to have read and execute permissions set
for 'group' and 'other' as well as the read/write/execute bits set for
the 'user'.
-<p><br><a name="forcedirectorymode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force directory mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will
+<p><a name="forcedirectorymode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force directory mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will
<em>*always*</em> be set on a directory created by Samba. This is done by
bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the mode bits of a directory that is
being created. The default for this parameter is (in octal) 0000 which
will not add any extra permission bits to a created directory. This
operation is done after the mode mask in the parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a> is applied.
-<p><br>See also the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a> for
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a> is applied.
+<p>See also the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a> for
details on masking mode bits on created directories.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#inheritpermissions"><strong>"inherit permissions"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> force directory mode = 000</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force directory mode = 0755</code>
-<p><br>would force all created directories to have read and execute
+<p>would force all created directories to have read and execute
permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.
-<p><br><a name="forcedirectorysecuritymode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force directory security mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when
+<p><a name="forcedirectorysecuritymode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force directory security mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when
a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permission on a directory
using the native NT security dialog box.
-<p><br>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed
+<p>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed
permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that the user may
have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this mask may be
treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a directory,
the user has always set to be 'on'.
-<p><br>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>force directory mode</strong></a> parameter. To allow
+<p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>force directory mode</strong></a> parameter. To allow
a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a directory,
with restrictions set this parameter to 000.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
+<p><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
means can easily bypass this restriction, so it is primarily
useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
most normal systems will probably want to set it to 0000.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security mask</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security mask</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security
mode</strong></a> parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> force directory security mode = &lt;same as force directory mode&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force directory security mode = 0</code>
-<p><br><a name="forcegroup"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force group (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be assigned as the default
+<p><a name="forcegroup"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force group (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be assigned as the default
primary group for all users connecting to this service. This is useful
for sharing files by ensuring that all access to files on service will
use the named group for their permissions checking. Thus, by assigning
permissions for this group to the files and directories within this
service the Samba administrator can restrict or allow sharing of these
files.
-<p><br>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter has extended functionality in the following
+<p>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter has extended functionality in the following
way. If the group name listed here has a '+' character prepended to it
then the current user accessing the share only has the primary group
default assigned to this group if they are already assigned as a member
@@ -1683,151 +1683,151 @@ assignment. For example, the setting <code>force group = +sys</code> means
that only users who are already in group sys will have their default
primary group assigned to sys when accessing this Samba share. All
other users will retain their ordinary primary group.
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a> parameter is also set the
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a> parameter is also set the
group specified in <strong>force group</strong> will override the primary group
-set in <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a>.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+set in <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a>.
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forceuser"><strong>"force user"</strong></a>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> no forced group</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force group = agroup</code>
-<p><br><a name="forcesecuritymode"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force security mode (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when
+<p><a name="forcesecuritymode"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force security mode (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when
a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permission on a file
using the native NT security dialog box.
-<p><br>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed
+<p>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the changed
permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that the user may
have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this mask may be
treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a file, the
user has always set to be 'on'.
-<p><br>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>force create mode</strong></a> parameter. To allow
+<p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>force create mode</strong></a> parameter. To allow
a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file,
with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
+<p><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
means can easily bypass this restriction, so it is primarily
useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
most normal systems will probably want to set it to 0000.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
-mode</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security
-mask</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
+mode</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security
+mask</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securitymask"><strong>security mask</strong></a>
parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> force security mode = &lt;same as force create mode&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force security mode = 0</code>
-<p><br><a name="forceuser"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>force user (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be assigned as the default
+<p><a name="forceuser"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>force user (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be assigned as the default
user for all users connecting to this service. This is useful for
sharing files. You should also use it carefully as using it
incorrectly can cause security problems.
-<p><br>This user name only gets used once a connection is established. Thus
+<p>This user name only gets used once a connection is established. Thus
clients still need to connect as a valid user and supply a valid
password. Once connected, all file operations will be performed as the
<code>"forced user"</code>, no matter what username the client connected as.
-<p><br>This can be very useful.
-<p><br>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the primary
+<p>This can be very useful.
+<p>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the primary
group of the forced user to be used as the primary group for all
file activity. Prior to 2.0.5 the primary group was left as the
primary group of the connecting user (this was a bug).
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>"force group"</strong></a>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>"force group"</strong></a>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> no forced user</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> force user = auser</code>
-<p><br><a name="fstype"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>fstype (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter allows the administrator to configure the string that
+<p><a name="fstype"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>fstype (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter allows the administrator to configure the string that
specifies the type of filesystem a share is using that is reported by
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> when a client queries the filesystem type
for a share. The default type is <strong>"NTFS"</strong> for compatibility with
Windows NT but this can be changed to other strings such as "Samba" or
"FAT" if required.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> fstype = NTFS</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> fstype = Samba</code>
-<p><br><a name="getwdcache"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>getwd cache (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a caching algorithm
+<p><a name="getwdcache"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>getwd cache (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a caching algorithm
will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd() calls. This can have
a significant impact on performance, especially when the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>widelinks</strong></a> parameter is set to False.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>widelinks</strong></a> parameter is set to False.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> getwd cache = No</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> getwd cache = Yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="group"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>group (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>"force group"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="guestaccount"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>guest account (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a username which will be used for access to services which are
-specified as <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>'guest ok'</strong></a> (see below). Whatever
+<p><a name="group"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>group (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcegroup"><strong>"force group"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="guestaccount"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>guest account (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a username which will be used for access to services which are
+specified as <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>'guest ok'</strong></a> (see below). Whatever
privileges this user has will be available to any client connecting to
the guest service. Typically this user will exist in the password
file, but will not have a valid login. The user account <strong>"ftp"</strong> is
often a good choice for this parameter. If a username is specified in
a given service, the specified username overrides this one.
-<p><br>One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not be able to
+<p>One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not be able to
print. Use another account in this case. You should test this by
trying to log in as your guest user (perhaps by using the <code>"su -"</code>
command) and trying to print using the system print command such as
<strong>lpr (1)</strong> or <strong>lp (1)</strong>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> specified at compile time, usually "nobody"</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> guest account = ftp</code>
-<p><br><a name="guestok"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>guest ok (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this parameter is <em>'yes'</em> for a service, then no password is
+<p><a name="guestok"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>guest ok (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this parameter is <em>'yes'</em> for a service, then no password is
required to connect to the service. Privileges will be those of the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a>.
-<p><br>See the section below on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> for more
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>guest account</strong></a>.
+<p>See the section below on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> for more
information about this option.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> guest ok = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> guest ok = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="guestonly"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>guest only (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this parameter is <em>'yes'</em> for a service, then only guest
+<p><a name="guestonly"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>guest only (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this parameter is <em>'yes'</em> for a service, then only guest
connections to the service are permitted. This parameter will have no
-affect if <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>"guest ok"</strong></a> or <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#public"><strong>"public"</strong></a>
+affect if <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>"guest ok"</strong></a> or <a href="smb.conf.5.html#public"><strong>"public"</strong></a>
is not set for the service.
-<p><br>See the section below on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> for more
+<p>See the section below on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> for more
information about this option.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> guest only = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> guest only = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="hidedotfiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hide dot files (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether files starting with
+<p><a name="hidedotfiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hide dot files (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether files starting with
a dot appear as hidden files.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> hide dot files = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> hide dot files = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="hidefiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hide files(S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of files or directories that are not visible but are
+<p><a name="hidefiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hide files(S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of files or directories that are not visible but are
accessible. The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied to any files or
directories that match.
-<p><br>Each entry in the list must be separated by a <code>'/'</code>, which allows
+<p>Each entry in the list must be separated by a <code>'/'</code>, which allows
spaces to be included in the entry. <code>'*'</code> and <code>'?'</code> can be used
to specify multiple files or directories as in DOS wildcards.
-<p><br>Each entry must be a Unix path, not a DOS path and must not include the
+<p>Each entry must be a Unix path, not a DOS path and must not include the
Unix directory separator <code>'/'</code>.
-<p><br>Note that the case sensitivity option is applicable in hiding files.
-<p><br>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, as it
+<p>Note that the case sensitivity option is applicable in hiding files.
+<p>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, as it
will be forced to check all files and directories for a match as they
are scanned.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hidedotfiles"><strong>"hide dot files"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>"veto
-files"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hidedotfiles"><strong>"hide dot files"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>"veto
+files"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default</strong>
<pre>
No files or directories are hidden by this option (dot files are
@@ -1835,139 +1835,139 @@ files"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><str
</pre>
-<p><br><strong>Example</strong>
+<p><strong>Example</strong>
<code> hide files = /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/</code>
-<p><br>The above example is based on files that the Macintosh SMB client
+<p>The above example is based on files that the Macintosh SMB client
(DAVE) available from <a href="http://www.thursby.com"><strong>Thursby</strong></a> creates for
internal use, and also still hides all files beginning with a dot.
-<p><br><a name="homedirmap"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>homedir map (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>"nis homedir"</strong></a> is true, and
-<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> is also acting as a Win95/98 <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon
+<p><a name="homedirmap"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>homedir map (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>"nis homedir"</strong></a> is true, and
+<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> is also acting as a Win95/98 <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon
server</strong></a> then this parameter specifies the NIS (or YP)
map from which the server for the user's home directory should be
extracted. At present, only the Sun auto.home map format is
understood. The form of the map is:
-<p><br><code>username server:/some/file/system</code>
-<p><br>and the program will extract the servername from before the first
+<p><code>username server:/some/file/system</code>
+<p>and the program will extract the servername from before the first
<code>':'</code>. There should probably be a better parsing system that copes
with different map formats and also Amd (another automounter) maps.
-<p><br>NB: A working NIS is required on the system for this option to work.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>"nis homedir"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>domain
+<p>NB: A working NIS is required on the system for this option to work.
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nishomedir"><strong>"nis homedir"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>domain
logons</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> homedir map = auto.home</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> homedir map = amd.homedir</code>
-<p><br><a name="hostsallow"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hosts allow (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>A synonym for this parameter is <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>'allow hosts'</strong></a>
-<p><br>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited set of hosts which
+<p><a name="hostsallow"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hosts allow (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>A synonym for this parameter is <a href="smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>'allow hosts'</strong></a>
+<p>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited set of hosts which
are permitted to access a service.
-<p><br>If specified in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section then it will
+<p>If specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section then it will
apply to all services, regardless of whether the individual service
has a different setting.
-<p><br>You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For example, you could
+<p>You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For example, you could
restrict access to only the hosts on a Class C subnet with something
like <code>"allow hosts = 150.203.5."</code>. The full syntax of the list is
described in the man page <strong>hosts_access (5)</strong>. Note that this man
page may not be present on your system, so a brief description will
be given here also.
-<p><br>Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always be allowed
+<p>Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always be allowed
access unless specifically denied by a "hosts deny" option.
-<p><br>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and by netgroup
+<p>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and by netgroup
names if your system supports netgroups. The <em>EXCEPT</em> keyword can also
be used to limit a wildcard list. The following examples may provide
some help:
-<p><br><strong>Example 1</strong>: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.* except one
-<p><br><code> hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example 2</strong>: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask
-<p><br><code> hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example 3</strong>: allow a couple of hosts
-<p><br><code> hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example 4</strong>: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but
+<p><strong>Example 1</strong>: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.* except one
+<p><code> hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</code>
+<p><strong>Example 2</strong>: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask
+<p><code> hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</code>
+<p><strong>Example 3</strong>: allow a couple of hosts
+<p><code> hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</code>
+<p><strong>Example 4</strong>: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but
deny access from one particular host
-<p><br><code> hosts allow = @foonet</code>
-<p><br><code> hosts deny = pirate</code>
-<p><br>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.
-<p><br>See <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm (1)</strong></a> for a way of testing your
+<p><code> hosts allow = @foonet</code>
+<p><code> hosts deny = pirate</code>
+<p>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.
+<p>See <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm (1)</strong></a> for a way of testing your
host access to see if it does what you expect.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> allow hosts = 150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au</code>
-<p><br><a name="hostsdeny"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hosts deny (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The opposite of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>'hosts allow'</strong></a> - hosts listed
+<p><a name="hostsdeny"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hosts deny (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The opposite of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>'hosts allow'</strong></a> - hosts listed
here are <em>NOT</em> permitted access to services unless the specific
services have their own lists to override this one. Where the lists
-conflict, the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>'allow'</strong></a> list takes precedence.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+conflict, the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>'allow'</strong></a> list takes precedence.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none (i.e., no hosts specifically excluded)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> hosts deny = 150.203.4. badhost.mynet.edu.au</code>
-<p><br><a name="hostsequiv"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hosts equiv (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this global parameter is a non-null string, it specifies the name
+<p><a name="hostsequiv"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hosts equiv (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this global parameter is a non-null string, it specifies the name
of a file to read for the names of hosts and users who will be allowed
access without specifying a password.
-<p><br>This is not be confused with <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a> which
+<p>This is not be confused with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>hosts allow</strong></a> which
is about hosts access to services and is more useful for guest
services. <strong>hosts equiv</strong> may be useful for NT clients which will not
supply passwords to samba.
-<p><br>NOTE: The use of <strong>hosts equiv</strong> can be a major security hole. This is
+<p>NOTE: The use of <strong>hosts equiv</strong> can be a major security hole. This is
because you are trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is
very easy to get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the
<strong>hosts equiv</strong> option be only used if you really know what you are
doing, or perhaps on a home network where you trust your spouse and
kids. And only if you <em>really</em> trust them :-).
-<p><br><strong>Default</strong>
+<p><strong>Default</strong>
<code> No host equivalences</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example</strong>
+<p><strong>Example</strong>
<code> hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv</code>
-<p><br><a name="include"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>include (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This allows you to include one config file inside another. The file
+<p><a name="include"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>include (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This allows you to include one config file inside another. The file
is included literally, as though typed in place.
-<p><br>It takes the standard substitutions, except <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentP"><strong>%P</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="inheritpermissions"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>inherit permissions (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The permissions on new files and directories are normally governed by
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a>
+<p>It takes the standard substitutions, except <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentP"><strong>%P</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="inheritpermissions"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>inherit permissions (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The permissions on new files and directories are normally governed by
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a>
but the boolean inherit permissions parameter overrides this.
-<p><br>New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
+<p>New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
including bits such as setgid.
-<p><br>New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent directory.
+<p>New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent directory.
Their execute bits continue to be determined by
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maparchive"><strong>"map archive"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maphidden"><strong>"map hidden"</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#mapsystem"><strong>"map system"</strong></a> as usual.
-<p><br>Note that the setuid bit is *never* set via inheritance
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#maparchive"><strong>"map archive"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#maphidden"><strong>"map hidden"</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#mapsystem"><strong>"map system"</strong></a> as usual.
+<p>Note that the setuid bit is *never* set via inheritance
(the code explicitly prohibits this).
-<p><br>This can be particularly useful on large systems with many users,
+<p>This can be particularly useful on large systems with many users,
perhaps several thousand,
to allow a single <strong>[homes]</strong> share to be used flexibly by each user.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorymask"><strong>"directory mask"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcecreatemode"><strong>"force create mode"</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorymode"><strong>"force directory mode"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default</strong>
<code> inherit permissions = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example</strong>
+<p><strong>Example</strong>
<code> inherit permissions = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="interfaces"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>interfaces (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to override the default network interfaces list
+<p><a name="interfaces"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>interfaces (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to override the default network interfaces list
that Samba will use for browsing, name registration and other NBT
traffic. By default Samba will query the kernel for the list of all
active interfaces and use any interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are
broadcast capable.
-<p><br>The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string can be in
+<p>The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string can be in
any of the following forms:
-<p><br><ul>
+<p><dl>
<li > a network interface name (such as eth0). This may include
shell-like wildcards so eth* will match any interface starting
with the substring "eth"
@@ -1975,27 +1975,27 @@ any of the following forms:
from the list of interfaces obtained from the kernel
<li > an IP/mask pair.
<li > a broadcast/mask pair.
-</ul>
-<p><br>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such as 24 for a C
+</dl>
+<p>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such as 24 for a C
class network) or a full netmask in dotted decmal form.
-<p><br>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted decimal IP
+<p>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted decimal IP
address or a hostname which will be looked up via the OSes normal
hostname resolution mechanisms.
-<p><br>For example, the following line:
-<p><br><code>interfaces = eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0</code>
-<p><br>would configure three network interfaces corresponding to the eth0
+<p>For example, the following line:
+<p><code>interfaces = eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0</code>
+<p>would configure three network interfaces corresponding to the eth0
device and IP addresses 192.168.2.10 and 192.168.3.10. The netmasks of
the latter two interfaces would be set to 255.255.255.0.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#bindinterfacesonly"><strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="invalidusers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>invalid users (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of users that should not be allowed to login to this
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#bindinterfacesonly"><strong>"bind interfaces only"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="invalidusers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>invalid users (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of users that should not be allowed to login to this
service. This is really a <em>"paranoid"</em> check to absolutely ensure an
improper setting does not breach your security.
-<p><br>A name starting with a <code>'@'</code> is interpreted as an NIS netgroup first
+<p>A name starting with a <code>'@'</code> is interpreted as an NIS netgroup first
(if your system supports NIS), and then as a UNIX group if the name
was not found in the NIS netgroup database.
-<p><br>A name starting with <code>'+'</code> is interpreted only by looking in the
+<p>A name starting with <code>'+'</code> is interpreted only by looking in the
UNIX group database. A name starting with <code>'&amp;'</code> is interpreted only
by looking in the NIS netgroup database (this requires NIS to be
working on your system). The characters <code>'+'</code> and <code>'&amp;'</code> may be
@@ -2004,120 +2004,120 @@ used at the start of the name in either order so the value
netgroup database, and the value <code>"&amp;+group"</code> means check the NIS
netgroup database, followed by the UNIX group database (the same as
the <code>'@'</code> prefix).
-<p><br>The current servicename is substituted for
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>. This is useful in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>
+<p>The current servicename is substituted for
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>. This is useful in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>
section.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>"valid users"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>"valid users"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> No invalid users</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> invalid users = root fred admin @wheel</code>
-<p><br><a name="keepalive"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>keepalive (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents the number of
+<p><a name="keepalive"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>keepalive (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents the number of
seconds between <strong>'keepalive'</strong> packets. If this parameter is zero, no
keepalive packets will be sent. Keepalive packets, if sent, allow the
server to tell whether a client is still present and responding.
-<p><br>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket being used
-has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>"socket
+<p>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket being used
+has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>"socket
options"</strong></a>). Basically you should only use this option
if you strike difficulties.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> keepalive = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> keepalive = 60</code>
-<p><br><a name="kerneloplocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>kernel oplocks (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>For UNIXs that support kernel based <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
+<p><a name="kerneloplocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>kernel oplocks (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>For UNIXs that support kernel based <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a>
(currently only IRIX but hopefully also Linux and FreeBSD soon) this
parameter allows the use of them to be turned on or off.
-<p><br>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a> to be
+<p>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>oplocks</strong></a> to be
broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation accesses a file
that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> has oplocked. This allows complete
data consistency between SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is a
<em>very</em> cool feature :-).
-<p><br>This parameter defaults to <em>"On"</em> on systems that have the support,
+<p>This parameter defaults to <em>"On"</em> on systems that have the support,
and <em>"off"</em> on systems that don't. You should never need to touch
this parameter.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>"level2 oplocks"</strong></a>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>"level2 oplocks"</strong></a>
parameters.
-<p><br><a name="ldapfilter"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap filter (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldapfilter"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap filter (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies an LDAP search filter used to search for a
+<p>This parameter specifies an LDAP search filter used to search for a
user name in the LDAP database. It must contain the string
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%u</strong></a> which will be replaced with the user being
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%u</strong></a> which will be replaced with the user being
searched for.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> empty string.</code>
-<p><br><a name="ldapport"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap port (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldapport"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap port (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the TCP port number to use to contact
+<p>This parameter specifies the TCP port number to use to contact
the LDAP server on.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ldap port = 389.</code>
-<p><br><a name="ldaproot"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap root (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldaproot"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap root (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the entity to bind to the LDAP server
+<p>This parameter specifies the entity to bind to the LDAP server
as (essentially the LDAP username) in order to be able to perform
queries and modifications on the LDAP database.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldaprootpasswd"><strong>ldap root passwd</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldaprootpasswd"><strong>ldap root passwd</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> empty string (no user defined)</code>
-<p><br><a name="ldaprootpasswd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap root passwd (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldaprootpasswd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap root passwd (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the password for the entity to bind to the
+<p>This parameter specifies the password for the entity to bind to the
LDAP server as (the password for this LDAP username) in order to be
able to perform queries and modifications on the LDAP database.
-<p><br><em>BUGS:</em> This parameter should <em>NOT</em> be a readable parameter
+<p><em>BUGS:</em> This parameter should <em>NOT</em> be a readable parameter
in the <strong>smb.conf</strong> file and will be removed once a correct
storage place is found.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#ldaproot"><strong>ldap root</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ldaproot"><strong>ldap root</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> empty string.</code>
-<p><br><a name="ldapserver"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap server (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldapserver"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap server (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the DNS name of the LDAP server to use
+<p>This parameter specifies the DNS name of the LDAP server to use
for SMB/CIFS authentication purposes.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ldap server = localhost</code>
-<p><br><a name="ldapsuffix"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ldap suffix (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
+<p><a name="ldapsuffix"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ldap suffix (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is part of the <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> Samba support for a
password database stored on an LDAP server back-end. These options
are only available if your version of Samba was configured with
the <strong>--with-ldap</strong> option.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the <code>"dn"</code> or LDAP <em>"distinguished name"</em>
+<p>This parameter specifies the <code>"dn"</code> or LDAP <em>"distinguished name"</em>
that tells <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to start from when searching
for an entry in the LDAP password database.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> empty string.</code>
-<p><br><a name="level2oplocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>level2 oplocks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter (new in Samba 2.0.5) controls whether Samba supports
+<p><a name="level2oplocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>level2 oplocks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter (new in Samba 2.0.5) controls whether Samba supports
level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share. In Samba 2.0.5 this parameter
defaults to "False" as the code is new, but will default to "True"
in a later release.
-<p><br>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients that have an
+<p>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients that have an
oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock to a read-only
oplock once a second client opens the file (instead of releasing all
oplocks on a second open, as in traditional, exclusive oplocks). This
@@ -2125,66 +2125,66 @@ allows all openers of the file that support level2 oplocks to cache
the file for read-ahead only (ie. they may not cache writes or lock
requests) and increases performance for many acesses of files that
are not commonly written (such as application .EXE files).
-<p><br>Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock writes to
+<p>Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock writes to
the file all clients are notified (no reply is needed or waited
for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and delete any
read-ahead caches.
-<p><br>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on to speed access
+<p>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on to speed access
to shared executables (and also to test the code :-).
-<p><br>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.
-<p><br>Currently, if <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> are supported
+<p>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.
+<p>Currently, if <a href="smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> are supported
then level2 oplocks are not granted (even if this parameter is set
-to <code>"true"</code>). Note also, the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> parameter must
+to <code>"true"</code>). Note also, the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> parameter must
be set to "true" on this share in order for this parameter to have any
effect.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> parameters.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> level2 oplocks = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> level2 oplocks = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="lmannounce"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lm announce (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will produce
+<p><a name="lmannounce"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lm announce (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will produce
Lanman announce broadcasts that are needed by <strong>OS/2</strong> clients in order
for them to see the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter
can have three values, <code>"true"</code>, <code>"false"</code>, or <code>"auto"</code>. The
default is <code>"auto"</code>. If set to <code>"false"</code> Samba will never produce
these broadcasts. If set to <code>"true"</code> Samba will produce Lanman
-announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm
+announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm
interval"</strong></a>. If set to <code>"auto"</code> Samba will not send Lanman
announce broadcasts by default but will listen for them. If it hears
such a broadcast on the wire it will then start sending them at a
-frequency set by the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm interval"</strong></a>.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm interval"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+frequency set by the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm interval"</strong></a>.
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lminterval"><strong>"lm interval"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> lm announce = auto</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> lm announce = true</code>
-<p><br><a name="lminterval"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lm interval (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce broadcasts needed by
-<strong>OS/2</strong> clients (see the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm announce"</strong></a>
+<p><a name="lminterval"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lm interval (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce broadcasts needed by
+<strong>OS/2</strong> clients (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm announce"</strong></a>
parameter) then this parameter defines the frequency in seconds with
which they will be made. If this is set to zero then no Lanman
-announcements will be made despite the setting of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm
+announcements will be made despite the setting of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm
announce"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm announce"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lmannounce"><strong>"lm announce"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> lm interval = 60</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> lm interval = 120</code>
-<p><br><a name="loadprinters"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>load printers (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>A boolean variable that controls whether all printers in the printcap
+<p><a name="loadprinters"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>load printers (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>A boolean variable that controls whether all printers in the printcap
will be loaded for browsing by default. See the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>"printers"</strong></a> section for more details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>"printers"</strong></a> section for more details.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> load printers = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> load printers = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="localmaster"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>local master (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to try and become a
+<p><a name="localmaster"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>local master (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to try and become a
local master browser on a subnet. If set to False then
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will not attempt to become a local master
browser on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By
@@ -2192,464 +2192,464 @@ default this value is set to true. Setting this value to true doesn't
mean that Samba will <em>become</em> the local master browser on a subnet,
just that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will <em>participate</em> in
elections for local master browser.
-<p><br>Setting this value to False will cause <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>
+<p>Setting this value to False will cause <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a>
<em>never</em> to become a local master browser.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> local master = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="lockdir"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lock dir (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>"lock directory"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="lockdirectory"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lock directory (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option specifies the directory where lock files will be placed.
-The lock files are used to implement the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maxconnections"><strong>"max
+<p><a name="lockdir"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lock dir (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>"lock directory"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="lockdirectory"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lock directory (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option specifies the directory where lock files will be placed.
+The lock files are used to implement the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxconnections"><strong>"max
connections"</strong></a> option.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> lock directory = /tmp/samba</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> lock directory = /usr/local/samba/var/locks</code>
-<p><br><a name="locking"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>locking (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether or not locking will be performed by the server
+<p><a name="locking"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>locking (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether or not locking will be performed by the server
in response to lock requests from the client.
-<p><br>If <code>"locking = no"</code>, all lock and unlock requests will appear to
+<p>If <code>"locking = no"</code>, all lock and unlock requests will appear to
succeed and all lock queries will indicate that the queried lock is
clear.
-<p><br>If <code>"locking = yes"</code>, real locking will be performed by the server.
-<p><br>This option <em>may</em> be useful for read-only filesystems which <em>may</em>
+<p>If <code>"locking = yes"</code>, real locking will be performed by the server.
+<p>This option <em>may</em> be useful for read-only filesystems which <em>may</em>
not need locking (such as cdrom drives), although setting this
parameter of <code>"no"</code> is not really recommended even in this case.
-<p><br>Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a specific
+<p>Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a specific
service, as lack of locking may result in data corruption. You should
never need to set this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> locking = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> locking = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="logfile"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>log file (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This options allows you to override the name of the Samba log file
+<p><a name="logfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>log file (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This options allows you to override the name of the Samba log file
(also known as the debug file).
-<p><br>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
+<p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
separate log files for each user or machine.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> log file = /usr/local/samba/var/log.%m</code>
-<p><br><a name="loglevel"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>log level (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="logondrive"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>logon drive (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the local path to which the home directory
-will be connected (see <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#logonhome"><strong>"logon home"</strong></a>) and is only
+<p><a name="loglevel"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>log level (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="logondrive"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>logon drive (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the local path to which the home directory
+will be connected (see <a href="smb.conf.5.html#logonhome"><strong>"logon home"</strong></a>) and is only
used by NT Workstations.
-<p><br>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> logon drive = h:</code>
-<p><br><a name="logonhome"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>logon home (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the home directory location when a Win95/98 or
+<p><a name="logonhome"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>logon home (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the home directory location when a Win95/98 or
NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC. It allows you to do
-<p><br><code>"NET USE H: /HOME"</code>
-<p><br>from a command prompt, for example.
-<p><br>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
+<p><code>"NET USE H: /HOME"</code>
+<p>from a command prompt, for example.
+<p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
separate logon scripts for each user or machine.
-<p><br>This parameter can be used with Win9X workstations to ensure that
+<p>This parameter can be used with Win9X workstations to ensure that
roaming profiles are stored in a subdirectory of the user's home
directory. This is done in the following way:
-<p><br><code>" logon home = \\%L\%U\profile"</code>
-<p><br>This tells Samba to return the above string, with substitutions made
+<p><code>" logon home = \\%L\%U\profile"</code>
+<p>This tells Samba to return the above string, with substitutions made
when a client requests the info, generally in a NetUserGetInfo request.
Win9X clients truncate the info to \\server\share when a user does <code>"net use /home"</code>,
but use the whole string when dealing with profiles.
-<p><br>Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <code>"logon path"</code> was returned rather than
+<p>Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <code>"logon path"</code> was returned rather than
<code>"logon home"</code>. This broke <code>"net use /home"</code> but allowed profiles outside the
home directory. The current implementation is correct, and can be used for profiles
if you use the above trick.
-<p><br>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> logon home = "\\remote_smb_server\%U"</code>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> logon home = "\\%N\%U"</code>
-<p><br><a name="logonpath"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>logon path (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the home directory where roaming profiles
+<p><a name="logonpath"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>logon path (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the home directory where roaming profiles
(NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are stored. Contrary to previous
versions of these manual pages, it has nothing to do with Win 9X roaming
profiles. To find out how to handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see
the <code>"logon home"</code> parameter.
-<p><br>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
+<p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
separate logon scripts for each user or machine. It also specifies
the directory from which the <code>"application data"</code>, (<code>"desktop"</code>, <code>"start menu"</code>,
<code>"network neighborhood"</code>, <code>"programs"</code> and other folders, and their
contents, are loaded and displayed on your Windows NT client.
-<p><br>The share and the path must be readable by the user for the
+<p>The share and the path must be readable by the user for the
preferences and directories to be loaded onto the Windows NT
client. The share must be writeable when the logs in for the first
time, in order that the Windows NT client can create the NTuser.dat
and other directories.
-<p><br>Thereafter, the directories and any of the contents can, if required, be
+<p>Thereafter, the directories and any of the contents can, if required, be
made read-only. It is not advisable that the NTuser.dat file be made
read-only - rename it to NTuser.man to achieve the desired effect (a
<em>MAN</em>datory profile).
-<p><br>Windows clients can sometimes maintain a connection to the [homes]
+<p>Windows clients can sometimes maintain a connection to the [homes]
share, even though there is no user logged in. Therefore, it is vital
that the logon path does not include a reference to the homes share
(i.e. setting this parameter to <code>\\%N\HOMES\profile_path</code> will cause
problems).
-<p><br>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
+<p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
separate logon scripts for each user or machine.
-<p><br>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> logon path = \\%N\%U\profile</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\HOME_DIR\%U\PROFILE</code>
-<p><br><a name="logonscript"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>logon script (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or NT command file
+<p><a name="logonscript"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>logon script (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or NT command file
(.cmd) to be downloaded and run on a machine when a user successfully
logs in. The file must contain the DOS style cr/lf line endings.
Using a DOS-style editor to create the file is recommended.
-<p><br>The script must be a relative path to the <code>[netlogon]</code> service. If
-the <code>[netlogon]</code> service specifies a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a> of
+<p>The script must be a relative path to the <code>[netlogon]</code> service. If
+the <code>[netlogon]</code> service specifies a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#path"><strong>path</strong></a> of
/usr/local/samba/netlogon, and logon script = STARTUP.BAT, then the
file that will be downloaded is:
-<p><br><code>/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT</code>
-<p><br>The contents of the batch file is entirely your choice. A suggested
+<p><code>/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT</code>
+<p>The contents of the batch file is entirely your choice. A suggested
command would be to add <code>NET TIME \\SERVER /SET /YES</code>, to force every
machine to synchronize clocks with the same time server. Another use
would be to add <code>NET USE U: \\SERVER\UTILS</code> for commonly used
utilities, or <code>NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</code> for example.
-<p><br>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write access to
+<p>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write access to
the <code>[netlogon]</code> share, or to grant users write permission on the
batch files in a secure environment, as this would allow the batch
files to be arbitrarily modified and security to be breached.
-<p><br>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
+<p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have
separate logon scripts for each user or machine.
-<p><br>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> logon script = scripts\%U.bat</code>
-<p><br><a name="lppausecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lppause command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="lppausecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lppause command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to stop printing or spooling a specific print job.
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
and job number to pause the print job. One way of implementing this is
by using job priorities, where jobs having a too low priority won't be
sent to the printer.
-<p><br>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
+<p>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
<code>"%j"</code> is replaced with the job number (an integer). On HPUX (see
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing=hpux</strong></a>), if the <code>"-p%p"</code> option is added
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing=hpux</strong></a>), if the <code>"-p%p"</code> option is added
to the lpq command, the job will show up with the correct status,
i.e. if the job priority is lower than the set fence priority it will
have the PAUSED status, whereas if the priority is equal or higher it
will have the SPOOLED or PRINTING status.
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
lppause command as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
Currently no default value is given to this string, unless the
-value of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>SYSV</code>, in
+value of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>SYSV</code>, in
which case the default is :
-<p><br><code> lp -i %p-%j -H hold</code>
-<p><br>or if the value of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>softq</code>,
+<p><code> lp -i %p-%j -H hold</code>
+<p>or if the value of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>softq</code>,
then the default is:
-<p><br><code> qstat -s -j%j -h</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example for HPUX:</strong>
+<p><code> qstat -s -j%j -h</code>
+<p><strong>Example for HPUX:</strong>
lppause command = /usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p0
-<p><br><a name="lpqcachetime"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lpq cache time (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls how long lpq info will be cached for to prevent the
+<p><a name="lpqcachetime"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lpq cache time (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls how long lpq info will be cached for to prevent the
<strong>lpq</strong> command being called too often. A separate cache is kept for
each variation of the <strong>lpq</strong> command used by the system, so if you
use different <strong>lpq</strong> commands for different users then they won't
share cache information.
-<p><br>The cache files are stored in <code>/tmp/lpq.xxxx</code> where xxxx is a hash of
+<p>The cache files are stored in <code>/tmp/lpq.xxxx</code> where xxxx is a hash of
the <strong>lpq</strong> command in use.
-<p><br>The default is 10 seconds, meaning that the cached results of a
+<p>The default is 10 seconds, meaning that the cached results of a
previous identical <strong>lpq</strong> command will be used if the cached data is
less than 10 seconds old. A large value may be advisable if your
<strong>lpq</strong> command is very slow.
-<p><br>A value of 0 will disable caching completely.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>A value of 0 will disable caching completely.
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> lpq cache time = 10</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> lpq cache time = 30</code>
-<p><br><a name="lpqcommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lpq command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="lpqcommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lpq command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to obtain <code>"lpq"</code>-style printer status information.
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
as its only parameter and outputs printer status information.
-<p><br>Currently eight styles of printer status information are supported;
+<p>Currently eight styles of printer status information are supported;
BSD, AIX, LPRNG, PLP, SYSV, HPUX, QNX and SOFTQ. This covers most UNIX
systems. You control which type is expected using the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing ="</strong></a> option.
-<p><br>Some clients (notably Windows for Workgroups) may not correctly send
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing ="</strong></a> option.
+<p>Some clients (notably Windows for Workgroups) may not correctly send
the connection number for the printer they are requesting status
information about. To get around this, the server reports on the first
printer service connected to by the client. This only happens if the
connection number sent is invalid.
-<p><br>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. Otherwise
+<p>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. Otherwise
it is placed at the end of the command.
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the <strong>lpq
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the <strong>lpq
command</strong> as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> depends on the setting of printing =</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> lpq command = /usr/bin/lpq %p</code>
-<p><br><a name="lpresumecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lpresume command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="lpresumecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lpresume command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to restart or continue printing or spooling a specific print
job.
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
-and job number to resume the print job. See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>"lppause
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+and job number to resume the print job. See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>"lppause
command"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
+<p>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
<code>%j</code> is replaced with the job number (an integer).
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the <strong>lpresume
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the <strong>lpresume
command</strong> as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
-<p><br>Currently no default value is given to this string, unless the
-value of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>SYSV</code>, in
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>Currently no default value is given to this string, unless the
+value of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>SYSV</code>, in
which case the default is :
-<p><br><code> lp -i %p-%j -H resume</code>
-<p><br>or if the value of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>softq</code>,
+<p><code> lp -i %p-%j -H resume</code>
+<p>or if the value of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter is <code>softq</code>,
then the default is:
-<p><br><code> qstat -s -j%j -r</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example for HPUX:</strong>
+<p><code> qstat -s -j%j -r</code>
+<p><strong>Example for HPUX:</strong>
<code> lpresume command = /usr/bin/lpalt %p-%j -p2</code>
-<p><br><a name="lprmcommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>lprm command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="lprmcommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>lprm command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to delete a print job.
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
and job number, and deletes the print job.
-<p><br>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
+<p>If a <code>%p</code> is given then the printername is put in its place. A
<code>%j</code> is replaced with the job number (an integer).
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
<strong>lprm command</strong> as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> depends on the setting of "printing ="</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example 1:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example 1:</strong>
<code> lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example 2:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example 2:</strong>
<code> lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j</code>
-<p><br><a name="machinepasswordtimeout"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>machine password timeout (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If a Samba server is a member of an Windows NT Domain (see the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>) parameter) then
+<p><a name="machinepasswordtimeout"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>machine password timeout (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If a Samba server is a member of an Windows NT Domain (see the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>) parameter) then
periodically a running <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> process will try and
change the <strong>MACHINE ACCOUNT PASWORD</strong> stored in the file called
<code>&lt;Domain&gt;.&lt;Machine&gt;.mac</code> where <code>&lt;Domain&gt;</code> is the name of the
Domain we are a member of and <code>&lt;Machine&gt;</code> is the primary
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>"NetBIOS name"</strong></a> of the machine
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>"NetBIOS name"</strong></a> of the machine
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> is running on. This parameter specifies how
often this password will be changed, in seconds. The default is one
week (expressed in seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member
server.
-<p><br>See also <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>, and the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>) parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>, and the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>) parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> machine password timeout = 604800</code>
-<p><br><a name="magicoutput"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>magic output (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the name of a file which will contain output
-created by a magic script (see the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>"magic
+<p><a name="magicoutput"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>magic output (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the name of a file which will contain output
+created by a magic script (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>"magic
script"</strong></a> parameter below).
-<p><br>Warning: If two clients use the same <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>"magic
+<p>Warning: If two clients use the same <a href="smb.conf.5.html#magicscript"><strong>"magic
script"</strong></a> in the same directory the output file content
is undefined.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> magic output = &lt;magic script name&gt;.out</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> magic output = myfile.txt</code>
-<p><br><a name="magicscript"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>magic script (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the name of a file which, if opened, will be
+<p><a name="magicscript"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>magic script (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the name of a file which, if opened, will be
executed by the server when the file is closed. This allows a UNIX
script to be sent to the Samba host and executed on behalf of the
connected user.
-<p><br>Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon completion,
+<p>Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon completion,
permissions permitting.
-<p><br>If the script generates output, output will be sent to the file
-specified by the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#magicoutput"><strong>"magic output"</strong></a> parameter (see
+<p>If the script generates output, output will be sent to the file
+specified by the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#magicoutput"><strong>"magic output"</strong></a> parameter (see
above).
-<p><br>Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts containing
+<p>Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts containing
carriage-return-linefeed instead of linefeed as the end-of-line
marker. Magic scripts must be executable <em>"as is"</em> on the host,
which for some hosts and some shells will require filtering at the DOS
end.
-<p><br>Magic scripts are <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> and should <em>NOT</em> be relied upon.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>Magic scripts are <em>EXPERIMENTAL</em> and should <em>NOT</em> be relied upon.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> None. Magic scripts disabled.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> magic script = user.csh</code>
-<p><br><a name="manglecase"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangle case (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>See the section on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="manglelocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangle locks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option is was introduced with Samba 2.0.4 and above and has been
+<p><a name="manglecase"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangle case (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>See the section on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="manglelocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangle locks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option is was introduced with Samba 2.0.4 and above and has been
removed in Samba 2.0.6 as Samba now dynamically configures such things
on 32 bit systems.
-<p><br><a name="mangledmap"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangled map (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is for those who want to directly map UNIX file names which can
+<p><a name="mangledmap"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangled map (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is for those who want to directly map UNIX file names which can
not be represented on Windows/DOS. The mangling of names is not always
what is needed. In particular you may have documents with file
extensions that differ between DOS and UNIX. For example, under UNIX
it is common to use <code>".html"</code> for HTML files, whereas under
Windows/DOS <code>".htm"</code> is more commonly used.
-<p><br>So to map <code>"html"</code> to <code>"htm"</code> you would use:
-<p><br><code> mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</code>
-<p><br>One very useful case is to remove the annoying <code>";1"</code> off the ends
+<p>So to map <code>"html"</code> to <code>"htm"</code> you would use:
+<p><code> mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</code>
+<p>One very useful case is to remove the annoying <code>";1"</code> off the ends
of filenames on some CDROMS (only visible under some UNIXs). To do
this use a map of (*;1 *).
-<p><br><strong>default:</strong>
+<p><strong>default:</strong>
<code> no mangled map</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> mangled map = (*;1 *)</code>
-<p><br><a name="manglednames"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangled names (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX should be mapped to
+<p><a name="manglednames"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangled names (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX should be mapped to
DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible, or whether non-DOS
names should simply be ignored.
-<p><br>See the section on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a> for details
+<p>See the section on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a> for details
on how to control the mangling process.
-<p><br>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters before the
+<p>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters before the
rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced to upper case, and
appear as the first (up to) five characters of the mangled name.
-<p><br><li > A tilde <code>"~"</code> is appended to the first part of the mangled
+<p><li > A tilde <code>"~"</code> is appended to the first part of the mangled
name, followed by a two-character unique sequence, based on the
original root name (i.e., the original filename minus its final
extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation
only if it contains any upper case characters or is longer than three
characters.
-<p><br>Note that the character to use may be specified using the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglingchar"><strong>"mangling char"</strong></a> option, if you don't like
+<p>Note that the character to use may be specified using the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglingchar"><strong>"mangling char"</strong></a> option, if you don't like
<code>'~'</code>.
-<p><br><li > The first three alphanumeric characters of the final extension
+<p><li > The first three alphanumeric characters of the final extension
are preserved, forced to upper case and appear as the extension of the
mangled name. The final extension is defined as that part of the
original filename after the rightmost dot. If there are no dots in the
filename, the mangled name will have no extension (except in the case
-of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>"hidden files"</strong></a> - see below).
-<p><br><li > Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be presented as DOS
+of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>"hidden files"</strong></a> - see below).
+<p><li > Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be presented as DOS
hidden files. The mangled name will be created as for other filenames,
but with the leading dot removed and <code>"___"</code> as its extension regardless
of actual original extension (that's three underscores).
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>The two-digit hash value consists of upper case alphanumeric
+<p></dl>
+<p>The two-digit hash value consists of upper case alphanumeric
characters.
-<p><br>This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files in a directory
+<p>This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files in a directory
share the same first five alphanumeric characters. The probability of
such a clash is 1/1300.
-<p><br>The name mangling (if enabled) allows a file to be copied between UNIX
+<p>The name mangling (if enabled) allows a file to be copied between UNIX
directories from Windows/DOS while retaining the long UNIX
filename. UNIX files can be renamed to a new extension from
Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names do not
change between sessions.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> mangled names = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> mangled names = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="manglingchar"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangling char (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls what character is used as the <em>"magic"</em> character in
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#manglednames"><strong>name mangling</strong></a>. The default is a <code>'~'</code> but
+<p><a name="manglingchar"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangling char (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls what character is used as the <em>"magic"</em> character in
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#manglednames"><strong>name mangling</strong></a>. The default is a <code>'~'</code> but
this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set it to
whatever you prefer.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> mangling char = ~</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> mangling char = ^</code>
-<p><br><a name="mangledstack"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>mangled stack (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls the number of mangled names that should be
+<p><a name="mangledstack"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>mangled stack (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls the number of mangled names that should be
cached in the Samba server <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br>This stack is a list of recently mangled base names (extensions are
+<p>This stack is a list of recently mangled base names (extensions are
only maintained if they are longer than 3 characters or contains upper
case characters).
-<p><br>The larger this value, the more likely it is that mangled names can be
+<p>The larger this value, the more likely it is that mangled names can be
successfully converted to correct long UNIX names. However, large
stack sizes will slow most directory access. Smaller stacks save
memory in the server (each stack element costs 256 bytes).
-<p><br>It is not possible to absolutely guarantee correct long file names, so
+<p>It is not possible to absolutely guarantee correct long file names, so
be prepared for some surprises!
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> mangled stack = 50</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> mangled stack = 100</code>
-<p><br><a name="maparchive"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>map archive (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether the DOS archive attribute should be mapped to
+<p><a name="maparchive"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>map archive (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether the DOS archive attribute should be mapped to
the UNIX owner execute bit. The DOS archive bit is set when a file
has been modified since its last backup. One motivation for this
option it to keep Samba/your PC from making any file it touches from
becoming executable under UNIX. This can be quite annoying for shared
source code, documents, etc...
-<p><br>Note that this requires the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
+<p>Note that this requires the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
parameter to be set such that owner execute bit is not masked out
-(i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create
+(i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create
mask"</strong></a> for details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> map archive = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> map archive = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="maphidden"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>map hidden (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether DOS style hidden files should be mapped to the
+<p><a name="maphidden"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>map hidden (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether DOS style hidden files should be mapped to the
UNIX world execute bit.
-<p><br>Note that this requires the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> to be
+<p>Note that this requires the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> to be
set such that the world execute bit is not masked out (i.e. it must
-include 001). See the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
+include 001). See the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
for details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> map hidden = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> map hidden = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="mapsystem"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>map system (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls whether DOS style system files should be mapped to the
+<p><a name="mapsystem"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>map system (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls whether DOS style system files should be mapped to the
UNIX group execute bit.
-<p><br>Note that this requires the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> to be
+<p>Note that this requires the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a> to be
set such that the group execute bit is not masked out (i.e. it must
-include 010). See the parameter <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
+include 010). See the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>"create mask"</strong></a>
for details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> map system = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> map system = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="maptoguest"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>map to guest (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is only useful in <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> modes
-other than <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> - i.e. user,
+<p><a name="maptoguest"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>map to guest (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is only useful in <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> modes
+other than <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> - i.e. user,
server, and domain.
-<p><br>This parameter can take three different values, which tell
+<p>This parameter can take three different values, which tell
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> what to do with user login requests that
don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.
-<p><br>The three settings are :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>"Never"</strong> - Means user login requests with an invalid password
+<p>The three settings are :
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>"Never"</strong> - Means user login requests with an invalid password
are rejected. This is the default.
-<p><br><li > <strong>"Bad User"</strong> - Means user logins with an invalid password are
+<p><li > <strong>"Bad User"</strong> - Means user logins with an invalid password are
rejected, unless the username does not exist, in which case it is
-treated as a guest login and mapped into the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest
+treated as a guest login and mapped into the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest
account"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><li > <strong>"Bad Password"</strong> - Means user logins with an invalid
+<p><li > <strong>"Bad Password"</strong> - Means user logins with an invalid
password are treated as a guest login and mapped into the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. Note that this can
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. Note that this can
cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing their
password will be silently logged on a <strong>"guest"</strong> - and
will not know the reason they cannot access files they think
@@ -2657,291 +2657,291 @@ they should - there will have been no message given to them
that they got their password wrong. Helpdesk services will
<em>*hate*</em> you if you set the <strong>"map to guest"</strong> parameter
this way :-).
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Note that this parameter is needed to set up <strong>"Guest"</strong> share
-services when using <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> modes other than
+<p></dl>
+<p>Note that this parameter is needed to set up <strong>"Guest"</strong> share
+services when using <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security</strong></a> modes other than
share. This is because in these modes the name of the resource being
requested is <em>*not*</em> sent to the server until after the server has
successfully authenticated the client so the server cannot make
authentication decisions at the correct time (connection to the
share) for <strong>"Guest"</strong> shares.
-<p><br>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this parameter
+<p>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this parameter
maps to the old compile-time setting of the GUEST_SESSSETUP value
in local.h.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> map to guest = Never</code>
<strong>Example</strong>:
<code> map to guest = Bad User</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxconnections"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max connections (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service
+<p><a name="maxconnections"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max connections (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service
to be limited. If <strong>"max connections"</strong> is greater than 0 then
connections will be refused if this number of connections to the
service are already open. A value of zero mean an unlimited number of
connections may be made.
-<p><br>Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The lock files
-will be stored in the directory specified by the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>"lock
+<p>Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The lock files
+will be stored in the directory specified by the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lockdirectory"><strong>"lock
directory"</strong></a> option.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max connections = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> max connections = 10</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxdisksize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max disk size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to put an upper limit on the apparent size of
+<p><a name="maxdisksize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max disk size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to put an upper limit on the apparent size of
disks. If you set this option to 100 then all shares will appear to be
not larger than 100 MB in size.
-<p><br>Note that this option does not limit the amount of data you can put on
+<p>Note that this option does not limit the amount of data you can put on
the disk. In the above case you could still store much more than 100
MB on the disk, but if a client ever asks for the amount of free disk
space or the total disk size then the result will be bounded by the
amount specified in <strong>"max disk size"</strong>.
-<p><br>This option is primarily useful to work around bugs in some pieces of
+<p>This option is primarily useful to work around bugs in some pieces of
software that can't handle very large disks, particularly disks over
1GB in size.
-<p><br>A <strong>"max disk size"</strong> of 0 means no limit.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>A <strong>"max disk size"</strong> of 0 means no limit.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max disk size = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> max disk size = 1000</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxlogsize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max log size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies the max size the log
+<p><a name="maxlogsize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max log size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies the max size the log
file should grow to. Samba periodically checks the size and if it is
exceeded it will rename the file, adding a <code>".old"</code> extension.
-<p><br>A size of 0 means no limit.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>A size of 0 means no limit.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max log size = 5000</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> max log size = 1000</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxmux"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max mux (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option controls the maximum number of outstanding simultaneous
+<p><a name="maxmux"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max mux (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option controls the maximum number of outstanding simultaneous
SMB operations that samba tells the client it will allow. You should
never need to set this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max mux = 50</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxopenfiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max open files (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter limits the maximum number of open files that one
+<p><a name="maxopenfiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max open files (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter limits the maximum number of open files that one
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> file serving process may have open for
a client at any one time. The default for this parameter is set
very high (10,000) as Samba uses only one bit per unopened file.
-<p><br>The limit of the number of open files is usually set by the
+<p>The limit of the number of open files is usually set by the
UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than this parameter
so you should never need to touch this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max open files = 10000</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxpacket"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max packet (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#packetsize"><strong>"packet size"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="maxttl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max ttl (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> what the default 'time
+<p><a name="maxpacket"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max packet (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#packetsize"><strong>"packet size"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="maxttl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max ttl (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> what the default 'time
to live' of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds) when
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> is requesting a name using either a
broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should never need to
change this parameter. The default is 3 days.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max ttl = 259200</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxwinsttl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max wins ttl (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
-server <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>(wins support =true)</strong></a> what the maximum
+<p><a name="maxwinsttl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max wins ttl (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
+server <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>(wins support =true)</strong></a> what the maximum
'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
parameter. The default is 6 days (518400 seconds).
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minwinsttl"><strong>"min wins ttl"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minwinsttl"><strong>"min wins ttl"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max wins ttl = 518400</code>
-<p><br><a name="maxxmit"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>max xmit (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option controls the maximum packet size that will be negotiated
+<p><a name="maxxmit"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>max xmit (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option controls the maximum packet size that will be negotiated
by Samba. The default is 65535, which is the maximum. In some cases
you may find you get better performance with a smaller value. A value
below 2048 is likely to cause problems.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> max xmit = 65535</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> max xmit = 8192</code>
-<p><br><a name="messagecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>message command (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies what command to run when the server receives a WinPopup
+<p><a name="messagecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>message command (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies what command to run when the server receives a WinPopup
style message.
-<p><br>This would normally be a command that would deliver the message
+<p>This would normally be a command that would deliver the message
somehow. How this is to be done is up to your imagination.
-<p><br>An example is:
-<p><br><code> message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &amp;</code>
-<p><br>This delivers the message using <strong>xedit</strong>, then removes it
+<p>An example is:
+<p><code> message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &amp;</code>
+<p>This delivers the message using <strong>xedit</strong>, then removes it
afterwards. <em>NOTE THAT IT IS VERY IMPORTANT THAT THIS COMMAND RETURN
IMMEDIATELY</em>. That's why I have the <code>'&amp;'</code> on the end. If it doesn't
return immediately then your PCs may freeze when sending messages
(they should recover after 30secs, hopefully).
-<p><br>All messages are delivered as the global guest user. The command takes
-the standard substitutions, although <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> won't work
-(<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%U</strong></a> may be better in this case).
-<p><br>Apart from the standard substitutions, some additional ones apply. In
+<p>All messages are delivered as the global guest user. The command takes
+the standard substitutions, although <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> won't work
+(<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentU"><strong>%U</strong></a> may be better in this case).
+<p>Apart from the standard substitutions, some additional ones apply. In
particular:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <code>"%s"</code> = the filename containing the message.
-<p><br><li > <code>"%t"</code> = the destination that the message was sent to (probably the server
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <code>"%s"</code> = the filename containing the message.
+<p><li > <code>"%t"</code> = the destination that the message was sent to (probably the server
name).
-<p><br><li > <code>"%f"</code> = who the message is from.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>You could make this command send mail, or whatever else takes your
+<p><li > <code>"%f"</code> = who the message is from.
+<p></dl>
+<p>You could make this command send mail, or whatever else takes your
fancy. Please let us know of any really interesting ideas you have.
-<p><br>Here's a way of sending the messages as mail to root:
-<p><br><code>message command = /bin/mail -s 'message from %f on %m' root &lt; %s; rm %s</code>
-<p><br>If you don't have a message command then the message won't be
+<p>Here's a way of sending the messages as mail to root:
+<p><code>message command = /bin/mail -s 'message from %f on %m' root &lt; %s; rm %s</code>
+<p>If you don't have a message command then the message won't be
delivered and Samba will tell the sender there was an
error. Unfortunately WfWg totally ignores the error code and carries
on regardless, saying that the message was delivered.
-<p><br>If you want to silently delete it then try:
-<p><br><code>"message command = rm %s"</code>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>If you want to silently delete it then try:
+<p><code>"message command = rm %s"</code>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> no message command</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &amp;</code>
-<p><br><a name="minprintspace"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>min print space (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This sets the minimum amount of free disk space that must be available
+<p><a name="minprintspace"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>min print space (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This sets the minimum amount of free disk space that must be available
before a user will be able to spool a print job. It is specified in
kilobytes. The default is 0, which means a user can always spool a print
job.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>printing</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> min print space = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> min print space = 2000</code>
-<p><br><a name="minpasswdlength"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>min passwd length (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#minpasswordlength"><strong>"min password length"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="minpasswordlength"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>min password length (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option sets the minimum length in characters of a plaintext password
+<p><a name="minpasswdlength"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>min passwd length (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#minpasswordlength"><strong>"min password length"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="minpasswordlength"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>min password length (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option sets the minimum length in characters of a plaintext password
than smbd will accept when performing UNIX password changing.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>"passwd chat
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>"passwd chat
debug"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> min password length = 5</code>
-<p><br><a name="minwinsttl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>min wins ttl (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
-server <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>(wins support = true)</strong></a> what the minimum
+<p><a name="minwinsttl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>min wins ttl (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option tells <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> when acting as a WINS
+server <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winssupport"><strong>(wins support = true)</strong></a> what the minimum
'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
parameter. The default is 6 hours (21600 seconds).
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> min wins ttl = 21600</code>
-<p><br><a name="nameresolveorder"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>name resolve order (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option is used by the programs in the Samba suite to determine
+<p><a name="nameresolveorder"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>name resolve order (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba suite to determine
what naming services and in what order to resolve host names to IP
addresses. The option takes a space separated string of different name
resolution options.
-<p><br>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause
+<p>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause
names to be resolved as follows :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>lmhosts</strong> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file.
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>lmhosts</strong> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file.
If the line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the NetBIOS
name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><strong>lmhosts (5)</strong></a> for details) then
any name type matches for lookup.
-<p><br><li > <strong>host</strong> : Do a standard host name to IP address resolution,
+<p><li > <strong>host</strong> : Do a standard host name to IP address resolution,
using the system /etc/hosts, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name
resolution is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or
Solaris this may be controlled by the <em>/etc/nsswitch.conf</em> file).
Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name type being
queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise it is ignored.
-<p><br><li > <strong>wins</strong> : Query a name with the IP address listed in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins server</strong></a> parameter. If no WINS server has
+<p><li > <strong>wins</strong> : Query a name with the IP address listed in the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins server</strong></a> parameter. If no WINS server has
been specified this method will be ignored.
-<p><br><li > <strong>bcast</strong> : Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
-listed in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a> parameter. This is the
+<p><li > <strong>bcast</strong> : Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
+listed in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a> parameter. This is the
least reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the
target host being on a locally connected subnet.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p></dl>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> name resolve order = lmhosts host wins bcast</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> name resolve order = lmhosts bcast host</code>
-<p><br>This will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined first, followed
+<p>This will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined first, followed
by a broadcast attempt, followed by a normal system hostname lookup.
-<p><br><a name="netbiosaliases"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>netbios aliases (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of NetBIOS names that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
+<p><a name="netbiosaliases"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>netbios aliases (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
advertise as additional names by which the Samba server is known. This
allows one machine to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If
-a machine is acting as a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>browse server</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a> none of these names will be
+a machine is acting as a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>browse server</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a> none of these names will be
advertised as either browse server or logon servers, only the primary
name of the machine will be advertised with these capabilities.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>"netbios name"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname"><strong>"netbios name"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> empty string (no additional names)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> netbios aliases = TEST TEST1 TEST2</code>
-<p><br><a name="netbiosname"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>netbios name (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba server is known. By
+<p><a name="netbiosname"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>netbios name (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba server is known. By
default it is the same as the first component of the host's DNS name.
-If a machine is a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>browse server</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a> this name (or the first component
+If a machine is a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#localmaster"><strong>browse server</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a> this name (or the first component
of the hosts DNS name) will be the name that these services are
advertised under.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>"netbios aliases"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>"netbios aliases"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> Machine DNS name.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> netbios name = MYNAME</code>
-<p><br><a name="netbiosscope"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>netbios scope (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will operate under. This should
+<p><a name="netbiosscope"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>netbios scope (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will operate under. This should
not be set unless every machine on your LAN also sets this value.
-<p><br><a name="nishomedir"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>nis homedir (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For UNIX systems that use an
+<p><a name="nishomedir"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>nis homedir (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For UNIX systems that use an
automounter, the user's home directory will often be mounted on a
workstation on demand from a remote server.
-<p><br>When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory server,
+<p>When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory server,
but is mounting the home directories via NFS then two network hops
would be required to access the users home directory if the logon
server told the client to use itself as the SMB server for home
directories (one over SMB and one over NFS). This can be very
slow.
-<p><br>This option allows Samba to return the home share as being on a
+<p>This option allows Samba to return the home share as being on a
different server to the logon server and as long as a Samba daemon is
running on the home directory server, it will be mounted on the Samba
client directly from the directory server. When Samba is returning the
home share to the client, it will consult the NIS map specified in
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homedirmap"><strong>"homedir map"</strong></a> and return the server listed
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#homedirmap"><strong>"homedir map"</strong></a> and return the server listed
there.
-<p><br>Note that for this option to work there must be a working NIS
+<p>Note that for this option to work there must be a working NIS
system and the Samba server with this option must also be a
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainlogons"><strong>logon server</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> nis homedir = false</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> nis homedir = true</code>
-<p><br><a name="ntaclsupport"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>nt acl support (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
+<p><a name="ntaclsupport"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>nt acl support (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will attempt to map UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> nt acl support = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> nt acl support = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="ntpipesupport"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>nt pipe support (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
+<p><a name="ntpipesupport"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>nt pipe support (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will allow Windows NT clients to connect to the NT SMB specific
<code>IPC$</code> pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left
alone.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> nt pipe support = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="ntsmbsupport"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>nt smb support (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
+<p><a name="ntsmbsupport"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>nt smb support (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will negotiate NT specific SMB support with Windows NT
clients. Although this is a developer debugging option and should be
left alone, benchmarking has discovered that Windows NT clients give
@@ -2950,19 +2950,19 @@ being investigated. If this option is set to <code>"no"</code> then Samba
offers exactly the same SMB calls that versions prior to Samba2.0
offered. This information may be of use if any users are having
problems with NT SMB support.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> nt support = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="nullpasswords"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>null passwords (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Allow or disallow client access to accounts that have null passwords.
-<p><br>See also <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd (5)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><a name="nullpasswords"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>null passwords (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Allow or disallow client access to accounts that have null passwords.
+<p>See also <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd (5)</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> null passwords = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> null passwords = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="olelockingcompatibility"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ole locking compatibility (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter allows an administrator to turn off the byte range lock
+<p><a name="olelockingcompatibility"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ole locking compatibility (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter allows an administrator to turn off the byte range lock
manipulation that is done within Samba to give compatibility for OLE
applications. Windows OLE applications use byte range locking as a
form of inter-process communication, by locking ranges of bytes around
@@ -2970,467 +2970,467 @@ the 2^32 region of a file range. This can cause certain UNIX lock
managers to crash or otherwise cause problems. Setting this parameter
to <code>"no"</code> means you trust your UNIX lock manager to handle such cases
correctly.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ole locking compatibility = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> ole locking compatibility = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="onlyguest"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>only guest (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>A synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="onlyuser"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>only user (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean option that controls whether connections with
-usernames not in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a> list will be allowed. By
+<p><a name="onlyguest"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>only guest (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>A synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="onlyuser"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>only user (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean option that controls whether connections with
+usernames not in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user=</strong></a> list will be allowed. By
default this option is disabled so a client can supply a username to
be used by the server.
-<p><br>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce usernames from the
-service name. This can be annoying for the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>
-section. To get around this you could use "<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a> =
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>" which means your <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> list
+<p>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce usernames from the
+service name. This can be annoying for the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a>
+section. To get around this you could use "<a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a> =
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>%S</strong></a>" which means your <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> list
will be just the service name, which for home directories is the name
of the user.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>user</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> only user = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> only user = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="oplocks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>oplocks (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean option tells smbd whether to issue oplocks (opportunistic
+<p><a name="oplocks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>oplocks (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean option tells smbd whether to issue oplocks (opportunistic
locks) to file open requests on this share. The oplock code can
dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve the speed of access to files
on Samba servers. It allows the clients to aggressively cache files
locally and you may want to disable this option for unreliable network
environments (it is turned on by default in Windows NT Servers). For
more information see the file Speed.txt in the Samba docs/ directory.
-<p><br>Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files on a per share basis.
+<p>Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files on a per share basis.
See the 'veto oplock files' parameter. On some systems oplocks are recognized
by the underlying operating system. This allows data synchronization between
all access to oplocked files, whether it be via Samba or NFS or a local
-UNIX process. See the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>kernel oplocks</strong></a> parameter
+UNIX process. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>kernel oplocks</strong></a> parameter
for details.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>"level2 oplocks"</strong></a> parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#kerneloplocks"><strong>"kernel oplocks"</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#level2oplocks"><strong>"level2 oplocks"</strong></a> parameters.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> oplocks = True</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> oplocks = False</code>
-<p><br><a name="oplockbreakwaittime"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>oplock break wait time (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in both Windows 9x and WinNT.
+<p><a name="oplockbreakwaittime"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>oplock break wait time (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in both Windows 9x and WinNT.
If Samba responds to a client too quickly when that client issues an SMB that
can cause an oplock break request, then the client redirector can fail and
not respond to the break request. This tuning parameter (which is set in
milliseconds) is the amount of time Samba will wait before sending an
oplock break request to such (broken) clients.
-<p><br><em>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA
+<p><em>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA
OPLOCK CODE</em>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> oplock break wait time = 10</code>
-<p><br><a name="oplockcontentionlimit"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>oplock contention limit (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a <em>very</em> advanced <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> tuning option to improve
+<p><a name="oplockcontentionlimit"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>oplock contention limit (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a <em>very</em> advanced <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> tuning option to improve
the efficiency of the granting of oplocks under multiple client contention for the same file.
-<p><br>In brief it specifies a number, which causes smbd not to grant an oplock even
+<p>In brief it specifies a number, which causes smbd not to grant an oplock even
when requested if the approximate number of clients contending for an oplock on
the same file goes over this limit. This causes <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to
behave in a similar way to Windows NT.
-<p><br><em>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA
+<p><em>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA
OPLOCK CODE</em>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> oplock contention limit = 2</code>
-<p><br><a name="oslevel"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>os level (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This integer value controls what level Samba advertises itself as for
+<p><a name="oslevel"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>os level (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This integer value controls what level Samba advertises itself as for
browse elections. The value of this parameter determines whether
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> has a chance of becoming a local master
-browser for the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>WORKGROUP</strong></a> in the local broadcast
+browser for the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>WORKGROUP</strong></a> in the local broadcast
area. The default is zero, which means <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
lose elections to Windows machines. See BROWSING.txt in the Samba
docs/ directory for details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> os level = 20</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> os level = 65 ; This will win against any NT Server</code>
-<p><br><a name="packetsize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>packet size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a deprecated parameter that has no effect on the current
+<p><a name="packetsize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>packet size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a deprecated parameter that has no effect on the current
Samba code. It is left in the parameter list to prevent breaking
old <strong>smb.conf</strong> files.
-<p><br><a name="panicaction"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>panic action (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a Samba developer option that allows a system command to be
+<p><a name="panicaction"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>panic action (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a Samba developer option that allows a system command to be
called when either <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> or
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> crashes. This is usually used to draw
attention to the fact that a problem occurred.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> panic action = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><a name="passwdchat"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>passwd chat (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This string controls the <em>"chat"</em> conversation that takes places
+<p><a name="passwdchat"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>passwd chat (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This string controls the <em>"chat"</em> conversation that takes places
between <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> and the local password changing
program to change the users password. The string describes a sequence
of response-receive pairs that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> uses to
-determine what to send to the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>passwd</strong></a> program
+determine what to send to the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>passwd</strong></a> program
and what to expect back. If the expected output is not received then
the password is not changed.
-<p><br>This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending on what
+<p>This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending on what
local methods are used for password control (such as NIS etc).
-<p><br>The string can contain the macros <code>"%o"</code> and <code>"%n"</code> which are
+<p>The string can contain the macros <code>"%o"</code> and <code>"%n"</code> which are
substituted for the old and new passwords respectively. It can also
contain the standard macros <code>"\n"</code>, <code>"\r"</code>, <code>"\t"</code> and <code>"\s"</code>
to give line-feed, carriage-return, tab and space.
-<p><br>The string can also contain a <code>'*'</code> which matches any sequence of
+<p>The string can also contain a <code>'*'</code> which matches any sequence of
characters.
-<p><br>Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces in them into
+<p>Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces in them into
a single string.
-<p><br>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence is a fullstop
+<p>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence is a fullstop
<code>"."</code> then no string is sent. Similarly, is the expect string is a
fullstop then no string is expected.
-<p><br>Note that if the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>
+<p>Note that if the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>
parameter is set to true, then this sequence is called <em>*AS ROOT*</em>
when the SMB password in the smbpasswd file is being changed, without
access to the old password cleartext. In this case the old password
cleartext is set to <code>""</code> (the empty string).
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>"passwd chat
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchatdebug"><strong>"passwd chat
debug"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<pre>
passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\n "*Enter NEW password*" %n\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\n "*Password changed*"
</pre>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<pre>
passwd chat = *old*password* %o\n *new*password* %n\n *new*password* %n\n *changed*
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="passwdchatdebug"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>passwd chat debug (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script parameter is run in
+<p><a name="passwdchatdebug"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>passwd chat debug (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script parameter is run in
<code>"debug"</code> mode. In this mode the strings passed to and received from
the passwd chat are printed in the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> log with
-a <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a> of 100. This is a dangerous
+a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#debuglevel"><strong>"debug level"</strong></a> of 100. This is a dangerous
option as it will allow plaintext passwords to be seen in the
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> log. It is available to help Samba admins
-debug their <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd chat"</strong></a> scripts when calling
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and should be turned off
+debug their <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd chat"</strong></a> scripts when calling
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a> and should be turned off
after this has been done. This parameter is off by default.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd chat"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd chat"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd
program"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> passwd chat debug = True</code>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> passwd chat debug = False</code>
-<p><br><a name="passwdprogram"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>passwd program (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The name of a program that can be used to set UNIX user passwords.
-Any occurrences of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> will be replaced with the
+<p><a name="passwdprogram"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>passwd program (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The name of a program that can be used to set UNIX user passwords.
+Any occurrences of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> will be replaced with the
user name. The user name is checked for existence before calling the
password changing program.
-<p><br>Also note that many passwd programs insist in <em>"reasonable"</em>
+<p>Also note that many passwd programs insist in <em>"reasonable"</em>
passwords, such as a minimum length, or the inclusion of mixed case
chars and digits. This can pose a problem as some clients (such as
Windows for Workgroups) uppercase the password before sending it.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that if the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>
+<p><em>Note</em> that if the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>
parameter is set to <code>"True"</code> then this program is called <em>*AS
ROOT*</em> before the SMB password in the
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file is changed. If this UNIX
password change fails, then <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will fail to
change the SMB password also (this is by design).
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a> parameter is
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a> parameter is
set this parameter <em>MUST USE ABSOLUTE PATHS</em> for <em>ALL</em> programs
called, and must be examined for security implications. Note that by
-default <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a> is set to
+default <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a> is set to
<code>"False"</code>.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#unixpasswordsync"><strong>"unix password sync"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> passwd program = /bin/passwd</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> passwd program = /sbin/passwd %u</code>
-<p><br><a name="passwordlevel"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>password level (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Some client/server combinations have difficulty with mixed-case
+<p><a name="passwordlevel"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>password level (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Some client/server combinations have difficulty with mixed-case
passwords. One offending client is Windows for Workgroups, which for
some reason forces passwords to upper case when using the LANMAN1
protocol, but leaves them alone when using COREPLUS!
-<p><br>This parameter defines the maximum number of characters that may be
+<p>This parameter defines the maximum number of characters that may be
upper case in passwords.
-<p><br>For example, say the password given was <code>"FRED"</code>. If <strong>password
+<p>For example, say the password given was <code>"FRED"</code>. If <strong>password
level</strong> is set to 1, the following combinations would be tried if
<code>"FRED"</code> failed:
-<p><br><code>"Fred"</code>, <code>"fred"</code>, <code>"fRed"</code>, <code>"frEd"</code>, <code>"freD"</code>
-<p><br>If <strong>password level</strong> was set to 2, the following combinations would
+<p><code>"Fred"</code>, <code>"fred"</code>, <code>"fRed"</code>, <code>"frEd"</code>, <code>"freD"</code>
+<p>If <strong>password level</strong> was set to 2, the following combinations would
also be tried:
-<p><br><code>"FRed"</code>, <code>"FrEd"</code>, <code>"FreD"</code>, <code>"fREd"</code>, <code>"fReD"</code>,
+<p><code>"FRed"</code>, <code>"FrEd"</code>, <code>"FreD"</code>, <code>"fREd"</code>, <code>"fReD"</code>,
<code>"frED"</code>, <code>..</code>
-<p><br>And so on.
-<p><br>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely it is that a
+<p>And so on.
+<p>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely it is that a
mixed case password will be matched against a single case
password. However, you should be aware that use of this parameter
reduces security and increases the time taken to process a new
connection.
-<p><br>A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be made - the password
+<p>A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be made - the password
as is and the password in all-lower case.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> password level = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> password level = 4</code>
-<p><br><a name="passwordserver"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>password server (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>By specifying the name of another SMB server (such as a WinNT box)
-with this option, and using <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security = domain"</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security = server"</strong></a> you can get Samba to do all
+<p><a name="passwordserver"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>password server (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>By specifying the name of another SMB server (such as a WinNT box)
+with this option, and using <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security = domain"</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security = server"</strong></a> you can get Samba to do all
its username/password validation via a remote server.
-<p><br>This options sets the name of the password server to use. It must be a
+<p>This options sets the name of the password server to use. It must be a
NetBIOS name, so if the machine's NetBIOS name is different from its
internet name then you may have to add its NetBIOS name to the lmhosts
file which is stored in the same directory as the <strong>smb.conf</strong> file.
-<p><br>The name of the password server is looked up using the parameter
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>"name resolve order="</strong></a> and so may resolved
+<p>The name of the password server is looked up using the parameter
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>"name resolve order="</strong></a> and so may resolved
by any method and order described in that parameter.
-<p><br>The password server much be a machine capable of using the "LM1.2X002"
+<p>The password server much be a machine capable of using the "LM1.2X002"
or the "LM NT 0.12" protocol, and it must be in user level security
mode.
-<p><br>NOTE: Using a password server means your UNIX box (running Samba) is
+<p>NOTE: Using a password server means your UNIX box (running Samba) is
only as secure as your password server. <em>DO NOT CHOOSE A PASSWORD
SERVER THAT YOU DON'T COMPLETELY TRUST</em>.
-<p><br>Never point a Samba server at itself for password serving. This will
+<p>Never point a Samba server at itself for password serving. This will
cause a loop and could lock up your Samba server!
-<p><br>The name of the password server takes the standard substitutions, but
-probably the only useful one is <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentm"><strong>%m</strong></a>, which means
+<p>The name of the password server takes the standard substitutions, but
+probably the only useful one is <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentm"><strong>%m</strong></a>, which means
the Samba server will use the incoming client as the password
server. If you use this then you better trust your clients, and you
better restrict them with hosts allow!
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter is set to
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter is set to
<strong>"domain"</strong>, then the list of machines in this option must be a list
of Primary or Backup Domain controllers for the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>Domain</strong></a> or the character <code>*</code>, as the Samba server is cryptographicly
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>Domain</strong></a> or the character <code>*</code>, as the Samba server is cryptographicly
in that domain, and will use cryptographicly authenticated RPC calls
to authenticate the user logging on. The advantage of using
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a> is that if you list
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a> is that if you list
several hosts in the <strong>"password server"</strong> option then
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will try each in turn till it finds one
that responds. This is useful in case your primary server goes down.
-<p><br>If the <strong>"password server"</strong> option is set to the character <code>*</code>,
+<p>If the <strong>"password server"</strong> option is set to the character <code>*</code>,
then Samba will attempt to auto-locate the Primary or Backup Domain controllers
to authenticate against by doing a query for the name <code>WORKGROUP&lt;1C&gt;</code>
and then contacting each server returned in the list of IP addresses
-from the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolution</strong></a> source.
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter is set to
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"server"</strong></a>, then there are different
-restrictions that <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>
+from the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolution</strong></a> source.
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter is set to
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"server"</strong></a>, then there are different
+restrictions that <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>
doesn't suffer from:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > You may list several password servers in the <strong>"password server"</strong>
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > You may list several password servers in the <strong>"password server"</strong>
parameter, however if an <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> makes a connection
to a password server, and then the password server fails, no more
users will be able to be authenticated from this
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>. This is a restriction of the SMB/CIFS
-protocol when in <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> mode
+protocol when in <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> mode
and cannot be fixed in Samba.
-<p><br><li > If you are using a Windows NT server as your password server then
+<p><li > If you are using a Windows NT server as your password server then
you will have to ensure that your users are able to login from the
Samba server, as when in
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> mode the network
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security=server"</strong></a> mode the network
logon will appear to come from there rather than from the users
workstation.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p></dl>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>"security"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> password server = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> password server = NT-PDC, NT-BDC1, NT-BDC2</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> password server = *</code>
-<p><br><a name="path"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>path (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies a directory to which the user of the service
+<p><a name="path"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>path (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies a directory to which the user of the service
is to be given access. In the case of printable services, this is
where print data will spool prior to being submitted to the host for
printing.
-<p><br>For a printable service offering guest access, the service should be
+<p>For a printable service offering guest access, the service should be
readonly and the path should be world-writeable and have the sticky bit
set. This is not mandatory of course, but you probably won't get the
results you expect if you do otherwise.
-<p><br>Any occurrences of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> in the path will be replaced
+<p>Any occurrences of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentu"><strong>%u</strong></a> in the path will be replaced
with the UNIX username that the client is using on this
-connection. Any occurrences of <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentm"><strong>%m</strong></a> will be replaced
+connection. Any occurrences of <a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentm"><strong>%m</strong></a> will be replaced
by the NetBIOS name of the machine they are connecting from. These
replacements are very useful for setting up pseudo home directories
for users.
-<p><br>Note that this path will be based on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootdir"><strong>"root dir"</strong></a> if
+<p>Note that this path will be based on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootdir"><strong>"root dir"</strong></a> if
one was specified.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> path = /home/fred</code>
-<p><br><a name="postexec"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>postexec (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option specifies a command to be run whenever the service is
+<p><a name="postexec"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>postexec (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever the service is
disconnected. It takes the usual substitutions. The command may be run
as the root on some systems.
-<p><br>An interesting example may be do unmount server resources:
-<p><br><code>postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</code>
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>An interesting example may be do unmount server resources:
+<p><code>postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</code>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>preexec</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none (no command executed)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> postexec = echo "%u disconnected from %S from %m (%I)" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</code>
-<p><br><a name="postscript"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>postscript (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter forces a printer to interpret the print files as
+<p><a name="postscript"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>postscript (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter forces a printer to interpret the print files as
postscript. This is done by adding a <code>%!</code> to the start of print output.
-<p><br>This is most useful when you have lots of PCs that persist in putting
+<p>This is most useful when you have lots of PCs that persist in putting
a control-D at the start of print jobs, which then confuses your
printer.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> postscript = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> postscript = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="preexec"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>preexec (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option specifies a command to be run whenever the service is
+<p><a name="preexec"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>preexec (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever the service is
connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.
-<p><br>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome message every
+<p>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome message every
time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here is an example:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" | /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' &amp;
</pre>
-<p><br>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>preexec close</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>postexec</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>preexec close</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>postexec</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> none (no command executed)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> preexec = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</code>
-<p><br><a name="preexecclose"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>preexec close (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero return code from
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a> should close the service being connected to.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><a name="preexecclose"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>preexec close (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero return code from
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a> should close the service being connected to.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> preexec close = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> preexec close = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="preferredmaster"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>preferred master (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> is a
+<p><a name="preferredmaster"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>preferred master (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> is a
preferred master browser for its workgroup.
-<p><br>If this is set to true, on startup, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
+<p>If this is set to true, on startup, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
force an election, and it will have a slight advantage in winning the
election. It is recommended that this parameter is used in
-conjunction with <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#domainmaster"><strong>"domain master = yes"</strong></a>, so
+conjunction with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#domainmaster"><strong>"domain master = yes"</strong></a>, so
that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> can guarantee becoming a domain
master.
-<p><br>Use this option with caution, because if there are several hosts
+<p>Use this option with caution, because if there are several hosts
(whether Samba servers, Windows 95 or NT) that are preferred master
browsers on the same subnet, they will each periodically and
continuously attempt to become the local master browser. This will
result in unnecessary broadcast traffic and reduced browsing
capabilities.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oslevel"><strong>os level</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oslevel"><strong>os level</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> preferred master = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> preferred master = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="preferedmaster"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>prefered master (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preferredmaster"><strong>"preferred master"</strong></a> for people
+<p><a name="preferedmaster"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>prefered master (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preferredmaster"><strong>"preferred master"</strong></a> for people
who cannot spell :-).
-<p><br><a name="preload"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>preload</strong></strong>
-Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#autoservices"><strong>"auto services"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="preservecase"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>preserve case (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls if new filenames are created with the case that the
+<p><a name="preload"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>preload</strong></strong><dd>
+Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#autoservices"><strong>"auto services"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="preservecase"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>preserve case (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls if new filenames are created with the case that the
client passes, or if they are forced to be the <code>"default"</code> case.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> preserve case = yes</code>
-<p><br>See the section on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a> for a
+<p>See the section on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>"NAME MANGLING"</strong></a> for a
fuller discussion.
-<p><br><a name="printcommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>print command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>After a print job has finished spooling to a service, this command
+<p><a name="printcommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>print command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>After a print job has finished spooling to a service, this command
will be used via a <code>system()</code> call to process the spool
file. Typically the command specified will submit the spool file to
the host's printing subsystem, but there is no requirement that this
be the case. The server will not remove the spool file, so whatever
command you specify should remove the spool file when it has been
processed, otherwise you will need to manually remove old spool files.
-<p><br>The print command is simply a text string. It will be used verbatim,
+<p>The print command is simply a text string. It will be used verbatim,
with two exceptions: All occurrences of <code>"%s"</code> and <code>"%f"</code> will be
replaced by the appropriate spool file name, and all occurrences of
<code>"%p"</code> will be replaced by the appropriate printer name. The spool
file name is generated automatically by the server, the printer name
is discussed below.
-<p><br>The print command <em>MUST</em> contain at least one occurrence of <code>"%s"</code>
+<p>The print command <em>MUST</em> contain at least one occurrence of <code>"%s"</code>
or <code>"%f"</code> - the <code>"%p"</code> is optional. At the time a job is
submitted, if no printer name is supplied the <code>"%p"</code> will be
silently removed from the printer command.
-<p><br>If specified in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>"[global]"</strong></a> section, the print
+<p>If specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>"[global]"</strong></a> section, the print
command given will be used for any printable service that does not
have its own print command specified.
-<p><br>If there is neither a specified print command for a printable service
+<p>If there is neither a specified print command for a printable service
nor a global print command, spool files will be created but not
processed and (most importantly) not removed.
-<p><br>Note that printing may fail on some UNIXs from the <code>"nobody"</code>
+<p>Note that printing may fail on some UNIXs from the <code>"nobody"</code>
account. If this happens then create an alternative guest account that
-can print and set the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a> in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>"[global]"</strong></a> section.
-<p><br>You can form quite complex print commands by realizing that they are
+can print and set the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a> in the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>"[global]"</strong></a> section.
+<p>You can form quite complex print commands by realizing that they are
just passed to a shell. For example the following will log a print
job, print the file, then remove it. Note that <code>';'</code> is the usual
separator for command in shell scripts.
-<p><br><code>print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt; /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</code>
-<p><br>You may have to vary this command considerably depending on how you
+<p><code>print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt; /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</code>
+<p>You may have to vary this command considerably depending on how you
normally print files on your system. The default for the parameter
-varies depending on the setting of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a>
+varies depending on the setting of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a>
parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
- For <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG or PLP :
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
+ For <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG or PLP :
<code> print command = lpr -r -P%p %s</code>
-<p><br>For <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> SYS or HPUX :
+<p>For <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> SYS or HPUX :
<code> print command = lp -c -d%p %s; rm %s</code>
-<p><br>For <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> SOFTQ :
+<p>For <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printing"><strong>"printing="</strong></a> SOFTQ :
<code> print command = lp -d%p -s %s; rm %s</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s</code>
-<p><br><a name="printok"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>print ok (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>printable</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="printable"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printable (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this parameter is <code>"yes"</code>, then clients may open, write to and
+<p><a name="printok"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>print ok (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>printable</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="printable"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printable (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this parameter is <code>"yes"</code>, then clients may open, write to and
submit spool files on the directory specified for the service.
-<p><br>Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing to the service
+<p>Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing to the service
path (user privileges permitting) via the spooling of print data. The
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a> parameter controls only non-printing
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a> parameter controls only non-printing
access to the resource.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> printable = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> printable = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="printcap"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printcap (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>printcapname</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="printcapname"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printcap name (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter may be used to override the compiled-in default
+<p><a name="printcap"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printcap (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcapname"><strong>printcapname</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="printcapname"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printcap name (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter may be used to override the compiled-in default
printcap name used by the server (usually /etc/printcap). See the
-discussion of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> section above for
+discussion of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> section above for
reasons why you might want to do this.
-<p><br>On System V systems that use <strong>lpstat</strong> to list available printers you
+<p>On System V systems that use <strong>lpstat</strong> to list available printers you
can use <code>"printcap name = lpstat"</code> to automatically obtain lists of
available printers. This is the default for systems that define SYSV
at configure time in Samba (this includes most System V based
systems). If <strong>"printcap name"</strong> is set to <strong>lpstat</strong> on these systems
then Samba will launch <code>"lpstat -v"</code> and attempt to parse the output
to obtain a printer list.
-<p><br>A minimal printcap file would look something like this:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p>A minimal printcap file would look something like this:
+<p><pre>
print1|My Printer 1
print2|My Printer 2
@@ -3440,287 +3440,287 @@ to obtain a printer list.
</pre>
-<p><br>where the <code>'|'</code> separates aliases of a printer. The fact that the
+<p>where the <code>'|'</code> separates aliases of a printer. The fact that the
second alias has a space in it gives a hint to Samba that it's a
comment.
-<p><br><em>NOTE</em>: Under AIX the default printcap name is
+<p><em>NOTE</em>: Under AIX the default printcap name is
<code>"/etc/qconfig"</code>. Samba will assume the file is in AIX <code>"qconfig"</code>
format if the string <code>"/qconfig"</code> appears in the printcap filename.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> printcap name = /etc/printcap</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> printcap name = /etc/myprintcap</code>
-<p><br><a name="printer"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printer (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the name of the printer to which print jobs
+<p><a name="printer"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printer (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the name of the printer to which print jobs
spooled through a printable service will be sent.
-<p><br>If specified in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section, the printer
+<p>If specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a> section, the printer
name given will be used for any printable service that does not have
its own printer name specified.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
none (but may be <code>"lp"</code> on many systems)
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
printer name = laserwriter
-<p><br><a name="printerdriver"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printer driver (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to control the string that clients receive when
+<p><a name="printerdriver"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printer driver (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to control the string that clients receive when
they ask the server for the printer driver associated with a
printer. If you are using Windows95 or WindowsNT then you can use this
to automate the setup of printers on your system.
-<p><br>You need to set this parameter to the exact string (case sensitive)
+<p>You need to set this parameter to the exact string (case sensitive)
that describes the appropriate printer driver for your system. If you
don't know the exact string to use then you should first try with no
<strong>"printer driver"</strong> option set and the client will give you a list of
printer drivers. The appropriate strings are shown in a scrollbox
after you have chosen the printer manufacturer.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>"printer driver file"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>"printer driver file"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
printer driver = HP LaserJet 4L
-<p><br><a name="printerdriverfile"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printer driver file (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter tells Samba where the printer driver definition file,
+<p><a name="printerdriverfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printer driver file (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter tells Samba where the printer driver definition file,
used when serving drivers to Windows 95 clients, is to be found. If
this is not set, the default is :
-<p><br><code>SAMBA_INSTALL_DIRECTORY/lib/printers.def</code>
-<p><br>This file is created from Windows 95 <code>"msprint.def"</code> files found on
+<p><code>SAMBA_INSTALL_DIRECTORY/lib/printers.def</code>
+<p>This file is created from Windows 95 <code>"msprint.def"</code> files found on
the Windows 95 client system. For more details on setting up serving
of printer drivers to Windows 95 clients, see the documentation file
in the docs/ directory, PRINTER_DRIVER.txt.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> None (set in compile).</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> printer driver file = /usr/local/samba/printers/drivers.def</code>
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverlocation"><strong>"printer driver location"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="printerdriverlocation"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printer driver location (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter tells clients of a particular printer share where to
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverlocation"><strong>"printer driver location"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="printerdriverlocation"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printer driver location (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter tells clients of a particular printer share where to
find the printer driver files for the automatic installation of
drivers for Windows 95 machines. If Samba is set up to serve printer
drivers to Windows 95 machines, this should be set to
-<p><br><code>\\MACHINE\PRINTER$</code>
-<p><br>Where MACHINE is the NetBIOS name of your Samba server, and PRINTER$
+<p><code>\\MACHINE\PRINTER$</code>
+<p>Where MACHINE is the NetBIOS name of your Samba server, and PRINTER$
is a share you set up for serving printer driver files. For more
details on setting this up see the documentation file in the docs/
directory, PRINTER_DRIVER.txt.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> None</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> printer driver location = \\MACHINE\PRINTER$</code>
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>"printer driver file"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="printername"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printer name (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printer"><strong>printer</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="printing"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printing (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameters controls how printer status information is interpreted
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printerdriverfile"><strong>"printer driver file"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="printername"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printer name (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printer"><strong>printer</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="printing"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printing (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameters controls how printer status information is interpreted
on your system. It also affects the default values for the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printcommand"><strong>"print command"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lpqcommand"><strong>"lpq
-command"</strong></a> <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>"lppause command"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lpresumecommand"><strong>"lpresume command"</strong></a>, and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#lprmcommand"><strong>"lprm
-command"</strong></a> if specified in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#printcommand"><strong>"print command"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lpqcommand"><strong>"lpq
+command"</strong></a> <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lppausecommand"><strong>"lppause command"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#lpresumecommand"><strong>"lpresume command"</strong></a>, and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#lprmcommand"><strong>"lprm
+command"</strong></a> if specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>
section.
-<p><br>Currently eight printing styles are supported. They are
+<p>Currently eight printing styles are supported. They are
<strong>"printing=BSD"</strong>, <strong>"printing=AIX"</strong>,
<strong>"printing=LPRNG"</strong>, <strong>"printing=PLP"</strong>, <strong>"printing=SYSV"</strong>,
<strong>"printing="HPUX"</strong>, <strong>"printing=QNX"</strong>, <strong>"printing=SOFTQ"</strong>,
and <strong>"printing=CUPS"</strong>.
-<p><br>To see what the defaults are for the other print commands when using
+<p>To see what the defaults are for the other print commands when using
the various options use the <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>"testparm"</strong></a> program.
-<p><br>This option can be set on a per printer basis
-<p><br>See also the discussion in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> section.
-<p><br><a name="protocol"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>protocol (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest protocol level
+<p>This option can be set on a per printer basis
+<p>See also the discussion in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a> section.
+<p><a name="protocol"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>protocol (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest protocol level
that will be supported by the server.
-<p><br>Possible values are :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > CORE: Earliest version. No concept of user names.
-<p><br><li > COREPLUS: Slight improvements on CORE for efficiency.
-<p><br><li > LANMAN1: First <em>"modern"</em> version of the protocol. Long
+<p>Possible values are :
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > CORE: Earliest version. No concept of user names.
+<p><li > COREPLUS: Slight improvements on CORE for efficiency.
+<p><li > LANMAN1: First <em>"modern"</em> version of the protocol. Long
filename support.
-<p><br><li > LANMAN2: Updates to Lanman1 protocol.
-<p><br><li > NT1: Current up to date version of the protocol. Used by Windows
+<p><li > LANMAN2: Updates to Lanman1 protocol.
+<p><li > NT1: Current up to date version of the protocol. Used by Windows
NT. Known as CIFS.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Normally this option should not be set as the automatic negotiation
+<p></dl>
+<p>Normally this option should not be set as the automatic negotiation
phase in the SMB protocol takes care of choosing the appropriate
protocol.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> protocol = NT1</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> protocol = LANMAN1</code>
-<p><br><a name="public"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>public (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>"guest ok"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="queuepausecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>queuepause command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="public"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>public (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestok"><strong>"guest ok"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="queuepausecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>queuepause command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to pause the printerqueue.
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
as its only parameter and stops the printerqueue, such that no longer
jobs are submitted to the printer.
-<p><br>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, but can be
+<p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, but can be
issued from the Printer's window under Windows 95 &amp; NT.
-<p><br>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its
+<p>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its
place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the command.
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
command as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> depends on the setting of "printing ="</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> queuepause command = disable %p</code>
-<p><br><a name="queueresumecommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>queueresume command (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
+<p><a name="queueresumecommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>queueresume command (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host
in order to resume the printerqueue. It is the command to undo the
behavior that is caused by the previous parameter
-(<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#queuepausecommand"><strong>"queuepause command</strong></a>).
-<p><br>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
+(<a href="smb.conf.5.html#queuepausecommand"><strong>"queuepause command</strong></a>).
+<p>This command should be a program or script which takes a printer name
as its only parameter and resumes the printerqueue, such that queued
jobs are resubmitted to the printer.
-<p><br>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, but can be
+<p>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups, but can be
issued from the Printer's window under Windows 95 &amp; NT.
-<p><br>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its
+<p>If a <code>"%p"</code> is given then the printername is put in its
place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the command.
-<p><br>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
+<p>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path in the
command as the PATH may not be available to the server.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> depends on the setting of "printing ="</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> queuepause command = enable %p</code>
-<p><br><a name="readbmpx"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read bmpx (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
+<p><a name="readbmpx"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read bmpx (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will support the "Read Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used
and defaults to off. You should never need to set this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
read bmpx = No
-<p><br><a name="readlist"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read list (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of users that are given read-only access to a
+<p><a name="readlist"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read list (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of users that are given read-only access to a
service. If the connecting user is in this list then they will not be
-given write access, no matter what the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>
+given write access, no matter what the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>
option is set to. The list can include group names using the syntax
-described in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writelist"><strong>"write list"</strong></a> parameter and
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+described in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writelist"><strong>"write list"</strong></a> parameter and
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> read list = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> read list = mary, @students</code>
-<p><br><a name="readonly"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read only (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Note that this is an inverted synonym for
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="readprediction"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read prediction (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br><em>NOTE</em>: This code is currently disabled in Samba2.0 and
+<p><a name="readonly"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read only (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Note that this is an inverted synonym for
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="readprediction"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read prediction (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p><em>NOTE</em>: This code is currently disabled in Samba2.0 and
may be removed at a later date. Hence this parameter has
no effect.
-<p><br>This options enables or disables the read prediction code used to
+<p>This options enables or disables the read prediction code used to
speed up reads from the server. When enabled the server will try to
pre-read data from the last accessed file that was opened read-only
while waiting for packets.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> read prediction = False</code>
-<p><br><a name="readraw"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read raw (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls whether or not the server will support the raw
+<p><a name="readraw"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read raw (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls whether or not the server will support the raw
read SMB requests when transferring data to clients.
-<p><br>If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in one packet. This
+<p>If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in one packet. This
typically provides a major performance benefit.
-<p><br>However, some clients either negotiate the allowable block size
+<p>However, some clients either negotiate the allowable block size
incorrectly or are incapable of supporting larger block sizes, and for
these clients you may need to disable raw reads.
-<p><br>In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning tool and left
-severely alone. See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeraw"><strong>"write raw"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning tool and left
+severely alone. See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeraw"><strong>"write raw"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> read raw = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="readsize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>read size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The option <strong>"read size"</strong> affects the overlap of disk reads/writes
+<p><a name="readsize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>read size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The option <strong>"read size"</strong> affects the overlap of disk reads/writes
with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being transferred in
several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and
SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value then the server begins writing
the data before it has received the whole packet from the network, or
in the case of SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before
all the data has been read from disk.
-<p><br>This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access
+<p>This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and network access
are similar, having very little effect when the speed of one is much
greater than the other.
-<p><br>The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been
+<p>The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been
done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the
best value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over
65536 is pointless and will cause you to allocate memory
unnecessarily.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> read size = 16384</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> read size = 8192</code>
-<p><br><a name="remoteannounce"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>remote announce (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to
+<p><a name="remoteannounce"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>remote announce (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to
periodically announce itself to arbitrary IP addresses with an
arbitrary workgroup name.
-<p><br>This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear in a remote
+<p>This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear in a remote
workgroup for which the normal browse propagation rules don't
work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere that you can send IP
packets to.
-<p><br>For example:
-<p><br><code> remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS 192.168.4.255/STAFF</code>
-<p><br>the above line would cause nmbd to announce itself to the two given IP
+<p>For example:
+<p><code> remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS 192.168.4.255/STAFF</code>
+<p>the above line would cause nmbd to announce itself to the two given IP
addresses using the given workgroup names. If you leave out the
workgroup name then the one given in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>"workgroup"</strong></a> parameter is used instead.
-<p><br>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>"workgroup"</strong></a> parameter is used instead.
+<p>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses
of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses of known
browse masters if your network config is that stable.
-<p><br>See the documentation file BROWSING.txt in the docs/ directory.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See the documentation file BROWSING.txt in the docs/ directory.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> remote announce = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS 192.168.4.255/STAFF</code>
-<p><br><a name="remotebrowsesync"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>remote browse sync (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to
+<p><a name="remotebrowsesync"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>remote browse sync (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to
periodically request synchronization of browse lists with the master
browser of a samba server that is on a remote segment. This option
will allow you to gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across
routed networks. This is done in a manner that does not work with any
non-samba servers.
-<p><br>This is useful if you want your Samba server and all local clients to
+<p>This is useful if you want your Samba server and all local clients to
appear in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse propagation
rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere that you can
send IP packets to.
-<p><br>For example:
-<p><br><code> remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255</code>
-<p><br>the above line would cause <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to request the
+<p>For example:
+<p><code> remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255</code>
+<p>the above line would cause <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to request the
master browser on the specified subnets or addresses to synchronize
their browse lists with the local server.
-<p><br>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses
+<p>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses
of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses of known
browse masters if your network config is that stable. If a machine IP
address is given Samba makes NO attempt to validate that the remote
machine is available, is listening, nor that it is in fact the browse
master on it's segment.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> remote browse sync = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255</code>
-<p><br><a name="restrictanonymous"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>restrict anonymous (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean parameter. If it is true, then anonymous access
+<p><a name="restrictanonymous"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>restrict anonymous (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean parameter. If it is true, then anonymous access
to the server will be restricted, namely in the case where the server
is expecting the client to send a username, but it doesn't. Setting
it to true will force these anonymous connections to be denied, and
the client will be required to always supply a username and password
when connecting. Use of this parameter is only recommened for homogenous
NT client environments.
-<p><br>This parameter makes the use of macro expansions that rely
+<p>This parameter makes the use of macro expansions that rely
on the username (%U, %G, etc) consistant. NT 4.0 likes to use
anonymous connections when refreshing the share list, and this
is a way to work around that.
-<p><br>When restrict anonymous is true, all anonymous connections are denied
+<p>When restrict anonymous is true, all anonymous connections are denied
no matter what they are for. This can effect the ability of a machine
to access the samba Primary Domain Controller to revalidate it's machine
account after someone else has logged on the client interactively. The
@@ -3729,42 +3729,42 @@ the domain doesn't exist or the password is bad. The best way to deal
with this is to reboot NT client machines between interactive logons,
using "Shutdown and Restart", rather than "Close all programs and logon
as a different user".
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> restrict anonymous = false</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> restrict anonymous = true</code>
-<p><br><a name="revalidate"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>revalidate (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Note that this option only works with
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> and will be ignored if
+<p><a name="revalidate"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>revalidate (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Note that this option only works with
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> and will be ignored if
this is not the case.
-<p><br>This option controls whether Samba will allow a previously validated
+<p>This option controls whether Samba will allow a previously validated
username/password pair to be used to attach to a share. Thus if you
connect to <code>\\server\share1</code> then to <code>\\server\share2</code> it won't
automatically allow the client to request connection to the second
share as the same username as the first without a password.
-<p><br>If <strong>"revalidate"</strong> is <code>"True"</code> then the client will be denied
+<p>If <strong>"revalidate"</strong> is <code>"True"</code> then the client will be denied
automatic access as the same username.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> revalidate = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> revalidate = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="root"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>"root directory"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="rootdir"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root dir (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>"root directory"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="rootdirectory"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root directory (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The server will <code>"chroot()"</code> (i.e. Change it's root directory) to
+<p><a name="root"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>"root directory"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="rootdir"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root dir (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootdirectory"><strong>"root directory"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="rootdirectory"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root directory (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The server will <code>"chroot()"</code> (i.e. Change it's root directory) to
this directory on startup. This is not strictly necessary for secure
operation. Even without it the server will deny access to files not in
one of the service entries. It may also check for, and deny access to,
soft links to other parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use
<code>".."</code> in file names to access other directories (depending on the
-setting of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>"wide links"</strong></a> parameter).
-<p><br>Adding a <strong>"root directory"</strong> entry other than <code>"/"</code> adds an extra
+setting of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#widelinks"><strong>"wide links"</strong></a> parameter).
+<p>Adding a <strong>"root directory"</strong> entry other than <code>"/"</code> adds an extra
level of security, but at a price. It absolutely ensures that no
access is given to files not in the sub-tree specified in the <strong>"root
directory"</strong> option, <em>*including*</em> some files needed for complete
@@ -3774,71 +3774,71 @@ directory"</strong> tree. In particular you will need to mirror /etc/passwd
(or a subset of it), and any binaries or configuration files needed
for printing (if required). The set of files that must be mirrored is
operating system dependent.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> root directory = /</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> root directory = /homes/smb</code>
-<p><br><a name="rootpostexec"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root postexec (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the same as the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>"postexec"</strong></a> parameter
+<p><a name="rootpostexec"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root postexec (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the same as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>"postexec"</strong></a> parameter
except that the command is run as root. This is useful for unmounting
filesystems (such as cdroms) after a connection is closed.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>"postexec"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="rootpreexec"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root preexec (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the same as the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a> parameter except
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#postexec"><strong>"postexec"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="rootpreexec"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root preexec (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the same as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a> parameter except
that the command is run as root. This is useful for mounting
filesystems (such as cdroms) before a connection is finalized.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a>
-and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexecclose"><strong>"root preexec close"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="rootpreexecclose"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>root preexec close (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the same as the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>"preexec close"</strong></a> parameter
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a>
+and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#rootpreexecclose"><strong>"root preexec close"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="rootpreexecclose"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>root preexec close (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the same as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>"preexec close"</strong></a> parameter
except that the command is run as root.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>"preexec close"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="security"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>security (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option affects how clients respond to Samba and is one of the most
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexec"><strong>"preexec"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preexecclose"><strong>"preexec close"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="security"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>security (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option affects how clients respond to Samba and is one of the most
important settings in the <strong>smb.conf</strong> file.
-<p><br>The option sets the <code>"security mode bit"</code> in replies to protocol
+<p>The option sets the <code>"security mode bit"</code> in replies to protocol
negotiations with <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> to turn share level
security on or off. Clients decide based on this bit whether (and how)
to transfer user and password information to the server.
-<p><br>The default is <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser">"security=user"</a>, as this is
+<p>The default is <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser">"security=user"</a>, as this is
the most common setting needed when talking to Windows 98 and Windows
NT.
-<p><br>The alternatives are <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security = share"</strong></a>,
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security = server"</strong></a> or
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><em>*****NOTE THAT THIS DEFAULT IS DIFFERENT IN SAMBA2.0 THAN FOR
+<p>The alternatives are <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security = share"</strong></a>,
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalserver"><strong>"security = server"</strong></a> or
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>.
+<p><em>*****NOTE THAT THIS DEFAULT IS DIFFERENT IN SAMBA2.0 THAN FOR
PREVIOUS VERSIONS OF SAMBA *******</em>.
-<p><br>In previous versions of Samba the default was
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> mainly because that was
+<p>In previous versions of Samba the default was
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>"security=share"</strong></a> mainly because that was
the only option at one stage.
-<p><br>There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this setting. When in
+<p>There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this setting. When in
user or server level security a WfWg client will totally ignore the
password you type in the "connect drive" dialog box. This makes it
very difficult (if not impossible) to connect to a Samba service as
anyone except the user that you are logged into WfWg as.
-<p><br>If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their usernames on the
+<p>If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their usernames on the
UNIX machine then you will want to use <strong>"security = user"</strong>. If you
mostly use usernames that don't exist on the UNIX box then use
<strong>"security = share"</strong>.
-<p><br>You should also use <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>security=share</strong></a> if
+<p>You should also use <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequalshare"><strong>security=share</strong></a> if
you want to mainly setup shares without a password (guest
shares). This is commonly used for a shared printer server. It is more
difficult to setup guest shares with
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>security=user</strong></a>, see the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>security=user</strong></a>, see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to
guest"</strong></a>parameter for details.
-<p><br>It is possible to use <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> in a <em>"hybrid
+<p>It is possible to use <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> in a <em>"hybrid
mode"</em> where it is offers both user and share level security under
-different <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>NetBIOS aliases</strong></a>. See the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>NetBIOS aliases</strong></a> and the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#include"><strong>include</strong></a> parameters for more information.
-<p><br>The different settings will now be explained.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="securityequalshare"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>"security=share"</strong></strong> When clients connect to a share level
+different <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>NetBIOS aliases</strong></a>. See the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosaliases"><strong>NetBIOS aliases</strong></a> and the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#include"><strong>include</strong></a> parameters for more information.
+<p>The different settings will now be explained.
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="securityequalshare"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>"security=share"</strong></strong><dd> When clients connect to a share level
security server then need not log onto the server with a valid
username and password before attempting to connect to a shared
resource (although modern clients such as Windows 95/98 and Windows NT
@@ -3846,193 +3846,193 @@ will send a logon request with a username but no password when talking
to a <strong>security=share</strong> server). Instead, the clients send
authentication information (passwords) on a per-share basis, at the
time they attempt to connect to that share.
-<p><br>Note that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> <em>*ALWAYS*</em> uses a valid UNIX
+<p>Note that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> <em>*ALWAYS*</em> uses a valid UNIX
user to act on behalf of the client, even in <strong>"security=share"</strong>
level security.
-<p><br>As clients are not required to send a username to the server
+<p>As clients are not required to send a username to the server
in share level security, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> uses several
techniques to determine the correct UNIX user to use on behalf
of the client.
-<p><br>A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
+<p>A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
client password is constructed using the following methods :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is set, then
-all the other stages are missed and only the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is set, then
+all the other stages are missed and only the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest
account"</strong></a> username is checked.
-<p><br><li > Is a username is sent with the share connection request, then
-this username (after mapping - see <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>"username
+<p><li > Is a username is sent with the share connection request, then
+this username (after mapping - see <a href="smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>"username
map"</strong></a>), is added as a potential username.
-<p><br><li > If the client did a previous <em>"logon"</em> request (the
+<p><li > If the client did a previous <em>"logon"</em> request (the
SessionSetup SMB call) then the username sent in this SMB
will be added as a potential username.
-<p><br><li > The name of the service the client requested is added
+<p><li > The name of the service the client requested is added
as a potential username.
-<p><br><li > The NetBIOS name of the client is added to the list as a
+<p><li > The NetBIOS name of the client is added to the list as a
potential username.
-<p><br><li > Any users on the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> list are added
+<p><li > Any users on the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> list are added
as potential usernames.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is not set, then
+<p></dl>
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is not set, then
this list is then tried with the supplied password. The first user for
whom the password matches will be used as the UNIX user.
-<p><br>If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is set, or no
+<p>If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a> parameter is set, or no
username can be determined then if the share is marked as available to
-the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>, then this guest user will
+the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>, then this guest user will
be used, otherwise access is denied.
-<p><br>Note that it can be <em>*very*</em> confusing in share-level security as to
+<p>Note that it can be <em>*very*</em> confusing in share-level security as to
which UNIX username will eventually be used in granting access.
-<p><br>See also the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
+<p>See also the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
VALIDATION"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="securityequaluser"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>"security=user"</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is the default security setting in Samba2.0. With user-level
+<p><a name="securityequaluser"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>"security=user"</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is the default security setting in Samba2.0. With user-level
security a client must first <code>"log-on"</code> with a valid username and
-password (which can be mapped using the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>"username
+password (which can be mapped using the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#usernamemap"><strong>"username
map"</strong></a> parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter) can also
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter) can also
be used in this security mode. Parameters such as
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a>, if set
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#user"><strong>"user"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestonly"><strong>"guest only"</strong></a>, if set
are then applied and may change the UNIX user to use on this
connection, but only after the user has been successfully
authenticated.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
+<p><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
<em>*not*</em> sent to the server until after the server has successfully
authenticated the client. This is why guest shares don't work in user
level security without allowing the server to automatically map unknown
-users into the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
+users into the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
doing this.
-<p><br>See also the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
+<p>See also the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
VALIDATION"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="securityequalserver"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>"security=server"</strong></strong>
-<p><br>In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by
+<p><a name="securityequalserver"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>"security=server"</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by
passing it to another SMB server, such as an NT box. If this fails it
will revert to <strong>"security = user"</strong>, but note that if encrypted
passwords have been negotiated then Samba cannot revert back to
checking the UNIX password file, it must have a valid smbpasswd file
to check users against. See the documentation file in the docs/
directory ENCRYPTION.txt for details on how to set this up.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that from the clients point of view <strong>"security=server"</strong> is
-the same as <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>"security=user"</strong></a>. It only
+<p><em>Note</em> that from the clients point of view <strong>"security=server"</strong> is
+the same as <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>"security=user"</strong></a>. It only
affects how the server deals with the authentication, it does not in
any way affect what the client sees.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
+<p><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
<em>*not*</em> sent to the server until after the server has successfully
authenticated the client. This is why guest shares don't work in server
level security without allowing the server to automatically map unknown
-users into the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
+users into the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
doing this.
-<p><br>See also the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
+<p>See also the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
VALIDATION"</strong></a>.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> parameter.
-and the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><a name="securityequaldomain"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>"security=domain"</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This mode will only work correctly if
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> parameter.
+and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><a name="securityequaldomain"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>"security=domain"</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This mode will only work correctly if
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> has been used to add this machine
-into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted
+into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted
passwords"</strong></a> parameter to be set to <code>"true"</code>. In
this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing
it to a Windows NT Primary or Backup Domain Controller, in exactly the
same way that a Windows NT Server would do.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that a valid UNIX user must still exist as well as the
+<p><em>Note</em> that a valid UNIX user must still exist as well as the
account on the Domain Controller to allow Samba to have a valid
UNIX account to map file access to.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that from the clients point of view <strong>"security=domain"</strong> is
-the same as <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>"security=user"</strong></a>. It only
+<p><em>Note</em> that from the clients point of view <strong>"security=domain"</strong> is
+the same as <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaluser"><strong>"security=user"</strong></a>. It only
affects how the server deals with the authentication, it does not in
any way affect what the client sees.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
+<p><em>Note</em> that the name of the resource being requested is
<em>*not*</em> sent to the server until after the server has successfully
authenticated the client. This is why guest shares don't work in domain
level security without allowing the server to automatically map unknown
-users into the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
+users into the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#guestaccount"><strong>"guest account"</strong></a>. See the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#maptoguest"><strong>"map to guest"</strong></a> parameter for details on
doing this.
-<p><br><em>BUG:</em> There is currently a bug in the implementation of
+<p><em>BUG:</em> There is currently a bug in the implementation of
<strong>"security=domain</strong> with respect to multi-byte character
set usernames. The communication with a Domain Controller
must be done in UNICODE and Samba currently does not widen
multi-byte user names to UNICODE correctly, thus a multi-byte
username will not be recognized correctly at the Domain Controller.
This issue will be addressed in a future release.
-<p><br>See also the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
+<p>See also the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
VALIDATION"</strong></a>.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> parameter.
-and the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> parameter.
+and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypted passwords"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p></dl>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> security = USER</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> security = DOMAIN</code>
-<p><br><a name="securitymask"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>security mask (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified
+<p><a name="securitymask"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>security mask (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified
when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permission on a
file using the native NT security dialog box.
-<p><br>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the changed
+<p>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to the changed
permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in this mask from
being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this mask may be treated
as a set of bits the user is not allowed to change.
-<p><br>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a> parameter. To allow a user to
+<p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#createmask"><strong>create mask</strong></a> parameter. To allow a user to
modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file, set this
parameter to 0777.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
+<p><em>Note</em> that users who can access the Samba server through other
means can easily bypass this restriction, so it is primarily
useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of
most normal systems will probably want to set it to 0777.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
-mode</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security
-mask</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcedirectorysecuritymode"><strong>force directory security
+mode</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#directorysecuritymask"><strong>directory security
+mask</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#forcesecuritymode"><strong>force security
mode</strong></a> parameters.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> security mask = &lt;same as create mask&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> security mask = 0777</code>
-<p><br><a name="serverstring"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>server string (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in
+<p><a name="serverstring"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>server string (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in
print manager and next to the IPC connection in <code>"net view"</code>. It can be
any string that you wish to show to your users.
-<p><br>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next to the machine
+<p>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next to the machine
name.
-<p><br>A <code>"%v"</code> will be replaced with the Samba version number.
-<p><br>A <code>"%h"</code> will be replaced with the hostname.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>A <code>"%v"</code> will be replaced with the Samba version number.
+<p>A <code>"%h"</code> will be replaced with the hostname.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> server string = Samba %v</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> server string = University of GNUs Samba Server</code>
-<p><br><a name="setdirectory"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>set directory (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If <code>"set directory = no"</code>, then users of the service may not use the
+<p><a name="setdirectory"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>set directory (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If <code>"set directory = no"</code>, then users of the service may not use the
setdir command to change directory.
-<p><br>The setdir command is only implemented in the Digital Pathworks
+<p>The setdir command is only implemented in the Digital Pathworks
client. See the Pathworks documentation for details.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> set directory = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> set directory = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="sharemodes"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>share modes (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This enables or disables the honoring of the <code>"share modes"</code> during a
+<p><a name="sharemodes"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>share modes (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This enables or disables the honoring of the <code>"share modes"</code> during a
file open. These modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or
write access to a file.
-<p><br>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so they are
+<p>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so they are
simulated using shared memory, or lock files if your UNIX doesn't
support shared memory (almost all do).
-<p><br>The share modes that are enabled by this option are DENY_DOS,
+<p>The share modes that are enabled by this option are DENY_DOS,
DENY_ALL, DENY_READ, DENY_WRITE, DENY_NONE and DENY_FCB.
-<p><br>This option gives full share compatibility and enabled by default.
-<p><br>You should <em>*NEVER*</em> turn this parameter off as many Windows
+<p>This option gives full share compatibility and enabled by default.
+<p>You should <em>*NEVER*</em> turn this parameter off as many Windows
applications will break if you do so.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> share modes = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="sharedmemsize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>shared mem size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>It specifies the size of the shared memory (in bytes) to use between
+<p><a name="sharedmemsize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>shared mem size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>It specifies the size of the shared memory (in bytes) to use between
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> processes. This parameter defaults to one
megabyte of shared memory. It is possible that if you have a large
server with many files open simultaneously that you may need to
@@ -4040,160 +4040,160 @@ increase this parameter. Signs that this parameter is set too low are
users reporting strange problems trying to save files (locking errors)
and error messages in the smbd log looking like <code>"ERROR
smb_shm_alloc : alloc of XX bytes failed"</code>.
-<p><br>If your OS refuses the size that Samba asks for then Samba will try a
+<p>If your OS refuses the size that Samba asks for then Samba will try a
smaller size, reducing by a factor of 0.8 until the OS accepts it.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> shared mem size = 1048576</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> shared mem size = 5242880 ; Set to 5mb for a large number of files.</code>
-<p><br><a name="shortpreservecase"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>short preserve case (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls if new files which conform to 8.3
+<p><a name="shortpreservecase"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>short preserve case (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls if new files which conform to 8.3
syntax, that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created
upper case, or if they are forced to be the <code>"default"</code> case. This
-option can be use with <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#preservecaseoption"><strong>"preserve case
+option can be use with <a href="smb.conf.5.html#preservecaseoption"><strong>"preserve case
=yes"</strong></a> to permit long filenames to retain their
case, while short names are lowered. Default <em>Yes</em>.
-<p><br>See the section on <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>NAME MANGLING</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See the section on <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMEMANGLING"><strong>NAME MANGLING</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> short preserve case = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="smbpasswdfile"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>smb passwd file (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option sets the path to the encrypted smbpasswd file. By default
+<p><a name="smbpasswdfile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>smb passwd file (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option sets the path to the encrypted smbpasswd file. By default
the path to the smbpasswd file is compiled into Samba.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> smb passwd file= &lt;compiled default&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> smb passwd file = /usr/samba/private/smbpasswd</code>
-<p><br><a name="smbrun"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>smbrun (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This sets the full path to the <strong>smbrun</strong> binary. This defaults to the
+<p><a name="smbrun"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>smbrun (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This sets the full path to the <strong>smbrun</strong> binary. This defaults to the
value in the Makefile.
-<p><br>You must get this path right for many services to work correctly.
-<p><br>You should not need to change this parameter so long as Samba
+<p>You must get this path right for many services to work correctly.
+<p>You should not need to change this parameter so long as Samba
is installed correctly.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> smbrun=&lt;compiled default&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> smbrun = /usr/local/samba/bin/smbrun</code>
-<p><br><a name="socketaddress"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>socket address (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to control what address Samba will listen for
+<p><a name="socketaddress"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>socket address (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to control what address Samba will listen for
connections on. This is used to support multiple virtual interfaces on
the one server, each with a different configuration.
-<p><br>By default samba will accept connections on any address.
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p>By default samba will accept connections on any address.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> socket address = 192.168.2.20</code>
-<p><br><a name="socketoptions"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>socket options (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to set socket options to be used when talking
+<p><a name="socketoptions"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>socket options (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to set socket options to be used when talking
with the client.
-<p><br>Socket options are controls on the networking layer of the operating
+<p>Socket options are controls on the networking layer of the operating
systems which allow the connection to be tuned.
-<p><br>This option will typically be used to tune your Samba server for
+<p>This option will typically be used to tune your Samba server for
optimal performance for your local network. There is no way that Samba
can know what the optimal parameters are for your net, so you must
experiment and choose them yourself. We strongly suggest you read the
appropriate documentation for your operating system first (perhaps
<strong>"man setsockopt"</strong> will help).
-<p><br>You may find that on some systems Samba will say "Unknown socket
+<p>You may find that on some systems Samba will say "Unknown socket
option" when you supply an option. This means you either incorrectly
typed it or you need to add an include file to includes.h for your OS.
If the latter is the case please send the patch to
<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>Any of the supported socket options may be combined in any way you
+<p>Any of the supported socket options may be combined in any way you
like, as long as your OS allows it.
-<p><br>This is the list of socket options currently settable using this
+<p>This is the list of socket options currently settable using this
option:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > SO_KEEPALIVE
-<p><br><li > SO_REUSEADDR
-<p><br><li > SO_BROADCAST
-<p><br><li > TCP_NODELAY
-<p><br><li > IPTOS_LOWDELAY
-<p><br><li > IPTOS_THROUGHPUT
-<p><br><li > SO_SNDBUF *
-<p><br><li > SO_RCVBUF *
-<p><br><li > SO_SNDLOWAT *
-<p><br><li > SO_RCVLOWAT *
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Those marked with a <code>*</code> take an integer argument. The others can
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > SO_KEEPALIVE
+<p><li > SO_REUSEADDR
+<p><li > SO_BROADCAST
+<p><li > TCP_NODELAY
+<p><li > IPTOS_LOWDELAY
+<p><li > IPTOS_THROUGHPUT
+<p><li > SO_SNDBUF *
+<p><li > SO_RCVBUF *
+<p><li > SO_SNDLOWAT *
+<p><li > SO_RCVLOWAT *
+<p></dl>
+<p>Those marked with a <code>*</code> take an integer argument. The others can
optionally take a 1 or 0 argument to enable or disable the option, by
default they will be enabled if you don't specify 1 or 0.
-<p><br>To specify an argument use the syntax SOME_OPTION=VALUE for example
+<p>To specify an argument use the syntax SOME_OPTION=VALUE for example
<code>SO_SNDBUF=8192</code>. Note that you must not have any spaces before or after
the = sign.
-<p><br>If you are on a local network then a sensible option might be
-<p><br><code>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</code>
-<p><br>If you have a local network then you could try:
-<p><br><code>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</code>
-<p><br>If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try setting
+<p>If you are on a local network then a sensible option might be
+<p><code>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</code>
+<p>If you have a local network then you could try:
+<p><code>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</code>
+<p>If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try setting
IPTOS_THROUGHPUT.
-<p><br>Note that several of the options may cause your Samba server to fail
+<p>Note that several of the options may cause your Samba server to fail
completely. Use these options with caution!
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> socket options = TCP_NODELAY</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</code>
-<p><br><a name="sourceenvironment"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>source environment (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter causes Samba to set environment variables as per the
+<p><a name="sourceenvironment"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>source environment (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter causes Samba to set environment variables as per the
content of the file named.
-<p><br>The file <strong>must</strong> be owned by root and not world writable in order
+<p>The file <strong>must</strong> be owned by root and not world writable in order
to be read (this is a security check).
-<p><br>If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character then Samba will
+<p>If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character then Samba will
treat that value as a pipe command to open and will set the environment
variables from the oput of the pipe. This command must not be world writable
and must reside in a directory that is not world writable.
-<p><br>The contents of the file or the output of the pipe should be formatted
+<p>The contents of the file or the output of the pipe should be formatted
as the output of the standard Unix env(1) command. This is of the form :
-<p><br>Example environment entry:
+<p>Example environment entry:
<code> SAMBA_NETBIOS_NAME=myhostname </code>
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code>No default value</code>
-<p><br><strong>Examples:</strong>
-<p><br><code> source environment = |/etc/smb.conf.sh</code>
-<p><br><code> source environment = /usr/local/smb_env_vars</code>
-<p><br><a name="ssl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><strong>Examples:</strong>
+<p><code> source environment = |/etc/smb.conf.sh</code>
+<p><code> source environment = /usr/local/smb_env_vars</code>
+<p><a name="ssl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This variable enables or disables the entire SSL mode. If it is set to
+<p>This variable enables or disables the entire SSL mode. If it is set to
"no", the SSL enabled samba behaves exactly like the non-SSL samba. If
-set to "yes", it depends on the variables <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>"ssl
-hosts"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>"ssl hosts resign"</strong></a>
+set to "yes", it depends on the variables <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>"ssl
+hosts"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>"ssl hosts resign"</strong></a>
whether an SSL connection will be required.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl=no</code>
<strong>Example:</strong>
<code> ssl=yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslCAcertDir"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl CA certDir (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslCAcertDir"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl CA certDir (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This variable defines where to look up the Certification
+<p>This variable defines where to look up the Certification
Authorities. The given directory should contain one file for each CA
that samba will trust. The file name must be the hash value over the
"Distinguished Name" of the CA. How this directory is set up is
explained later in this document. All files within the directory that
don't fit into this naming scheme are ignored. You don't need this
variable if you don't verify client certificates.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl CA certDir = /usr/local/ssl/certs</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslCAcertFile"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl CA certFile (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslCAcertFile"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl CA certFile (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This variable is a second way to define the trusted CAs. The
+<p>This variable is a second way to define the trusted CAs. The
certificates of the trusted CAs are collected in one big file and this
variable points to the file. You will probably only use one of the two
ways to define your CAs. The first choice is preferable if you have
@@ -4201,93 +4201,93 @@ many CAs or want to be flexible, the second is preferable if you only
have one CA and want to keep things simple (you won't need to create
the hashed file names). You don't need this variable if you don't
verify client certificates.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl CA certFile = /usr/local/ssl/certs/trustedCAs.pem</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslciphers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl ciphers (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslciphers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl ciphers (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This variable defines the ciphers that should be offered during SSL
+<p>This variable defines the ciphers that should be offered during SSL
negotiation. You should not set this variable unless you know what you
are doing.
-<p><br><a name="sslclientcert"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl client cert (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslclientcert"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl client cert (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>The certificate in this file is used by
+<p>The certificate in this file is used by
<a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a> if it exists. It's needed if the
server requires a client certificate.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl client cert = /usr/local/ssl/certs/smbclient.pem</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslclientkey"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl client key (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslclientkey"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl client key (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This is the private key for <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a>. It's
+<p>This is the private key for <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a>. It's
only needed if the client should have a certificate.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl client key = /usr/local/ssl/private/smbclient.pem</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslcompatibility"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl compatibility (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslcompatibility"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl compatibility (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This variable defines whether SSLeay should be configured for bug
+<p>This variable defines whether SSLeay should be configured for bug
compatibility with other SSL implementations. This is probably not
desirable because currently no clients with SSL implementations other
than SSLeay exist.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl compatibility = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslhosts"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl hosts (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>See <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>"ssl hosts resign"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="sslhostsresign"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl hosts resign (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslhosts"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl hosts (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>See <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhostsresign"><strong>"ssl hosts resign"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="sslhostsresign"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl hosts resign (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>These two variables define whether samba will go into SSL mode or
+<p>These two variables define whether samba will go into SSL mode or
not. If none of them is defined, samba will allow only SSL
-connections. If the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>"ssl hosts"</strong></a> variable lists
+connections. If the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslhosts"><strong>"ssl hosts"</strong></a> variable lists
hosts (by IP-address, IP-address range, net group or name), only these
hosts will be forced into SSL mode. If the <strong>"ssl hosts resign"</strong>
variable lists hosts, only these hosts will NOT be forced into SSL
mode. The syntax for these two variables is the same as for the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>"hosts allow"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>"hosts
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>"hosts allow"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>"hosts
deny"</strong></a> pair of variables, only that the subject of the
decision is different: It's not the access right but whether SSL is
-used or not. See the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>"allow hosts"</strong></a> parameter for
+used or not. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#allowhosts"><strong>"allow hosts"</strong></a> parameter for
details. The example below requires SSL connections from all hosts
outside the local net (which is 192.168.*.*).
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl hosts = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
<code> ssl hosts resign = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> ssl hosts resign = 192.168.</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslrequireclientcert"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl require clientcert (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslrequireclientcert"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl require clientcert (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>If this variable is set to <code>"yes"</code>, the server will not tolerate
+<p>If this variable is set to <code>"yes"</code>, the server will not tolerate
connections from clients that don't have a valid certificate. The
-directory/file given in <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertDir"><strong>"ssl CA certDir"</strong></a> and
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertFile"><strong>"ssl CA certFile"</strong></a> will be used to look up the
+directory/file given in <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertDir"><strong>"ssl CA certDir"</strong></a> and
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslCAcertFile"><strong>"ssl CA certFile"</strong></a> will be used to look up the
CAs that issued the client's certificate. If the certificate can't be
verified positively, the connection will be terminated. If this
variable is set to <code>"no"</code>, clients don't need certificates. Contrary
@@ -4296,100 +4296,100 @@ certificates. In the web environment the client's data is sensitive
(credit card numbers) and the server must prove to be trustworthy. In
a file server environment the server's data will be sensitive and the
clients must prove to be trustworthy.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl require clientcert = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslrequireservercert"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl require servercert (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslrequireservercert"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl require servercert (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>If this variable is set to <code>"yes"</code>, the
+<p>If this variable is set to <code>"yes"</code>, the
<a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a> will request a certificate from
-the server. Same as <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireclientcert"><strong>"ssl require
+the server. Same as <a href="smb.conf.5.html#sslrequireclientcert"><strong>"ssl require
clientcert"</strong></a> for the server.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl require servercert = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslservercert"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl server cert (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslservercert"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl server cert (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This is the file containing the server's certificate. The server _must_
+<p>This is the file containing the server's certificate. The server _must_
have a certificate. The file may also contain the server's private key.
See later for how certificates and private keys are created.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl server cert = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslserverkey"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl server key (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslserverkey"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl server key (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This file contains the private key of the server. If this variable is
+<p>This file contains the private key of the server. If this variable is
not defined, the key is looked up in the certificate file (it may be
appended to the certificate). The server <em>*must*</em> have a private key
and the certificate <em>*must*</em> match this private key.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl server key = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><a name="sslversion"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>ssl version (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
+<p><a name="sslversion"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>ssl version (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This is only available if
the SSL libraries have been compiled on your system and the configure
option <code>"--with-ssl"</code> was given at configure time.
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
+<p><em>Note</em> that for export control reasons this code is <em>**NOT**</em>
enabled by default in any current binary version of Samba.
-<p><br>This enumeration variable defines the versions of the SSL protocol
+<p>This enumeration variable defines the versions of the SSL protocol
that will be used. <code>"ssl2or3"</code> allows dynamic negotiation of SSL v2
or v3, <code>"ssl2"</code> results in SSL v2, <code>"ssl3"</code> results in SSL v3 and
"tls1" results in TLS v1. TLS (Transport Layer Security) is the
(proposed?) new standard for SSL.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> ssl version = "ssl2or3"</code>
-<p><br><a name="statcache"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>stat cache (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter determines if <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will use a
+<p><a name="statcache"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>stat cache (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter determines if <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> will use a
cache in order to speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should
never need to change this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> stat cache = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="statcachesize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>stat cache size (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter determines the number of entries in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#statcache"><strong>stat
+<p><a name="statcachesize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>stat cache size (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter determines the number of entries in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#statcache"><strong>stat
cache</strong></a>. You should never need to change this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> stat cache size = 50</code>
-<p><br><a name="status"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>status (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This enables or disables logging of connections to a status file that
+<p><a name="status"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>status (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This enables or disables logging of connections to a status file that
<a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong></a> can read.
-<p><br>With this disabled <a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong></a> won't be able
+<p>With this disabled <a href="smbstatus.1.html"><strong>smbstatus</strong></a> won't be able
to tell you what connections are active. You should never need to
change this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
status = yes
-<p><br><a name="strictlocking"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>strict locking (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean that controls the handling of file locking in the
+<p><a name="strictlocking"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>strict locking (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of file locking in the
server. When this is set to <code>"yes"</code> the server will check every read and
write access for file locks, and deny access if locks exist. This can
be slow on some systems.
-<p><br>When strict locking is <code>"no"</code> the server does file lock checks only
+<p>When strict locking is <code>"no"</code> the server does file lock checks only
when the client explicitly asks for them.
-<p><br>Well behaved clients always ask for lock checks when it is important,
+<p>Well behaved clients always ask for lock checks when it is important,
so in the vast majority of cases <strong>"strict locking = no"</strong> is
preferable.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> strict locking = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> strict locking = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="strictsync"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>strict sync (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Many Windows applications (including the Windows 98 explorer shell)
+<p><a name="strictsync"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>strict sync (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Many Windows applications (including the Windows 98 explorer shell)
seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to disk with doing a sync to
disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces the process to be suspended until
the kernel has ensured that all outstanding data in kernel disk
@@ -4401,120 +4401,120 @@ operating system itself that Samba is running on crashes, so there is
little danger in this default setting. In addition, this fixes many
performance problems that people have reported with the new Windows98
explorer shell file copies.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#syncalways"><strong>"sync always"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#syncalways"><strong>"sync always"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> strict sync = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> strict sync = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="stripdot"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>strip dot (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean that controls whether to strip trailing dots off
+<p><a name="stripdot"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>strip dot (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean that controls whether to strip trailing dots off
UNIX filenames. This helps with some CDROMs that have filenames ending
in a single dot.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> strip dot = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> strip dot = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="syncalways"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>sync always (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether writes will always
+<p><a name="syncalways"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>sync always (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether writes will always
be written to stable storage before the write call returns. If this is
false then the server will be guided by the client's request in each
write call (clients can set a bit indicating that a particular write
should be synchronous). If this is true then every write will be
followed by a fsync() call to ensure the data is written to disk.
-Note that the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>"strict sync"</strong></a> parameter must be
+Note that the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>"strict sync"</strong></a> parameter must be
set to <code>"yes"</code> in order for this parameter to have any affect.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>"strict sync"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#strictsync"><strong>"strict sync"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> sync always = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> sync always = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="syslog"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>syslog (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter maps how Samba debug messages are logged onto the
+<p><a name="syslog"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>syslog (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter maps how Samba debug messages are logged onto the
system syslog logging levels. Samba debug level zero maps onto syslog
LOG_ERR, debug level one maps onto LOG_WARNING, debug level two maps
onto LOG_NOTICE, debug level three maps onto LOG_INFO. All higher
levels are mapped to LOG_DEBUG.
-<p><br>This paramter sets the threshold for sending messages to syslog.
+<p>This paramter sets the threshold for sending messages to syslog.
Only messages with debug level less than this value will be sent
to syslog.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> syslog = 1</code>
-<p><br><a name="syslogonly"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>syslog only (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this parameter is set then Samba debug messages are logged into the
+<p><a name="syslogonly"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>syslog only (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this parameter is set then Samba debug messages are logged into the
system syslog only, and not to the debug log files.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> syslog only = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="templatehomedir"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>template homedir (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
-<p><br>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
+<p><a name="templatehomedir"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>template homedir (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
+<p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon uses this parameter to fill in
the home directory for that user. If the string <code>%D</code> is present it is
substituted with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string <code>%U</code>
is present it is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> template homedir = /home/%D/%U</code>
-<p><br><a name="templateshell"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>template shell (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
-<p><br>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
+<p><a name="templateshell"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>template shell (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
+<p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon uses this parameter to fill in
the login shell for that user.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> template shell = /bin/false</code>
-<p><br><a name="timeoffset"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>time offset (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add to the normal GMT to
+<p><a name="timeoffset"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>time offset (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add to the normal GMT to
local time conversion. This is useful if you are serving a lot of PCs
that have incorrect daylight saving time handling.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> time offset = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> time offset = 60</code>
-<p><br><a name="timeserver"></a>
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>time server (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> advertises
+<p><a name="timeserver"></a>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>time server (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> advertises
itself as a time server to Windows clients. The default is False.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> time server = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> time server = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="timestamplogs"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>timestamp logs (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="debugtimestamp"><strong>"debug timestamp"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="unixpasswordsync"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>unix password sync (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba attempts to synchronize
+<p><a name="timestamplogs"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>timestamp logs (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="debugtimestamp"><strong>"debug timestamp"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="unixpasswordsync"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>unix password sync (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba attempts to synchronize
the UNIX password with the SMB password when the encrypted SMB
password in the smbpasswd file is changed. If this is set to true the
-program specified in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a>
+program specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a>
parameter is called <em>*AS ROOT*</em> - to allow the new UNIX password to be
set without access to the old UNIX password (as the SMB password has
change code has no access to the old password cleartext, only the
new). By default this is set to <code>"false"</code>.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a>, <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdprogram"><strong>"passwd program"</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwdchat"><strong>"passwd
chat"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> unix password sync = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> unix password sync = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="unixrealname"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>unix realname (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter when set causes samba to supply the real name
+<p><a name="unixrealname"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>unix realname (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter when set causes samba to supply the real name
field from the unix password file to the client. This is useful for
setting up mail clients and WWW browsers on systems used by more than
one person.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> unix realname = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> unix realname = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="updateencrypted"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>update encrypted (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter allows a user logging on with a plaintext
+<p><a name="updateencrypted"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>update encrypted (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter allows a user logging on with a plaintext
password to have their encrypted (hashed) password in the smbpasswd
file to be updated automatically as they log on. This option allows a
site to migrate from plaintext password authentication (users
@@ -4526,80 +4526,80 @@ change is made. This is a convenience option to allow the change over
to encrypted passwords to be made over a longer period. Once all users
have encrypted representations of their passwords in the smbpasswd
file this parameter should be set to <code>"off"</code>.
-<p><br>In order for this parameter to work correctly the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypt
+<p>In order for this parameter to work correctly the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#encryptpasswords"><strong>"encrypt
passwords"</strong></a> parameter must be set to <code>"no"</code> when
this parameter is set to <code>"yes"</code>.
-<p><br>Note that even when this parameter is set a user authenticating to
+<p>Note that even when this parameter is set a user authenticating to
smbd must still enter a valid password in order to connect correctly,
and to update their hashed (smbpasswd) passwords.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> update encrypted = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> update encrypted = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="userhosts"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>use rhosts (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>If this global parameter is a true, it specifies that the UNIX users
+<p><a name="userhosts"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>use rhosts (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>If this global parameter is a true, it specifies that the UNIX users
<code>".rhosts"</code> file in their home directory will be read to find the
names of hosts and users who will be allowed access without specifying
a password.
-<p><br>NOTE: The use of <strong>use rhosts</strong> can be a major security hole. This is
+<p>NOTE: The use of <strong>use rhosts</strong> can be a major security hole. This is
because you are trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is
very easy to get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the
<strong>use rhosts</strong> option be only used if you really know what you are
doing.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> use rhosts = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> use rhosts = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="user"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>user (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>"username"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="users"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>users (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>"username"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="username"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>username (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited list, in which
+<p><a name="user"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>user (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>"username"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="users"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>users (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#username"><strong>"username"</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="username"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>username (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited list, in which
case the supplied password will be tested against each username in
turn (left to right).
-<p><br>The <strong>username=</strong> line is needed only when the PC is unable to supply
+<p>The <strong>username=</strong> line is needed only when the PC is unable to supply
its own username. This is the case for the COREPLUS protocol or where
your users have different WfWg usernames to UNIX usernames. In both
these cases you may also be better using the <code>\\server\share%user</code>
syntax instead.
-<p><br>The <strong>username=</strong> line is not a great solution in many cases as it
+<p>The <strong>username=</strong> line is not a great solution in many cases as it
means Samba will try to validate the supplied password against each of
the usernames in the username= line in turn. This is slow and a bad
idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords. You may get
timeouts or security breaches using this parameter unwisely.
-<p><br>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This parameter does not
+<p>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This parameter does not
restrict who can login, it just offers hints to the Samba server as to
what usernames might correspond to the supplied password. Users can
login as whoever they please and they will be able to do no more
damage than if they started a telnet session. The daemon runs as the
user that they log in as, so they cannot do anything that user cannot
do.
-<p><br>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you can use the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>"valid users="</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'@'</code> then the name will be
+<p>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you can use the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#validusers"><strong>"valid users="</strong></a> parameter.
+<p>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'@'</code> then the name will be
looked up first in the yp netgroups list (if Samba is compiled with
netgroup support), followed by a lookup in the UNIX groups database
and will expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.
-<p><br>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'+'</code> then the name will be
+<p>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'+'</code> then the name will be
looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list
of all users in the group of that name.
-<p><br>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'&amp;'</code> then the name will be
+<p>If any of the usernames begin with a <code>'&amp;'</code> then the name will be
looked up only in the yp netgroups database (if Samba is compiled with
netgroup support) and will expand to a list of all users in the
netgroup group of that name.
-<p><br>Note that searching though a groups database can take quite some time,
+<p>Note that searching though a groups database can take quite some time,
and some clients may time out during the search.
-<p><br>See the section <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
+<p>See the section <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NOTEABOUTUSERNAMEPASSWORDVALIDATION"><strong>"NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD
VALIDATION"</strong></a> for more
information on how this parameter determines access to the services.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> The guest account if a guest service, else the name of the service.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Examples:</strong>
+<p><strong>Examples:</strong>
<pre>
username = fred
@@ -4607,159 +4607,159 @@ information on how this parameter determines access to the services.
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="usernamelevel"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>username level (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at the real UNIX username,
+<p><a name="usernamelevel"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>username level (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at the real UNIX username,
as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase username. By default Samba
tries all lowercase, followed by the username with the first letter
capitalized, and fails if the username is not found on the UNIX
machine.
-<p><br>If this parameter is set to non-zero the behavior changes. This
+<p>If this parameter is set to non-zero the behavior changes. This
parameter is a number that specifies the number of uppercase
combinations to try whilst trying to determine the UNIX user name. The
higher the number the more combinations will be tried, but the slower
the discovery of usernames will be. Use this parameter when you have
strange usernames on your UNIX machine, such as <code>"AstrangeUser"</code>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> username level = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> username level = 5</code>
-<p><br><a name="usernamemap"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>username map (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option allows you to specify a file containing a mapping of
+<p><a name="usernamemap"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>username map (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option allows you to specify a file containing a mapping of
usernames from the clients to the server. This can be used for several
purposes. The most common is to map usernames that users use on DOS or
Windows machines to those that the UNIX box uses. The other is to map
multiple users to a single username so that they can more easily share
files.
-<p><br>The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should contain a single
+<p>The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should contain a single
UNIX username on the left then a <code>'='</code> followed by a list of
usernames on the right. The list of usernames on the right may contain
names of the form @group in which case they will match any UNIX
username in that group. The special client name <code>'*'</code> is a wildcard
and matches any name. Each line of the map file may be up to 1023
characters long.
-<p><br>The file is processed on each line by taking the supplied username and
+<p>The file is processed on each line by taking the supplied username and
comparing it with each username on the right hand side of the <code>'='</code>
signs. If the supplied name matches any of the names on the right hand
side then it is replaced with the name on the left. Processing then
continues with the next line.
-<p><br>If any line begins with a <code>'#'</code> or a <code>';'</code> then it is ignored
-<p><br>If any line begins with an <code>'!'</code> then the processing will stop after
+<p>If any line begins with a <code>'#'</code> or a <code>';'</code> then it is ignored
+<p>If any line begins with an <code>'!'</code> then the processing will stop after
that line if a mapping was done by the line. Otherwise mapping
continues with every line being processed. Using <code>'!'</code> is most
useful when you have a wildcard mapping line later in the file.
-<p><br>For example to map from the name <code>"admin"</code> or <code>"administrator"</code> to
+<p>For example to map from the name <code>"admin"</code> or <code>"administrator"</code> to
the UNIX name <code>"root"</code> you would use:
-<p><br><code> root = admin administrator</code>
-<p><br>Or to map anyone in the UNIX group <code>"system"</code> to the UNIX name
+<p><code> root = admin administrator</code>
+<p>Or to map anyone in the UNIX group <code>"system"</code> to the UNIX name
<code>"sys"</code> you would use:
-<p><br><code> sys = @system</code>
-<p><br>You can have as many mappings as you like in a username map file.
-<p><br>If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then the netgroup
+<p><code> sys = @system</code>
+<p>You can have as many mappings as you like in a username map file.
+<p>If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then the netgroup
database is checked before the <code>/etc/group</code> database for matching
groups.
-<p><br>You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them by using double
+<p>You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them by using double
quotes around the name. For example:
-<p><br><code> tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</code>
-<p><br>would map the windows username <code>"Andrew Tridgell"</code> to the unix
+<p><code> tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</code>
+<p>would map the windows username <code>"Andrew Tridgell"</code> to the unix
username tridge.
-<p><br>The following example would map mary and fred to the unix user sys,
+<p>The following example would map mary and fred to the unix user sys,
and map the rest to guest. Note the use of the <code>'!'</code> to tell Samba
to stop processing if it gets a match on that line.
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
!sys = mary fred
guest = *
</pre>
-<p><br>Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences of
+<p>Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences of
usernames. Thus if you connect to <code>"\\server\fred"</code> and <code>"fred"</code>
is remapped to <code>"mary"</code> then you will actually be connecting to
<code>"\\server\mary"</code> and will need to supply a password suitable for
<code>"mary"</code> not <code>"fred"</code>. The only exception to this is the username
-passed to the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> (if you have
+passed to the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#passwordserver"><strong>"password server"</strong></a> (if you have
one). The password server will receive whatever username the client
supplies without modification.
-<p><br>Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect this has is
+<p>Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect this has is
with printing. Users who have been mapped may have trouble deleting
print jobs as PrintManager under WfWg will think they don't own the
print job.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> no username map</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map</code>
-<p><br><a name="utmp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>utmp (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
+<p><a name="utmp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>utmp (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
with the option <code>--with-utmp</code>. If set to True then Samba will attempt
to add utmp or utmpx records (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a
connection is made to a Samba server. Sites may use this to record the
user connecting to a Samba share.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#utmpdirectory"><strong>"utmp directory"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#utmpdirectory"><strong>"utmp directory"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code>utmp = False</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code>utmp = True</code>
-<p><br><a name="utmpdirectory"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>utmp directory(G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
+<p><a name="utmpdirectory"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>utmp directory(G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is only available if Samba has been configured and compiled
with the option <code>--with-utmp</code>. It specifies a directory pathname that is
used to store the utmp or utmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
-record user connections to a Samba server. See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#utmp"><strong>"utmp"</strong></a>
+record user connections to a Samba server. See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#utmp"><strong>"utmp"</strong></a>
parameter. By default this is not set, meaning the system will use whatever
utmp file the native system is set to use (usually /var/run/utmp on Linux).
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code>no utmp directory</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code>utmp directory = /var/adm/</code>
-<p><br><a name="winbindcachetime"></a>
-<li><strong>winbind cache time</strong>
-<p><br>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
-<p><br>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
+<p><a name="winbindcachetime"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>winbind cache time</strong><dd>
+<p>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
+<p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon will cache user and group
information before querying a Windows NT server again.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> winbind cache type = 15</code>
-<p><br><a name="winbindgid"></a>
-<li><strong>winbind gid</strong>
-<p><br>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
-<p><br>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group ids that are
+<p><a name="winbindgid"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>winbind gid</strong><dd>
+<p>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
+<p>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group ids that are
allocated by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon. This range of
group ids should have no existing local or nis groups within it as strange
conflicts can occur otherwise.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> winbind gid = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> winbind gid = 10000-20000</code>
-<p><br><a name="winbinduid"></a>
-<li><strong>winbind uid</strong>
-<p><br>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
-<p><br>The winbind uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
+<p><a name="winbinduid"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong>winbind uid</strong><dd>
+<p>NOTE: this parameter is only available in Samba 3.0.
+<p>The winbind uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
allocated by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon. This range of
ids should have no existing local or nis users within it as strange
conflicts can occur otherwise.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> winbind uid = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> winbind uid = 10000-20000</code>
-<p><br><a name="validchars"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>valid chars (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>The option allows you to specify additional characters that should be
+<p><a name="validchars"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>valid chars (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>The option allows you to specify additional characters that should be
considered valid by the server in filenames. This is particularly
useful for national character sets, such as adding u-umlaut or a-ring.
-<p><br>The option takes a list of characters in either integer or character
+<p>The option takes a list of characters in either integer or character
form with spaces between them. If you give two characters with a colon
between them then it will be taken as an lowercase:uppercase pair.
-<p><br>If you have an editor capable of entering the characters into the
+<p>If you have an editor capable of entering the characters into the
config file then it is probably easiest to use this method. Otherwise
you can specify the characters in octal, decimal or hexadecimal form
using the usual C notation.
-<p><br>For example to add the single character <code>'Z'</code> to the charset (which
+<p>For example to add the single character <code>'Z'</code> to the charset (which
is a pointless thing to do as it's already there) you could do one of
the following
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
valid chars = Z
valid chars = z:Z
@@ -4767,15 +4767,15 @@ the following
</pre>
-<p><br>The last two examples above actually add two characters, and alter the
+<p>The last two examples above actually add two characters, and alter the
uppercase and lowercase mappings appropriately.
-<p><br>Note that you MUST specify this parameter after the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client
+<p>Note that you MUST specify this parameter after the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client
code page"</strong></a> parameter if you have both set. If
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code page"</strong></a> is set after the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code page"</strong></a> is set after the
<strong>"valid chars"</strong> parameter the <strong>"valid chars"</strong> settings will be
overwritten.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code page"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#clientcodepage"><strong>"client code page"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<pre>
Samba defaults to using a reasonable set of valid characters
@@ -4783,60 +4783,60 @@ overwritten.
</pre>
-<p><br><strong>Example</strong>
+<p><strong>Example</strong>
<code> valid chars = 0345:0305 0366:0326 0344:0304</code>
-<p><br>The above example allows filenames to have the Swedish characters in
+<p>The above example allows filenames to have the Swedish characters in
them.
-<p><br>NOTE: It is actually quite difficult to correctly produce a <strong>"valid
+<p>NOTE: It is actually quite difficult to correctly produce a <strong>"valid
chars"</strong> line for a particular system. To automate the process
<a href="mailto:tino@augsburg.net"><em>tino@augsburg.net</em></a> has written a package called <strong>"validchars"</strong>
which will automatically produce a complete <strong>"valid chars"</strong> line for
a given client system. Look in the examples/validchars/ subdirectory
of your Samba source code distribution for this package.
-<p><br><a name="validusers"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>valid users (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of users that should be allowed to login to this
+<p><a name="validusers"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>valid users (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of users that should be allowed to login to this
service. Names starting with <code>'@'</code>, <code>'+'</code> and <code>'&amp;'</code> are
-interpreted using the same rules as described in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid
+interpreted using the same rules as described in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid
users"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br>If this is empty (the default) then any user can login. If a username
-is in both this list and the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a>
+<p>If this is empty (the default) then any user can login. If a username
+is in both this list and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a>
list then access is denied for that user.
-<p><br>The current servicename is substituted for
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>"%S"</strong></a>. This is useful in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> section.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>The current servicename is substituted for
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#percentS"><strong>"%S"</strong></a>. This is useful in the
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> section.
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#invalidusers"><strong>"invalid users"</strong></a>.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> No valid users list. (anyone can login)</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> valid users = greg, @pcusers</code>
-<p><br><a name="vetofiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>veto files(S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of files and directories that are neither visible nor
+<p><a name="vetofiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>veto files(S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of files and directories that are neither visible nor
accessible. Each entry in the list must be separated by a <code>'/'</code>,
which allows spaces to be included in the entry. <code>'*'</code> and <code>'?'</code>
can be used to specify multiple files or directories as in DOS
wildcards.
-<p><br>Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and must <em>*not*</em> include the
+<p>Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and must <em>*not*</em> include the
unix directory separator <code>'/'</code>.
-<p><br>Note that the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a> option is
+<p>Note that the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case sensitive"</strong></a> option is
applicable in vetoing files.
-<p><br>One feature of the veto files parameter that it is important to be
+<p>One feature of the veto files parameter that it is important to be
aware of, is that if a directory contains nothing but files that match
the veto files parameter (which means that Windows/DOS clients cannot
ever see them) is deleted, the veto files within that directory *are
automatically deleted* along with it, if the user has UNIX permissions
to do so.
-<p><br>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, as it
+<p>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba, as it
will be forced to check all files and directories for a match as they
are scanned.
-<p><br>See also <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>"hide files"</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case
+<p>See also <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hidefiles"><strong>"hide files"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#casesensitive"><strong>"case
sensitive"</strong></a>.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> No files or directories are vetoed.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Examples:</strong>
-<p><br>Example 1.
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><strong>Examples:</strong>
+<p>Example 1.
+<p><pre>
Veto any files containing the word Security,
@@ -4847,8 +4847,8 @@ sensitive"</strong></a>.
</pre>
-<p><br>Example 2.
-<p><br><pre>
+<p>Example 2.
+<p><pre>
Veto the Apple specific files that a NetAtalk server
creates.
@@ -4857,170 +4857,170 @@ sensitive"</strong></a>.
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="vetooplockfiles"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>veto oplock files (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter is only valid when the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a>
+<p><a name="vetooplockfiles"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>veto oplock files (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter is only valid when the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#oplocks"><strong>"oplocks"</strong></a>
parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator
to selectively turn off the granting of oplocks on selected files that
match a wildcarded list, similar to the wildcarded list used in the
-<a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>"veto files"</strong></a> parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<a href="smb.conf.5.html#vetofiles"><strong>"veto files"</strong></a> parameter.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> No files are vetoed for oplock grants.</code>
-<p><br><strong>Examples:</strong>
-<p><br>You might want to do this on files that you know will be heavily
+<p><strong>Examples:</strong>
+<p>You might want to do this on files that you know will be heavily
contended for by clients. A good example of this is in the NetBench
SMB benchmark program, which causes heavy client contention for files
ending in <code>".SEM"</code>. To cause Samba not to grant oplocks on these
-files you would use the line (either in the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>
+files you would use the line (either in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#global"><strong>[global]</strong></a>
section or in the section for the particular NetBench share :
-<p><br><code> veto oplock files = /*.SEM/</code>
-<p><br><a name="volume"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>volume (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This allows you to override the volume label returned for a
+<p><code> veto oplock files = /*.SEM/</code>
+<p><a name="volume"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>volume (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This allows you to override the volume label returned for a
share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs that insist on a
particular volume label.
-<p><br>The default is the name of the share.
-<p><br><a name="widelinks"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>wide links (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls whether or not links in the UNIX file system
+<p>The default is the name of the share.
+<p><a name="widelinks"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>wide links (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls whether or not links in the UNIX file system
may be followed by the server. Links that point to areas within the
directory tree exported by the server are always allowed; this
parameter controls access only to areas that are outside the directory
tree being exported.
-<p><br>Note that setting this parameter can have a negative effect on your
+<p>Note that setting this parameter can have a negative effect on your
server performance due to the extra system calls that Samba has to
do in order to perform the link checks.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> wide links = yes</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> wide links = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="winsproxy"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>wins proxy (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a boolean that controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
+<p><a name="winsproxy"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>wins proxy (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a boolean that controls if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> will
respond to broadcast name queries on behalf of other hosts. You may
need to set this to <code>"yes"</code> for some older clients.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> wins proxy = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="winsserver"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>wins server (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP address for preference)
+<p><a name="winsserver"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>wins server (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP address for preference)
of the WINS server that <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> should register with.
If you have a WINS server on your network then you should set this to
the WINS server's IP.
-<p><br>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
+<p>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
multi-subnetted network.
-<p><br><em>NOTE</em>. You need to set up Samba to point to a WINS server if you
+<p><em>NOTE</em>. You need to set up Samba to point to a WINS server if you
have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet browsing to work correctly.
-<p><br>See the documentation file BROWSING.txt in the docs/ directory of your
+<p>See the documentation file BROWSING.txt in the docs/ directory of your
Samba source distribution.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> wins server = </code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> wins server = 192.9.200.1</code>
-<p><br><a name="winshook"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>wins hook (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>When Samba is running as a WINS server this allows you to call an
+<p><a name="winshook"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>wins hook (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>When Samba is running as a WINS server this allows you to call an
external program for all changes to the WINS database. The primary use
for this option is to allow the dynamic update of external name
resolution databases such as dynamic DNS.
-<p><br>The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script or executable
+<p>The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script or executable
that will be called as follows:
-<p><br>wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list
-<p><br>The first argument is the operation and is one of "add", "delete",
+<p>wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list
+<p>The first argument is the operation and is one of "add", "delete",
or "refresh". In most cases the operation can be ignored as the rest
of the parameters provide sufficient information. Note that "refresh"
may sometimes be called when the name has not previously been added,
in that case it should be treated as an add.
-<p><br>The second argument is the netbios name. If the name is not a legal
+<p>The second argument is the netbios name. If the name is not a legal
name then the wins hook is not called. Legal names contain only
letters, digits, hyphens, underscores and periods.
-<p><br>The third argument is the netbios name type as a 2 digit hexadecimal
+<p>The third argument is the netbios name type as a 2 digit hexadecimal
number.
-<p><br>The fourth argument is the TTL (time to live) for the name in seconds.
-<p><br>The fifth and subsequent arguments are the IP addresses currently
+<p>The fourth argument is the TTL (time to live) for the name in seconds.
+<p>The fifth and subsequent arguments are the IP addresses currently
registered for that name. If this list is empty then the name should
be deleted.
-<p><br>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update program
+<p>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update program
"nsupdate" is provided in the examples directory of the Samba source
code.
-<p><br><a name="winssupport"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>wins support (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This boolean controls if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> process in
+<p><a name="winssupport"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>wins support (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This boolean controls if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> process in
Samba will act as a WINS server. You should not set this to true
unless you have a multi-subnetted network and you wish a particular
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> to be your WINS server. Note that you
should <em>*NEVER*</em> set this to true on more than one machine in your
network.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> wins support = no</code>
-<p><br><a name="workgroup"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>workgroup (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This controls what workgroup your server will appear to be in when
+<p><a name="workgroup"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>workgroup (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This controls what workgroup your server will appear to be in when
queried by clients. Note that this parameter also controls the Domain
-name used with the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>
+name used with the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#securityequaldomain"><strong>"security=domain"</strong></a>
setting.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> set at compile time to WORKGROUP</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
workgroup = MYGROUP
-<p><br><a name="writable"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>writable (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a> for people who can't spell :-).
-<p><br><a name="writelist"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>write list (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This is a list of users that are given read-write access to a
+<p><a name="writable"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>writable (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a> for people who can't spell :-).
+<p><a name="writelist"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>write list (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This is a list of users that are given read-write access to a
service. If the connecting user is in this list then they will be
-given write access, no matter what the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>
+given write access, no matter what the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>"writeable"</strong></a>
option is set to. The list can include group names using the @group
syntax.
-<p><br>Note that if a user is in both the read list and the write list then
+<p>Note that if a user is in both the read list and the write list then
they will be given write access.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readlist"><strong>"read list"</strong></a> option.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p>See also the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readlist"><strong>"read list"</strong></a> option.
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> write list = &lt;empty string&gt;</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> write list = admin, root, @staff</code>
-<p><br><a name="writecachesize"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>write cache size (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This integer parameter (new with Samba 2.0.7) if set to non-zero causes Samba to create an in-memory
+<p><a name="writecachesize"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>write cache size (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This integer parameter (new with Samba 2.0.7) if set to non-zero causes Samba to create an in-memory
cache for each oplocked file (it does <strong>not</strong> do this for non-oplocked files). All
writes that the client does not request to be flushed directly to disk will be
stored in this cache if possible. The cache is flushed onto disk when a write
comes in whose offset would not fit into the cache or when the file is closed
by the client. Reads for the file are also served from this cache if the data
is stored within it.
-<p><br>This cache allows Samba to batch client writes into a more efficient write
+<p>This cache allows Samba to batch client writes into a more efficient write
size for RAID disks (ie. writes may be tuned to be the RAID stripe size) and
can improve performance on systems where the disk subsystem is a bottleneck
but there is free memory for userspace programs.
-<p><br>The integer parameter specifies the size of this cache (per oplocked file)
+<p>The integer parameter specifies the size of this cache (per oplocked file)
in bytes.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> write cache size = 0</code>
-<p><br><strong>Example:</strong>
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
<code> write cache size = 262144</code>
for a 256k cache size per file.
-<p><br><a name="writeok"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>write ok (S)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>Synonym for <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>writeable</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="writeraw"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>write raw (G)</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This parameter controls whether or not the server will support raw
+<p><a name="writeok"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>write ok (S)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>Synonym for <a href="smb.conf.5.html#writeable"><strong>writeable</strong></a>.
+<p><a name="writeraw"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>write raw (G)</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This parameter controls whether or not the server will support raw
writes SMB's when transferring data from clients. You should never
need to change this parameter.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> write raw = yes</code>
-<p><br><a name="writeable"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>writeable</strong></strong>
-<p><br>An inverted synonym is <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>"read only"</strong></a>.
-<p><br>If this parameter is <code>"no"</code>, then users of a service may not create
+<p><a name="writeable"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>writeable</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>An inverted synonym is <a href="smb.conf.5.html#readonly"><strong>"read only"</strong></a>.
+<p>If this parameter is <code>"no"</code>, then users of a service may not create
or modify files in the service's directory.
-<p><br>Note that a printable service <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>("printable = yes")</strong></a>
+<p>Note that a printable service <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printable"><strong>("printable = yes")</strong></a>
will <em>*ALWAYS*</em> allow writing to the directory (user privileges
permitting), but only via spooling operations.
-<p><br><strong>Default:</strong>
+<p><strong>Default:</strong>
<code> writeable = no</code>
-<p><br><strong>Examples:</strong>
+<p><strong>Examples:</strong>
<pre>
read only = no
@@ -5029,50 +5029,50 @@ permitting), but only via spooling operations.
</pre>
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="WARNINGS"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="WARNINGS"></a>
<h2>WARNINGS</h2>
-<p><br>Although the configuration file permits service names to contain
+<p>Although the configuration file permits service names to contain
spaces, your client software may not. Spaces will be ignored in
comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a problem - but be aware of the
possibility.
-<p><br>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients - limit
+<p>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients - limit
service names to eight characters. <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>Smbd</strong></a> has no
such limitation, but attempts to connect from such clients will fail
if they truncate the service names. For this reason you should
probably keep your service names down to eight characters in length.
-<p><br>Use of the <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and <a href="../yodldocs/smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a>
+<p>Use of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#homes"><strong>[homes]</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#printers"><strong>[printers]</strong></a>
special sections make life for an administrator easy, but the various
combinations of default attributes can be tricky. Take extreme care
when designing these sections. In particular, ensure that the
permissions on spool directories are correct.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>,
+<p><a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>,
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm (1)</strong></a>,
<a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns (1)</strong></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>Samba</strong></a>,
<a href="nmblookup.1.html"><strong>nmblookup (1)</strong></a>, <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd (5)</strong></a>,
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
index a68538aa155..42136f19474 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbclient (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,575 +16,574 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbclient - ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources on servers
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbclient</strong> <a href="smbclient.1.html#servicename">servicename</a> [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minuss">-s smb.conf</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusO">-O socket options</a>][<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusR">-R name resolve order</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusM">-M NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusi">-i scope</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN">-N</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusn">-n NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusp">-p port</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusl">-l log basename</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusI">-I dest IP</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusE">-E</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU">-U username</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusL">-L NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minust">-t terminal code</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusm">-m max protocol</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusb">-b buffersize</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusW">-W workgroup</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusT">-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusD">-D directory</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusc">-c command string</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbclient</strong> <a href="smbclient.1.html#servicename">servicename</a> [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minuss">-s smb.conf</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusO">-O socket options</a>][<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusR">-R name resolve order</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusM">-M NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusi">-i scope</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN">-N</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusn">-n NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusp">-p port</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusl">-l log basename</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusI">-I dest IP</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusE">-E</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU">-U username</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusL">-L NetBIOS name</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minust">-t terminal code</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusm">-m max protocol</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusb">-b buffersize</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusW">-W workgroup</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusT">-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusD">-D directory</a>] [<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusc">-c command string</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>smbclient</strong> is a client that can 'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>smbclient</strong> is a client that can 'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It
offers an interface similar to that of the ftp program (see <strong>ftp
(1)</strong>). Operations include things like getting files from the server
to the local machine, putting files from the local machine to the
server, retrieving directory information from the server and so on.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="servicename"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>servicename</strong></strong> servicename is the name of the service you want
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="servicename"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>servicename</strong></strong><dd> servicename is the name of the service you want
to use on the server. A service name takes the form
<code>//server/service</code> where <em>server</em> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS
server offering the desired service and <em>service</em> is the name
of the service offered. Thus to connect to the service <em>printer</em> on
the SMB/CIFS server <em>smbserver</em>, you would use the servicename
-<p><br><code>//smbserver/printer</code>
-<p><br>Note that the server name required is NOT necessarily the IP (DNS)
+<p><code>//smbserver/printer</code>
+<p>Note that the server name required is NOT necessarily the IP (DNS)
host name of the server ! The name required is a NetBIOS server name,
which may or may not be the same as the IP hostname of the machine
running the server.
-<p><br>The server name is looked up according to either the
+<p>The server name is looked up according to either the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusR"><strong>-R</strong></a> parameter to <strong>smbclient</strong> or using the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a>
parameter in the smb.conf file, allowing an administrator to change
the order and methods by which server names are looked up.
-<p><br><a name="password"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>password</strong></strong> password is the password required to access the
+<p><a name="password"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>password</strong></strong><dd> password is the password required to access the
specified service on the specified server. If this parameter is
supplied, the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN"><strong>-N</strong></a> option (suppress password prompt) is assumed.
-<p><br>There is no default password. If no password is supplied on the
+<p>There is no default password. If no password is supplied on the
command line (either by using this parameter or adding a password to
the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU"><strong>-U</strong></a> option (see below)) and the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN"><strong>-N</strong></a> option is not specified,
the client will prompt for a password, even if the desired service
does not require one. (If no password is required, simply press ENTER
to provide a null password.)
-<p><br>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for Workgroups) insist
+<p>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for Workgroups) insist
on an uppercase password. Lowercase or mixed case passwords may be
rejected by these servers.
-<p><br>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts.
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s smb.conf</strong></strong> This parameter specifies the pathname to the
+<p>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts.
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s smb.conf</strong></strong><dd> This parameter specifies the pathname to the
Samba configuration file, smb.conf. This file controls all aspects of
the Samba setup on the machine and smbclient also needs to read this
file.
-<p><br><a name="minusO"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-O socket options</strong></strong> TCP socket options to set on the client
+<p><a name="minusO"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-O socket options</strong></strong><dd> TCP socket options to set on the client
socket. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions">socket options</a>
parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> manpage for
the list of valid options.
-<p><br><a name="minusR"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-R name resolve order</strong></strong> This option allows the user of
+<p><a name="minusR"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-R name resolve order</strong></strong><dd> This option allows the user of
smbclient to determine what name resolution services to use when
looking up the NetBIOS name of the host being connected to.
-<p><br>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause
+<p>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause
names to be resolved as follows :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>lmhosts</strong> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file.
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>lmhosts</strong> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file.
The lmhosts file is stored in the same directory as the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><li > <strong>host</strong> : Do a standard host name to IP address resolution,
+<p><li > <strong>host</strong> : Do a standard host name to IP address resolution,
using the system /etc/hosts, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name
resolution is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or
Solaris this may be controlled by the <em>/etc/nsswitch.conf</em> file).
-<p><br><li > <strong>wins</strong> : Query a name with the IP address listed in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins
+<p><li > <strong>wins</strong> : Query a name with the IP address listed in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins
server</strong></a> parameter in the smb.conf file. If
no WINS server has been specified this method will be ignored.
-<p><br><li > <strong>bcast</strong> : Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
+<p><li > <strong>bcast</strong> : Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
listed in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a> parameter
in the smb.conf file. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally connected
subnet.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order defined
+<p></dl>
+<p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order defined
in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file parameter
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder">(<strong>name resolve order</strong>)</a>
will be used.
-<p><br>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without this
+<p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without this
parameter or any entry in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>"name resolve
order"</strong></a> parameter of the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file the name resolution methods
will be attempted in this order.
-<p><br><a name="minusM"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-M NetBIOS name</strong></strong> This options allows you to send messages,
+<p><a name="minusM"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-M NetBIOS name</strong></strong><dd> This options allows you to send messages,
using the "WinPopup" protocol, to another computer. Once a connection
is established you then type your message, pressing ^D (control-D) to
end.
-<p><br>If the receiving computer is running WinPopup the user will receive
+<p>If the receiving computer is running WinPopup the user will receive
the message and probably a beep. If they are not running WinPopup the
message will be lost, and no error message will occur.
-<p><br>The message is also automatically truncated if the message is over
+<p>The message is also automatically truncated if the message is over
1600 bytes, as this is the limit of the protocol.
-<p><br>One useful trick is to cat the message through <strong>smbclient</strong>.
+<p>One useful trick is to cat the message through <strong>smbclient</strong>.
For example:
-<p><br><code>cat mymessage.txt | smbclient -M FRED</code>
-<p><br>will send the message in the file <em>mymessage.txt</em> to the machine FRED.
-<p><br>You may also find the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU"><strong>-U</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusI"><strong>-I</strong></a> options useful, as they allow
+<p><code>cat mymessage.txt | smbclient -M FRED</code>
+<p>will send the message in the file <em>mymessage.txt</em> to the machine FRED.
+<p>You may also find the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU"><strong>-U</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusI"><strong>-I</strong></a> options useful, as they allow
you to control the FROM and TO parts of the message.
-<p><br>See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#messagecommand"><strong>message command</strong></a>
+<p>See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#messagecommand"><strong>message command</strong></a>
parameter in the <strong>smb.conf (5)</strong> for a description of how to handle
incoming WinPopup messages in Samba.
-<p><br>Note: Copy WinPopup into the startup group on your WfWg PCs if you
+<p>Note: Copy WinPopup into the startup group on your WfWg PCs if you
want them to always be able to receive messages.
-<p><br><a name="minusi"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that smbclient will use
+<p><a name="minusi"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong><dd> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that smbclient will use
to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the
use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes
are <em>very</em> rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
communicate with.
-<p><br><a name="minusN"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-N</strong></strong> If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal
+<p><a name="minusN"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-N</strong></strong><dd> If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal
password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when
accessing a service that does not require a password.
-<p><br>Unless a password is specified on the command line or this parameter
+<p>Unless a password is specified on the command line or this parameter
is specified, the client will request a password.
-<p><br><a name="minusn"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-n NetBIOS name</strong></strong> By default, the client will use the local
+<p><a name="minusn"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-n NetBIOS name</strong></strong><dd> By default, the client will use the local
machine's hostname (in uppercase) as its NetBIOS name. This parameter
allows you to override the host name and use whatever NetBIOS name you
wish.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10, or the
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong><dd> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10, or the
letter 'A'.
-<p><br>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
-<p><br>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
+<p>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
+<p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
about the activities of the client. At level 0, only critical errors
and serious warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of information about
operations carried out.
-<p><br>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
+<p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are
designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic. If debuglevel is set to the
letter 'A', then <em>all</em> debug messages will be printed. This setting
is for developers only (and people who <em>really</em> want to know how the
code works internally).
-<p><br>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
+<p>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
level</strong></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minusP"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong> This option is no longer used. The code in Samba2.0
+<p><a name="minusP"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong><dd> This option is no longer used. The code in Samba2.0
now lets the server decide the device type, so no printer specific
flag is needed.
-<p><br><a name="minusp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-p port</strong></strong> This number is the TCP port number that will be used
+<p><a name="minusp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-p port</strong></strong><dd> This number is the TCP port number that will be used
when making connections to the server. The standard (well-known) TCP
port number for an SMB/CIFS server is 139, which is the default.
-<p><br><a name="minusl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-l logfilename</strong></strong> If specified, logfilename specifies a base
+<p><a name="minusl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-l logfilename</strong></strong><dd> If specified, logfilename specifies a base
filename into which operational data from the running client will be
logged.
-<p><br>The default base name is specified at compile time.
-<p><br>The base name is used to generate actual log file names. For example,
+<p>The default base name is specified at compile time.
+<p>The base name is used to generate actual log file names. For example,
if the name specified was "log", the debug file would be
<code>log.client</code>.
-<p><br>The log file generated is never removed by the client.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> Print the usage message for the client.
-<p><br><a name="minusI"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-I IP address</strong></strong> IP address is the address of the server to
+<p>The log file generated is never removed by the client.
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> Print the usage message for the client.
+<p><a name="minusI"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-I IP address</strong></strong><dd> IP address is the address of the server to
connect to. It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation.
-<p><br>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named SMB/CIFS server by
+<p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named SMB/CIFS server by
looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution mechanism described
above in the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusR"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a> parameter
above. Using this parameter will force the client to assume that the
server is on the machine with the specified IP address and the NetBIOS
name component of the resource being connected to will be ignored.
-<p><br>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied, it will be
+<p>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied, it will be
determined automatically by the client as described above.
-<p><br><a name="minusE"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-E</strong></strong> This parameter causes the client to write messages to the
+<p><a name="minusE"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-E</strong></strong><dd> This parameter causes the client to write messages to the
standard error stream (stderr) rather than to the standard output
stream.
-<p><br>By default, the client writes messages to standard output - typically
+<p>By default, the client writes messages to standard output - typically
the user's tty.
-<p><br><a name="minusU"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-U username</strong></strong> This specifies the user name that will be used by
+<p><a name="minusU"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-U username</strong></strong><dd> This specifies the user name that will be used by
the client to make a connection, assuming your server is not a downlevel
server that is running a protocol level that uses passwords on shares,
not on usernames.
-<p><br>Some servers are fussy about the case of this name, and some insist
+<p>Some servers are fussy about the case of this name, and some insist
that it must be a valid NetBIOS name.
-<p><br>If no username is supplied, it will default to an uppercase version of
+<p>If no username is supplied, it will default to an uppercase version of
the environment variable <code>USER</code> or <code>LOGNAME</code> in that order. If no
username is supplied and neither environment variable exists the
username "GUEST" will be used.
-<p><br>If the <code>USER</code> environment variable contains a '%' character,
+<p>If the <code>USER</code> environment variable contains a '%' character,
everything after that will be treated as a password. This allows you
to set the environment variable to be <code>USER=username%password</code> so
that a password is not passed on the command line (where it may be
seen by the ps command).
-<p><br>If the service you are connecting to requires a password, it can be
+<p>If the service you are connecting to requires a password, it can be
supplied using the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusU"><strong>-U</strong></a> option, by appending a percent symbol ("%")
then the password to username. For example, to attach to a service as
user <code>"fred"</code> with password <code>"secret"</code>, you would specify. <br>
-<p><br><code>-U fred%secret</code> <br>
-<p><br>on the command line. Note that there are no spaces around the percent
+<p><code>-U fred%secret</code> <br>
+<p>on the command line. Note that there are no spaces around the percent
symbol.
-<p><br>If you specify the password as part of username then the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN"><strong>-N</strong></a> option
+<p>If you specify the password as part of username then the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN"><strong>-N</strong></a> option
(suppress password prompt) is assumed.
-<p><br>If you specify the password as a parameter <em>AND</em> as part of username
+<p>If you specify the password as a parameter <em>AND</em> as part of username
then the password as part of username will take precedence. Putting
nothing before or nothing after the percent symbol will cause an empty
username or an empty password to be used, respectively.
-<p><br>The password may also be specified by setting up an environment
+<p>The password may also be specified by setting up an environment
variable called <code>PASSWD</code> that contains the users password. Note
that this may be very insecure on some systems but on others allows
users to script smbclient commands without having a password appear in
the command line of a process listing.
-<p><br>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for Workgroups) insist
+<p>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for Workgroups) insist
on an uppercase password. Lowercase or mixed case passwords may be
rejected by these servers.
-<p><br>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts or in the
+<p>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts or in the
<code>PASSWD</code> environment variable. Also, on many systems the command
line of a running process may be seen via the <code>ps</code> command to be
safe always allow smbclient to prompt for a password and type it in
directly.
-<p><br><a name="minusL"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-L</strong></strong> This option allows you to look at what services are
+<p><a name="minusL"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-L</strong></strong><dd> This option allows you to look at what services are
available on a server. You use it as <code>"smbclient -L host"</code> and a
list should appear. The <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusI"><strong>-I</strong></a> option may be useful if your NetBIOS
names don't match your tcp/ip dns host names or if you are trying to
reach a host on another network.
-<p><br><a name="minust"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-t terminal code</strong></strong> This option tells smbclient how to interpret
+<p><a name="minust"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-t terminal code</strong></strong><dd> This option tells smbclient how to interpret
filenames coming from the remote server. Usually Asian language
multibyte UNIX implementations use different character sets than
SMB/CIFS servers (<em>EUC</em> instead of <em>SJIS</em> for example). Setting
this parameter will let smbclient convert between the UNIX filenames
and the SMB filenames correctly. This option has not been seriously
tested and may have some problems.
-<p><br>The terminal codes include <code>sjis</code>, <code>euc</code>, <code>jis7</code>, <code>jis8</code>,
+<p>The terminal codes include <code>sjis</code>, <code>euc</code>, <code>jis7</code>, <code>jis8</code>,
<code>junet</code>, <code>hex</code>, <code>cap</code>. This is not a complete list, check the
Samba source code for the complete list.
-<p><br><a name="minusm"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-m max protocol level</strong></strong> With the new code in Samba2.0,
+<p><a name="minusm"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-m max protocol level</strong></strong><dd> With the new code in Samba2.0,
<strong>smbclient</strong> always attempts to connect at the maximum
protocols level the server supports. This parameter is
preserved for backwards compatibility, but any string
following the <strong>-m</strong> will be ignored.
-<p><br><a name="minusb"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-b buffersize</strong></strong> This option changes the transmit/send buffer
+<p><a name="minusb"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-b buffersize</strong></strong><dd> This option changes the transmit/send buffer
size when getting or putting a file from/to the server. The default
is 65520 bytes. Setting this value smaller (to 1200 bytes) has been
observed to speed up file transfers to and from a Win9x server.
-<p><br><a name="minusW"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-W WORKGROUP</strong></strong> Override the default workgroup specified in the
+<p><a name="minusW"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-W WORKGROUP</strong></strong><dd> Override the default workgroup specified in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#workgroup"><strong>workgroup</strong></a> parameter of the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file for this connection. This may
be needed to connect to some servers.
-<p><br><a name="minusT"></a> <li><strong><strong>-T tar options</strong></strong> smbclient may be used to create
+<p><a name="minusT"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>-T tar options</strong></strong><dd> smbclient may be used to create
<strong>tar (1)</strong> compatible backups of all the files on an SMB/CIFS
share. The secondary tar flags that can be given to this option are :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>c</strong></strong> Create a tar file on UNIX. Must be followed by the
+<p><dl>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>c</strong></strong><dd> Create a tar file on UNIX. Must be followed by the
name of a tar file, tape device or <code>"-"</code> for standard output. If
using standard output you must turn the log level to its lowest value
<code>-d0</code> to avoid corrupting your tar file. This flag is
mutually exclusive with the <strong>x</strong> flag.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>x</strong></strong> Extract (restore) a local tar file back to a
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>x</strong></strong><dd> Extract (restore) a local tar file back to a
share. Unless the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusD"><strong>-D</strong></a> option is given, the tar files will be
restored from the top level of the share. Must be followed by the name
of the tar file, device or <code>"-"</code> for standard input. Mutually exclusive
with the <strong>c</strong> flag. Restored files have their creation times (mtime)
set to the date saved in the tar file. Directories currently do not
get their creation dates restored properly.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>I</strong></strong> Include files and directories. Is the default
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>I</strong></strong><dd> Include files and directories. Is the default
behavior when filenames are specified above. Causes tar files to
be included in an extract or create (and therefore everything else to
be excluded). See example below. Filename globbing works
in one of two ways. See <strong>r</strong> below.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>X</strong></strong> Exclude files and directories. Causes tar files to
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>X</strong></strong><dd> Exclude files and directories. Causes tar files to
be excluded from an extract or create. See example below. Filename
globbing works in one of two ways now. See <strong>r</strong> below.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>b</strong></strong> Blocksize. Must be followed by a valid (greater than
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>b</strong></strong><dd> Blocksize. Must be followed by a valid (greater than
zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to be written out in
blocksize*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>g</strong></strong> Incremental. Only back up files that have the
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>g</strong></strong><dd> Incremental. Only back up files that have the
archive bit set. Useful only with the <strong>c</strong> flag.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>q</strong></strong> Quiet. Keeps tar from printing diagnostics as it
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>q</strong></strong><dd> Quiet. Keeps tar from printing diagnostics as it
works. This is the same as tarmode quiet.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>r</strong></strong> Regular expression include or exclude. Uses regular
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>r</strong></strong><dd> Regular expression include or exclude. Uses regular
regular expression matching for excluding or excluding files if
compiled with HAVE_REGEX_H. However this mode can be very slow. If
not compiled with HAVE_REGEX_H, does a limited wildcard match on * and
?.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>N</strong></strong> Newer than. Must be followed by the name of a file
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>N</strong></strong><dd> Newer than. Must be followed by the name of a file
whose date is compared against files found on the share during a
create. Only files newer than the file specified are backed up to the
tar file. Useful only with the <strong>c</strong> flag.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>a</strong></strong> Set archive bit. Causes the archive bit to be reset
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>a</strong></strong><dd> Set archive bit. Causes the archive bit to be reset
when a file is backed up. Useful with the <strong>g</strong> and <strong>c</strong> flags.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><em>Tar Long File Names</em>
-<p><br>smbclient's tar option now supports long file names both on backup and
+<p></dl>
+<p><em>Tar Long File Names</em>
+<p>smbclient's tar option now supports long file names both on backup and
restore. However, the full path name of the file must be less than
1024 bytes. Also, when a tar archive is created, smbclient's tar
option places all files in the archive with relative names, not
absolute names.
-<p><br><em>Tar Filenames</em>
-<p><br>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with <code>\</code> as the
+<p><em>Tar Filenames</em>
+<p>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with <code>\</code> as the
component separator) or as UNIX path names (with <code>/</code> as the
component separator).
-<p><br><em>Examples</em>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > Restore from tar file backup.tar into myshare on mypc (no password on share).
-<p><br><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tx backup.tar</code>
-<p><br><li > Restore everything except users/docs
-<p><br><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -TXx backup.tar users/docs</code>
-<p><br><li > Create a tar file of the files beneath users/docs.
-<p><br><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar users/docs</code>
-<p><br><li > Create the same tar file as above, but now use a DOS path name.
-<p><br><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -tc backup.tar users\edocs</code>
-<p><br><li > Create a tar file of all the files and directories in the share.
-<p><br><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar *</code>
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusD"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-D initial directory</strong></strong> Change to initial directory before
+<p><em>Examples</em>
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > Restore from tar file backup.tar into myshare on mypc (no password on share).
+<p><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tx backup.tar</code>
+<p><li > Restore everything except users/docs
+<p><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -TXx backup.tar users/docs</code>
+<p><li > Create a tar file of the files beneath users/docs.
+<p><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar users/docs</code>
+<p><li > Create the same tar file as above, but now use a DOS path name.
+<p><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -tc backup.tar users\edocs</code>
+<p><li > Create a tar file of all the files and directories in the share.
+<p><code>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar *</code>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="minusD"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-D initial directory</strong></strong><dd> Change to initial directory before
starting. Probably only of any use with the tar <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusT"><strong>-T</strong></a> option.
-<p><br><a name="minusc"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-c command string</strong></strong> command string is a semicolon separated
+<p><a name="minusc"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-c command string</strong></strong><dd> command string is a semicolon separated
list of commands to be executed instead of prompting from stdin.
<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusN"><strong>-N</strong></a> is implied by <strong>-c</strong>.
-<p><br>This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin to the
+<p>This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin to the
server, e.g. <code>-c 'print -'</code>.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="OPERATIONS"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="OPERATIONS"></a>
<h2>OPERATIONS</h2>
-<p><br>Once the client is running, the user is presented with a prompt :
-<p><br><code>smb:\&gt;</code>
-<p><br>The backslash ("\") indicates the current working directory on the
+<p>Once the client is running, the user is presented with a prompt :
+<p><code>smb:\&gt;</code>
+<p>The backslash ("\") indicates the current working directory on the
server, and will change if the current working directory is changed.
-<p><br>The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to carry out
+<p>The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to carry out
a user command. Each command is a single word, optionally followed by
parameters specific to that command. Command and parameters are
space-delimited unless these notes specifically state otherwise. All
commands are case-insensitive. Parameters to commands may or may not
be case sensitive, depending on the command.
-<p><br>You can specify file names which have spaces in them by quoting the
+<p>You can specify file names which have spaces in them by quoting the
name with double quotes, for example "a long file name".
-<p><br>Parameters shown in square brackets (e.g., "[parameter]") are
+<p>Parameters shown in square brackets (e.g., "[parameter]") are
optional. If not given, the command will use suitable
defaults. Parameters shown in angle brackets (e.g., "&lt;parameter&gt;") are
required.
-<p><br>Note that all commands operating on the server are actually performed
+<p>Note that all commands operating on the server are actually performed
by issuing a request to the server. Thus the behavior may vary from
server to server, depending on how the server was implemented.
-<p><br>The commands available are given here in alphabetical order.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="questionmark"></a> <li><strong><strong>? [command]</strong></strong> If "command" is specified,
+<p>The commands available are given here in alphabetical order.
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="questionmark"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>? [command]</strong></strong><dd> If "command" is specified,
the <strong>?</strong> command will display a brief informative message about the
specified command. If no command is specified, a list of available
commands will be displayed.
-<p><br><a name="exclaimationmark"></a> <li><strong><strong>! [shell command]</strong></strong> If "shell command"
+<p><a name="exclaimationmark"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>! [shell command]</strong></strong><dd> If "shell command"
is specified, the <strong>!</strong> command will execute a shell locally and run
the specified shell command. If no command is specified, a local shell
will be run.
-<p><br><a name="cd"></a> <li><strong><strong>cd [directory name]</strong></strong> If "directory name" is
+<p><a name="cd"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>cd [directory name]</strong></strong><dd> If "directory name" is
specified, the current working directory on the server will be changed
to the directory specified. This operation will fail if for any reason
the specified directory is inaccessible.
-<p><br>If no directory name is specified, the current working directory on
+<p>If no directory name is specified, the current working directory on
the server will be reported.
-<p><br><a name="del"></a> <li><strong><strong>del &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> The client will request that the server
+<p><a name="del"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>del &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> The client will request that the server
attempt to delete all files matching "mask" from the current working
directory on the server.
-<p><br><a name="dir"></a> <li><strong><strong>dir &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> A list of the files matching "mask" in
+<p><a name="dir"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>dir &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> A list of the files matching "mask" in
the current working directory on the server will be retrieved from the
server and displayed.
-<p><br><a name="exit"></a> <li><strong><strong>exit</strong></strong> Terminate the connection with the server and
+<p><a name="exit"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>exit</strong></strong><dd> Terminate the connection with the server and
exit from the program.
-<p><br><a name="get"></a> <li><strong><strong>get &lt;remote file name&gt; [local file name]</strong></strong> Copy the
+<p><a name="get"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>get &lt;remote file name&gt; [local file name]</strong></strong><dd> Copy the
file called "remote file name" from the server to the machine running
the client. If specified, name the local copy "local file name". Note
that all transfers in smbclient are binary. See also the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#lowercase"><strong>lowercase</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="help"></a> <li><strong><strong>help [command]</strong></strong> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#questionmark"><strong>?</strong></a>
+<p><a name="help"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>help [command]</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#questionmark"><strong>?</strong></a>
command above.
-<p><br><a name="lcd"></a> <li><strong><strong>lcd [directory name]</strong></strong> If "directory name" is
+<p><a name="lcd"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>lcd [directory name]</strong></strong><dd> If "directory name" is
specified, the current working directory on the local machine will
be changed to the directory specified. This operation will fail if for
any reason the specified directory is inaccessible.
-<p><br>If no directory name is specified, the name of the current working
+<p>If no directory name is specified, the name of the current working
directory on the local machine will be reported.
-<p><br><a name="lowercase"></a> <li><strong><strong>lowercase</strong></strong> Toggle lowercasing of filenames
+<p><a name="lowercase"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>lowercase</strong></strong><dd> Toggle lowercasing of filenames
for the <a href="smbclient.1.html#get"><strong>get</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> commands.
-<p><br>When lowercasing is toggled ON, local filenames are converted to
+<p>When lowercasing is toggled ON, local filenames are converted to
lowercase when using the <a href="smbclient.1.html#get"><strong>get</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a>
commands. This is often useful when copying (say) MSDOS files from a
server, because lowercase filenames are the norm on UNIX systems.
-<p><br><a name="ls"></a> <li><strong><strong>ls &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#dir"><strong>dir</strong></a> command above.
-<p><br><a name="mask"></a> <li><strong><strong>mask &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> This command allows the user to set
+<p><a name="ls"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>ls &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#dir"><strong>dir</strong></a> command above.
+<p><a name="mask"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>mask &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> This command allows the user to set
up a mask which will be used during recursive operation of the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a> commands.
-<p><br>The masks specified to the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> and
+<p>The masks specified to the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> and
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a> commands act as filters for directories rather
than files when recursion is toggled ON.
-<p><br>The mask specified with the .B mask command is necessary to filter
+<p>The mask specified with the .B mask command is necessary to filter
files within those directories. For example, if the mask specified in
an <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> command is "source*" and the mask specified
with the mask command is "*.c" and recursion is toggled ON, the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> command will retrieve all files matching "*.c" in
all directories below and including all directories matching "source*"
in the current working directory.
-<p><br>Note that the value for mask defaults to blank (equivalent to "*") and
+<p>Note that the value for mask defaults to blank (equivalent to "*") and
remains so until the mask command is used to change it. It retains the
most recently specified value indefinitely. To avoid unexpected
results it would be wise to change the value of .I mask back to "*"
after using the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> or <a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a> commands.
-<p><br><a name="md"></a> <li><strong><strong>md &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mkdir"><strong>mkdir</strong></a>
+<p><a name="md"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>md &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mkdir"><strong>mkdir</strong></a>
command.
-<p><br><a name="mget"></a> <li><strong><strong>mget &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> Copy all files matching mask from the
+<p><a name="mget"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>mget &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Copy all files matching mask from the
server to the machine running the client.
-<p><br>Note that mask is interpreted differently during recursive operation
+<p>Note that mask is interpreted differently during recursive operation
and non-recursive operation - refer to the <a href="smbclient.1.html#recurse"><strong>recurse</strong></a>
and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mask"><strong>mask</strong></a> commands for more information. Note that all
transfers in .B smbclient are binary. See also the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#lowercase"><strong>lowercase</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="mkdir"></a> <li><strong><strong>mkdir &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong> Create a new directory on
+<p><a name="mkdir"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>mkdir &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Create a new directory on
the server (user access privileges permitting) with the specified
name.
-<p><br><a name="mput"></a> <li><strong><strong>mput &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> Copy all files matching mask in
+<p><a name="mput"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>mput &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Copy all files matching mask in
the current working directory on the local machine to the current
working directory on the server.
-<p><br>Note that mask is interpreted differently during recursive operation
+<p>Note that mask is interpreted differently during recursive operation
and non-recursive operation - refer to the <a href="smbclient.1.html#recurse"><strong>recurse</strong></a>
and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mask"><strong>mask</strong></a> commands for more information. Note that all
transfers in .B smbclient are binary.
-<p><br><a name="print"></a> <li><strong><strong>print &lt;file name&gt;</strong></strong> Print the specified file
+<p><a name="print"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>print &lt;file name&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Print the specified file
from the local machine through a printable service on the server.
-<p><br>See also the <a href="smbclient.1.html#printmode"><strong>printmode</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="printmode"></a> <li><strong><strong>printmode &lt;graphics or text&gt;</strong></strong> Set the print
+<p>See also the <a href="smbclient.1.html#printmode"><strong>printmode</strong></a> command.
+<p><a name="printmode"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>printmode &lt;graphics or text&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Set the print
mode to suit either binary data (such as graphical information) or
text. Subsequent print commands will use the currently set print
mode.
-<p><br><a name="prompt"></a> <li><strong><strong>prompt</strong></strong> Toggle prompting for filenames during
+<p><a name="prompt"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>prompt</strong></strong><dd> Toggle prompting for filenames during
operation of the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a>
commands.
-<p><br>When toggled ON, the user will be prompted to confirm the transfer of
+<p>When toggled ON, the user will be prompted to confirm the transfer of
each file during these commands. When toggled OFF, all specified files
will be transferred without prompting.
-<p><br><a name="put"></a> <li><strong><strong>put &lt;local file name&gt; [remote file name]</strong></strong> Copy the
+<p><a name="put"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>put &lt;local file name&gt; [remote file name]</strong></strong><dd> Copy the
file called "local file name" from the machine running the client to
the server. If specified, name the remote copy "remote file name".
Note that all transfers in smbclient are binary. See also the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#lowercase"><strong>lowercase</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="queue"></a> <li><strong><strong>queue</strong></strong> Displays the print queue, showing the job
+<p><a name="queue"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>queue</strong></strong><dd> Displays the print queue, showing the job
id, name, size and current status.
-<p><br><a name="quit"></a> <li><strong><strong>quit</strong></strong> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#exit"><strong>exit</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="rd"></a> <li><strong><strong>rd &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#rmdir"><strong>rmdir</strong></a>
+<p><a name="quit"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>quit</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#exit"><strong>exit</strong></a> command.
+<p><a name="rd"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>rd &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#rmdir"><strong>rmdir</strong></a>
command.
-<p><br><a name="recurse"></a> <li><strong><strong>recurse</strong></strong> Toggle directory recursion for the
+<p><a name="recurse"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>recurse</strong></strong><dd> Toggle directory recursion for the
commands <a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> and <a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a>.
-<p><br>When toggled ON, these commands will process all directories in the
+<p>When toggled ON, these commands will process all directories in the
source directory (i.e., the directory they are copying .IR from ) and
will recurse into any that match the mask specified to the
command. Only files that match the mask specified using the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mask"><strong>mask</strong></a> command will be retrieved. See also the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mask"><strong>mask</strong></a> command.
-<p><br>When recursion is toggled OFF, only files from the current working
+<p>When recursion is toggled OFF, only files from the current working
directory on the source machine that match the mask specified to the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#mget"><strong>mget</strong></a> or <a href="smbclient.1.html#mput"><strong>mput</strong></a> commands will be copied,
and any mask specified using the <a href="smbclient.1.html#mask"><strong>mask</strong></a> command will be
ignored.
-<p><br><a name="rm"></a> <li><strong><strong>rm &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong> Remove all files matching mask from
+<p><a name="rm"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>rm &lt;mask&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Remove all files matching mask from
the current working directory on the server.
-<p><br><a name="rmdir"></a> <li><strong><strong>rmdir &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong> Remove the specified
+<p><a name="rmdir"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>rmdir &lt;directory name&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Remove the specified
directory (user access privileges permitting) from the server.
-<p><br><a name="tar"></a> <li><strong><strong>tar &lt;c|x&gt;[IXbgNa]</strong></strong> Performs a tar operation - see
+<p><a name="tar"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>tar &lt;c|x&gt;[IXbgNa]</strong></strong><dd> Performs a tar operation - see
the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusT"><strong>-T</strong></a> command line option above. Behavior may be
affected by the <a href="smbclient.1.html#tarmode"><strong>tarmode</strong></a> command (see below). Using
g (incremental) and N (newer) will affect tarmode settings. Note that
using the "-" option with tar x may not work - use the command line
option instead.
-<p><br><a name="blocksize"></a> <li><strong><strong>blocksize &lt;blocksize&gt;</strong></strong> Blocksize. Must be
+<p><a name="blocksize"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>blocksize &lt;blocksize&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Blocksize. Must be
followed by a valid (greater than zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to
be written out in blocksize*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks.
-<p><br><a name="tarmode"></a> <li><strong><strong>tarmode &lt;full|inc|reset|noreset&gt;</strong></strong> Changes tar's
+<p><a name="tarmode"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>tarmode &lt;full|inc|reset|noreset&gt;</strong></strong><dd> Changes tar's
behavior with regard to archive bits. In full mode, tar will back up
everything regardless of the archive bit setting (this is the default
mode). In incremental mode, tar will only back up files with the
archive bit set. In reset mode, tar will reset the archive bit on all
files it backs up (implies read/write share).
-<p><br><a name="setmode"></a> <li><strong><strong>setmode &lt;filename&gt; &lt;perm=[+|\-]rsha&gt;</strong></strong> A version
+<p><a name="setmode"></a> <p></p><dt><strong><strong>setmode &lt;filename&gt; &lt;perm=[+|\-]rsha&gt;</strong></strong><dd> A version
of the DOS attrib command to set file permissions. For example:
-<p><br><code>setmode myfile +r</code>
-<p><br>would make myfile read only.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="NOTES"></a>
+<p><code>setmode myfile +r</code>
+<p>would make myfile read only.
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="NOTES"></a>
<h2>NOTES</h2>
-<p><br>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
+<p>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
passwords, share names (AKA service names) and machine names. If you
fail to connect try giving all parameters in uppercase.
-<p><br>It is often necessary to use the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusn"><strong>-n</strong></a> option when connecting to some
+<p>It is often necessary to use the <a href="smbclient.1.html#minusn"><strong>-n</strong></a> option when connecting to some
types of servers. For example OS/2 LanManager insists on a valid
NetBIOS name being used, so you need to supply a valid name that would
be known to the server.
-<p><br>smbclient supports long file names where the server supports the
+<p>smbclient supports long file names where the server supports the
LANMAN2 protocol or above.
-<p><br><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
+<p><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
<h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2>
-<p><br>The variable <strong>USER</strong> may contain the username of the person using the
+<p>The variable <strong>USER</strong> may contain the username of the person using the
client. This information is used only if the protocol level is high
enough to support session-level passwords.
-<p><br>The variable <strong>PASSWD</strong> may contain the password of the person using
+<p>The variable <strong>PASSWD</strong> may contain the password of the person using
the client. This information is used only if the protocol level is
high enough to support session-level passwords.
-<p><br><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
+<p><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
<h2>INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>The location of the client program is a matter for individual system
+<p>The location of the client program is a matter for individual system
administrators. The following are thus suggestions only.
-<p><br>It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed in the
+<p>It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed in the
/usr/local/samba/bin or /usr/samba/bin directory, this directory
readable by all, writeable only by root. The client program itself
should be executable by all. The client should <em>NOT</em> be setuid or
setgid!
-<p><br>The client log files should be put in a directory readable and
+<p>The client log files should be put in a directory readable and
writeable only by the user.
-<p><br>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a running
+<p>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a running
SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon on a
user-accessible port (typically any port number over 1024) would
provide a suitable test server.
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a specified log
+<p>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a specified log
file. The log file name is specified at compile time, but may be
overridden on the command line.
-<p><br>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends on the debug
+<p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends on the debug
level used by the client. If you have problems, set the debug level to
3 and peruse the log files.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
index 8230d50f47b..766de0853f0 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbd (8)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,178 +16,170 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbd - server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbd</strong> [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusD">-D</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minuso">-o</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusV">-V</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusl">-l log file</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusp">-p port number</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusO">-O socket options</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusi">-i scope</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbd</strong> [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusD">-D</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minuso">-o</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusV">-V</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusd">-d debuglevel</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusl">-l log file</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusp">-p port number</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minusO">-O socket options</a>] [<a href="smbd.8.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>smbd</strong> is the server daemon that provides filesharing and printing
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>smbd</strong> is the server daemon that provides filesharing and printing
services to
Windows clients. The server provides filespace and printer services to
clients using the SMB (or CIFS) protocol. This is compatible with the
LanManager protocol, and can service LanManager clients. These
include MSCLIENT 3.0 for DOS, Windows for Workgroups, Windows 95,
Windows NT, OS/2, DAVE for Macintosh, and smbfs for Linux.
-<p><br>An extensive description of the services that the server can provide
+<p>An extensive description of the services that the server can provide
is given in the man page for the configuration file controlling the
attributes of those services (see
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>. This man page
will not describe the services, but will concentrate on the
administrative aspects of running the server.
-<p><br>Please note that there are significant security implications to
+<p>Please note that there are significant security implications to
running this server, and the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> manpage should be
regarded as mandatory reading before proceeding with installation.
-<p><br>A session is created whenever a client requests one. Each client gets
+<p>A session is created whenever a client requests one. Each client gets
a copy of the server for each session. This copy then services all
connections made by the client during that session. When all
connections from its client are closed, the copy of the server for
that client terminates.
-<p><br>The configuration file, and any files that it includes, are
+<p>The configuration file, and any files that it includes, are
automatically reloaded every minute, if they change. You can force a
reload by sending a SIGHUP to the server. Reloading the configuration
file will not affect connections to any service that is already
established. Either the user will have to disconnect from the
service, or smbd killed and restarted.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusD"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-D</strong></strong> If specified, this parameter causes the server to operate as a
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minusD"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-D</strong></strong><dd> If specified, this parameter causes the server to operate as a
daemon. That is, it detaches itself and runs in the background,
fielding requests on the appropriate port. Operating the server as a
daemon is the recommended way of running smbd for servers that provide
more than casual use file and print services.
-<p><br>By default, the server will NOT operate as a daemon.
-<p><br><a name="minusa"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong> If this parameter is specified, each new connection will
+<p>By default, the server will NOT operate as a daemon.
+<p><a name="minusa"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong><dd> If this parameter is specified, each new connection will
append log messages to the log file. This is the default.
-<p><br><a name="minuso"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-o</strong></strong> If this parameter is specified, the log files will be
+<p><a name="minuso"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-o</strong></strong><dd> If this parameter is specified, the log files will be
overwritten when opened. By default, the log files will be appended
to.
-<p><br><a name="minusP"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong> Passive option. Causes smbd not to send any network traffic
+<p><a name="minusP"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong><dd> Passive option. Causes smbd not to send any network traffic
out. Used for debugging by the developers only.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> Prints the help information (usage) for <strong>smbd</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="minusV"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-V</strong></strong> Prints the version number for <strong>smbd</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
-<p><br>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
-<p><br>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> Prints the help information (usage) for <strong>smbd</strong>.
+<p><a name="minusV"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-V</strong></strong><dd> Prints the version number for <strong>smbd</strong>.
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d debuglevel</strong></strong><dd> debuglevel is an integer from 0 to 10.
+<p>The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
+<p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
about the activities of the server. At level 0, only critical errors
and serious warnings will be logged. Level 1 is a reasonable level for
day to day running - it generates a small amount of information about
operations carried out.
-<p><br>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
+<p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are
designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
-<p><br>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
+<p>Note that specifying this parameter here will override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel"><strong>log
level</strong></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="minusl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-l log file</strong></strong> If specified, <em>log file</em> specifies
+<p><a name="minusl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-l log file</strong></strong><dd> If specified, <em>log file</em> specifies
a log filename into which informational and debug messages from the
running server will be logged. The log file generated is never removed
by the server although its size may be controlled by the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize"><strong>max
log size</strong></a> option in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> file. The default log file name is specified
at compile time.
-<p><br><a name="minusO"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-O socket options</strong></strong> See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>socket
+<p><a name="minusO"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-O socket options</strong></strong><dd> See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#socketoptions"><strong>socket
options</strong></a> parameter in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> file for details.
-<p><br><a name="minusp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-p port number</strong></strong> port number is a positive integer value. The
+<p><a name="minusp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-p port number</strong></strong><dd> port number is a positive integer value. The
default value if this parameter is not specified is 139.
-<p><br>This number is the port number that will be used when making
+<p>This number is the port number that will be used when making
connections to the server from client software. The standard
(well-known) port number for the SMB over TCP is 139, hence the
default. If you wish to run the server as an ordinary user rather than
as root, most systems will require you to use a port number greater
than 1024 - ask your system administrator for help if you are in this
situation.
-<p><br>In order for the server to be useful by most clients, should you
+<p>In order for the server to be useful by most clients, should you
configure it on a port other than 139, you will require port
redirection services on port 139, details of which are outlined in
rfc1002.txt section 4.3.5.
-<p><br>This parameter is not normally specified except in the above
+<p>This parameter is not normally specified except in the above
situation.
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong>
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong><dd>
The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
server. The information in this file includes server-specific
information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions
of all the services that the server is to provide. See <strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong> for more information.
The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.
-<p><br><a name="minusi"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-i scope</strong></strong> This specifies a NetBIOS scope that the server will use
-to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the
-use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes
-are <em>very</em> rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
-system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
-communicate with.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="FILES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
-<p><br>If the server is to be run by the inetd meta-daemon, this file must
+<p><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
+<p>If the server is to be run by the inetd meta-daemon, this file must
contain suitable startup information for the meta-daemon. See the
section <a href="smbd.8.html#INSTALLATION">INSTALLATION</a> below.
-<p><br><strong>/etc/rc</strong>
-<p><br>(or whatever initialization script your system uses).
-<p><br>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to
+<p><strong>/etc/rc</strong>
+<p>(or whatever initialization script your system uses).
+<p>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to
contain an appropriate startup sequence for the server. See the
section <a href="smbd.8.html#INSTALLATION">INSTALLATION</a> below.
-<p><br><strong>/etc/services</strong>
-<p><br>If running the server via the meta-daemon inetd, this file must
+<p><strong>/etc/services</strong>
+<p>If running the server via the meta-daemon inetd, this file must
contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn) to service port
(e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp). See the section
<a href="smbd.8.html#INSTALLATION">INSTALLATION</a> below.
-<p><br><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
-<p><br>This is the default location of the <em>smb.conf</em> server configuration
+<p><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
+<p>This is the default location of the <em>smb.conf</em> server configuration
file. Other common places that systems install this file are
<em>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</em> and <em>/etc/smb.conf</em>.
-<p><br>This file describes all the services the server is to make available
+<p>This file describes all the services the server is to make available
to clients. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> for more information.
-<p><br><a name="LIMITATIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="LIMITATIONS"></a>
<h2>LIMITATIONS</h2>
-<p><br>On some systems <strong>smbd</strong> cannot change uid back to root after a
+<p>On some systems <strong>smbd</strong> cannot change uid back to root after a
setuid() call. Such systems are called "trapdoor" uid systems. If you
have such a system, you will be unable to connect from a client (such
as a PC) as two different users at once. Attempts to connect the
second user will result in "access denied" or similar.
-<p><br><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
+<p><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
<h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>PRINTER</strong>
-<p><br>If no printer name is specified to printable services, most systems
+<p><strong>PRINTER</strong>
+<p>If no printer name is specified to printable services, most systems
will use the value of this variable (or "lp" if this variable is not
defined) as the name of the printer to use. This is not specific to
the server, however.
-<p><br><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
+<p><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
<h2>INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>The location of the server and its support files is a matter for
+<p>The location of the server and its support files is a matter for
individual system administrators. The following are thus suggestions
only.
-<p><br>It is recommended that the server software be installed under the
+<p>It is recommended that the server software be installed under the
/usr/local/samba hierarchy, in a directory readable by all, writeable
only by root. The server program itself should be executable by all,
as users may wish to run the server themselves (in which case it will
@@ -200,93 +193,93 @@ fix has only been confirmed on old versions (pre-kernel 2.0) of Linux
at the time this was written. It is possible that this hole only
exists in Linux, as testing on other systems has thus far shown them
to be immune.
-<p><br>The server log files should be put in a directory readable and
+<p>The server log files should be put in a directory readable and
writeable only by root, as the log files may contain sensitive
information.
-<p><br>The configuration file should be placed in a directory readable and
+<p>The configuration file should be placed in a directory readable and
writeable only by root, as the configuration file controls security for
the services offered by the server. The configuration file can be made
readable by all if desired, but this is not necessary for correct
operation of the server and is not recommended. A sample configuration
file "smb.conf.sample" is supplied with the source to the server -
this may be renamed to "smb.conf" and modified to suit your needs.
-<p><br>The remaining notes will assume the following:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><li > <strong>smbd</strong> (the server program) installed in /usr/local/samba/bin
-<p><br><li > <strong>smb.conf</strong> (the configuration file) installed in /usr/local/samba/lib
-<p><br><li > log files stored in /var/adm/smblogs
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>The server may be run either as a daemon by users or at startup, or it
+<p>The remaining notes will assume the following:
+<p><dl>
+<p><li > <strong>smbd</strong> (the server program) installed in /usr/local/samba/bin
+<p><li > <strong>smb.conf</strong> (the configuration file) installed in /usr/local/samba/lib
+<p><li > log files stored in /var/adm/smblogs
+<p></dl>
+<p>The server may be run either as a daemon by users or at startup, or it
may be run from a meta-daemon such as inetd upon request. If run as a
daemon, the server will always be ready, so starting sessions will be
faster. If run from a meta-daemon some memory will be saved and
utilities such as the tcpd TCP-wrapper may be used for extra security.
For serious use as file server it is recommended that <strong>smbd</strong> be run
as a daemon.
-<p><br>When you've decided, continue with either
+<p>When you've decided, continue with either
<a href="smbd.8.html#RUNNINGTHESERVERASADAEMON">RUNNING THE SERVER AS A DAEMON</a> or
<a href="smbd.8.html#RUNNINGTHESERVERONREQUEST">RUNNING THE SERVER ON REQUEST</a>.
-<p><br><a name="RUNNINGTHESERVERASADAEMON"></a>
+<p><a name="RUNNINGTHESERVERASADAEMON"></a>
<h2>RUNNING THE SERVER AS A DAEMON</h2>
-<p><br>To run the server as a daemon from the command line, simply put the
+<p>To run the server as a daemon from the command line, simply put the
<a href="smbd.8.html#minusD"><strong>-D</strong></a> option on the command line. There is no need to place an
ampersand at the end of the command line - the <a href="smbd.8.html#minusD"><strong>-D</strong></a> option causes
the server to detach itself from the tty anyway.
-<p><br>Any user can run the server as a daemon (execute permissions
+<p>Any user can run the server as a daemon (execute permissions
permitting, of course). This is useful for testing purposes, and may
even be useful as a temporary substitute for something like ftp. When
run this way, however, the server will only have the privileges of the
user who ran it.
-<p><br>To ensure that the server is run as a daemon whenever the machine is
+<p>To ensure that the server is run as a daemon whenever the machine is
started, and to ensure that it runs as root so that it can serve
multiple clients, you will need to modify the system startup
files. Wherever appropriate (for example, in /etc/rc), insert the
following line, substituting port number, log file location,
configuration file location and debug level as desired:
-<p><br><code>/usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -l /var/adm/smblogs/log -s /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
-<p><br>(The above should appear in your initialization script as a single line.
+<p><code>/usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -D -l /var/adm/smblogs/log -s /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
+<p>(The above should appear in your initialization script as a single line.
Depending on your terminal characteristics, it may not appear that way in
this man page. If the above appears as more than one line, please treat any
newlines or indentation as a single space or TAB character.)
-<p><br>If the options used at compile time are appropriate for your system,
+<p>If the options used at compile time are appropriate for your system,
all parameters except <a href="smbd.8.html#minusD"><strong>-D</strong></a> may be
omitted. See the section <a href="smbd.8.html#OPTIONS">OPTIONS</a> above.
-<p><br><a name="RUNNINGTHESERVERONREQUEST"></a>
+<p><a name="RUNNINGTHESERVERONREQUEST"></a>
<h2>RUNNING THE SERVER ON REQUEST</h2>
-<p><br>If your system uses a meta-daemon such as <strong>inetd</strong>, you can arrange to
+<p>If your system uses a meta-daemon such as <strong>inetd</strong>, you can arrange to
have the smbd server started whenever a process attempts to connect to
it. This requires several changes to the startup files on the host
machine. If you are experimenting as an ordinary user rather than as
root, you will need the assistance of your system administrator to
modify the system files.
-<p><br>You will probably want to set up the NetBIOS name server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> at
+<p>You will probably want to set up the NetBIOS name server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> at
the same time as <strong>smbd</strong>. To do this refer to the man page for
<a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>.
-<p><br>First, ensure that a port is configured in the file <code>/etc/services</code>. The
+<p>First, ensure that a port is configured in the file <code>/etc/services</code>. The
well-known port 139 should be used if possible, though any port may be
used.
-<p><br>Ensure that a line similar to the following is in <code>/etc/services</code>:
-<p><br><code>netbios-ssn 139/tcp</code>
-<p><br>Note for NIS/YP users - you may need to rebuild the NIS service maps
+<p>Ensure that a line similar to the following is in <code>/etc/services</code>:
+<p><code>netbios-ssn 139/tcp</code>
+<p>Note for NIS/YP users - you may need to rebuild the NIS service maps
rather than alter your local <code>/etc/services file</code>.
-<p><br>Next, put a suitable line in the file <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> (in the unlikely
+<p>Next, put a suitable line in the file <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> (in the unlikely
event that you are using a meta-daemon other than inetd, you are on
your own). Note that the first item in this line matches the service
name in <code>/etc/services</code>. Substitute appropriate values for your system
in this line (see <strong>inetd (8)</strong>):
-<p><br><code>netbios-ssn stream tcp nowait root /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -d1 -l/var/adm/smblogs/log -s/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
-<p><br>(The above should appear in <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> as a single
+<p><code>netbios-ssn stream tcp nowait root /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd -d1 -l/var/adm/smblogs/log -s/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</code>
+<p>(The above should appear in <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> as a single
line. Depending on your terminal characteristics, it may not appear
that way in this man page. If the above appears as more than one
line, please treat any newlines or indentation as a single space or
TAB character.)
-<p><br>Note that there is no need to specify a port number here, even if you
+<p>Note that there is no need to specify a port number here, even if you
are using a non-standard port number.
-<p><br>Lastly, edit the configuration file to provide suitable services. To
+<p>Lastly, edit the configuration file to provide suitable services. To
start with, the following two services should be all you need:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
[homes]
@@ -301,85 +294,85 @@ start with, the following two services should be all you need:
</pre>
-<p><br>This will allow you to connect to your home directory and print to any
+<p>This will allow you to connect to your home directory and print to any
printer supported by the host (user privileges permitting).
-<p><br><a name="TESTINGTHEINSTALLATION"></a>
+<p><a name="TESTINGTHEINSTALLATION"></a>
<h2>TESTING THE INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>If running the server as a daemon, execute it before proceeding. If
+<p>If running the server as a daemon, execute it before proceeding. If
using a meta-daemon, either restart the system or kill and restart the
meta-daemon. Some versions of inetd will reread their configuration
tables if they receive a HUP signal.
-<p><br>If your machine's name is "fred" and your name is "mary", you should
+<p>If your machine's name is "fred" and your name is "mary", you should
now be able to connect to the service <code>\\fred\mary</code>.
-<p><br>To properly test and experiment with the server, we recommend using
+<p>To properly test and experiment with the server, we recommend using
the smbclient program (see
<a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>) and also going through
the steps outlined in the file <em>DIAGNOSIS.txt</em> in the <em>docs/</em>
directory of your Samba installation.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged in a specified log
+<p>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged in a specified log
file. The log file name is specified at compile time, but may be
overridden on the command line.
-<p><br>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends on the debug
+<p>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends on the debug
level used by the server. If you have problems, set the debug level to
3 and peruse the log files.
-<p><br>Most messages are reasonably self-explanatory. Unfortunately, at the time
+<p>Most messages are reasonably self-explanatory. Unfortunately, at the time
this man page was created, there are too many diagnostics available
in the source code to warrant describing each and every diagnostic. At
this stage your best bet is still to grep the source code and inspect
the conditions that gave rise to the diagnostics you are seeing.
-<p><br><a name="SIGNALS"></a>
+<p><a name="SIGNALS"></a>
<h2>SIGNALS</h2>
-<p><br>Sending the smbd a SIGHUP will cause it to re-load its smb.conf
+<p>Sending the smbd a SIGHUP will cause it to re-load its smb.conf
configuration file within a short period of time.
-<p><br>To shut down a users smbd process it is recommended that SIGKILL (-9)
+<p>To shut down a users smbd process it is recommended that SIGKILL (-9)
<em>NOT</em> be used, except as a last resort, as this may leave the shared
memory area in an inconsistent state. The safe way to terminate an
smbd is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for it to die on
its own.
-<p><br>The debug log level of smbd may be raised
+<p>The debug log level of smbd may be raised
by sending it a SIGUSR1 <code>(kill -USR1 &lt;smbd-pid&gt;)</code> and lowered by
sending it a SIGUSR2 <code>(kill -USR2 &lt;smbd-pid&gt;)</code>. This is to allow
transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running at a normally
low log level.
-<p><br>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write, they are not
+<p>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write, they are not
re-entrant in smbd. This you should wait until smbd is in a state of
waiting for an incoming smb before issuing them. It is possible to
make the signal handlers safe by un-blocking the signals before the
select call and re-blocking them after, however this would affect
performance.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><strong>hosts_access (5)</strong>, <strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
+<p><strong>hosts_access (5)</strong>, <strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient
(1)</strong></a>, <a href="testparm.1.html"><strong>testparm (1)</strong></a>,
<a href="testprns.1.html"><strong>testprns (1)</strong></a>, and the Internet RFC's
<strong>rfc1001.txt</strong>, <strong>rfc1002.txt</strong>. In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB)
specification is available as a link from the Web page :
<a href="http://samba.org/cifs/">http://samba.org/cifs/</a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full list of contributors
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full list of contributors
and details on how to submit bug reports, comments etc.
</body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
index 9ff258afad0..29690227909 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbpasswd (5)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,47 +16,46 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbpasswd - The Samba encrypted password file
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br>smbpasswd is the <strong>Samba</strong> encrypted password file.
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p>smbpasswd is the <strong>Samba</strong> encrypted password file.
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This file is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br>smbpasswd is the <strong>Samba</strong> encrypted password file. It contains
+<p>This file is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p>smbpasswd is the <strong>Samba</strong> encrypted password file. It contains
the username, Unix user id and the SMB hashed passwords of the
user, as well as account flag information and the time the password
was last changed. This file format has been evolving with Samba
and has had several different formats in the past.
-<p><br><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
+<p><a name="FILEFORMAT"></a>
<h2>FILE FORMAT</h2>
-<p><br>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.0 is very similar to
+<p>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.0 is very similar to
the familiar Unix <strong>passwd (5)</strong> file. It is an ASCII file containing
one line for each user. Each field within each line is separated from
the next by a colon. Any entry beginning with # is ignored. The
smbpasswd file contains the following information for each user:
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="name"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>name</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This is the user name. It must be a name that already exists
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="name"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>name</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This is the user name. It must be a name that already exists
in the standard UNIX passwd file.
-<p><br><a name="uid"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>uid</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This is the UNIX uid. It must match the uid field for the same
+<p><a name="uid"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>uid</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This is the UNIX uid. It must match the uid field for the same
user entry in the standard UNIX passwd file. If this does not
match then Samba will refuse to recognize this <strong>smbpasswd</strong> file entry
as being valid for a user.
-<p><br><a name="LanmanPasswordHash"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>Lanman Password Hash</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This is the <em>LANMAN</em> hash of the users password, encoded as 32 hex
+<p><a name="LanmanPasswordHash"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>Lanman Password Hash</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This is the <em>LANMAN</em> hash of the users password, encoded as 32 hex
digits. The <em>LANMAN</em> hash is created by DES encrypting a well known
string with the users password as the DES key. This is the same
password used by Windows 95/98 machines. Note that this password hash
@@ -67,7 +67,7 @@ smbpasswd file contains the following information for each user:
is equal to 32 <code>'X'</code> characters then the users account is marked as
<em>disabled</em> and the user will not be able to log onto the Samba
server.
-<p><br><em>WARNING !!</em>. Note that, due to the challenge-response nature of the
+<p><em>WARNING !!</em>. Note that, due to the challenge-response nature of the
SMB/CIFS authentication protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this
password hash will be able to impersonate the user on the network.
For this reason these hashes are known as <em>"plain text equivalent"</em>
@@ -76,19 +76,19 @@ smbpasswd file contains the following information for each user:
directory with read and traverse access only to the root user and the
<strong>smbpasswd</strong> file itself must be set to be read/write only by root,
with no other access.
-<p><br><a name="NTPasswordHash"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>NT Password Hash</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This is the <em>Windows NT</em> hash of the users password, encoded as 32
+<p><a name="NTPasswordHash"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>NT Password Hash</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This is the <em>Windows NT</em> hash of the users password, encoded as 32
hex digits. The <em>Windows NT</em> hash is created by taking the users
password as represented in 16-bit, little-endian UNICODE and then
applying the <em>MD4</em> (internet rfc1321) hashing algorithm to it.
-<p><br>This password hash is considered more secure than the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html#LanmanPasswordHash"><strong>Lanman
+<p>This password hash is considered more secure than the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html#LanmanPasswordHash"><strong>Lanman
Password Hash</strong></a> as it preserves the case of the
password and uses a much higher quality hashing algorithm. However, it
is still the case that if two users choose the same password this
entry will be identical (i.e. the password is not <em>"salted"</em> as the
UNIX password is).
-<p><br><em>WARNING !!</em>. Note that, due to the challenge-response nature of the
+<p><em>WARNING !!</em>. Note that, due to the challenge-response nature of the
SMB/CIFS authentication protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this
password hash will be able to impersonate the user on the network.
For this reason these hashes are known as <em>"plain text equivalent"</em>
@@ -97,48 +97,48 @@ smbpasswd file contains the following information for each user:
directory with read and traverse access only to the root user and the
<strong>smbpasswd</strong> file itself must be set to be read/write only by root,
with no other access.
-<p><br><a name="AccountFlags"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>Account Flags</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This section contains flags that describe the attributes of the users
+<p><a name="AccountFlags"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>Account Flags</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This section contains flags that describe the attributes of the users
account. In the <strong>Samba2.0</strong> release this field is bracketed by <code>'['</code>
and <code>']'</code> characters and is always 13 characters in length (including
the <code>'['</code> and <code>']'</code> characters). The contents of this field may be
any of the characters.
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="capU"></a>
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="capU"></a>
<li > <strong>'U'</strong> This means this is a <em>"User"</em> account, i.e. an ordinary
user. Only <strong>User</strong> and <a href="smbpasswd.5.html#capW"><strong>Workstation Trust</strong></a> accounts are
currently supported in the <strong>smbpasswd</strong> file.
-<p><br><a name="capN"></a>
+<p><a name="capN"></a>
<li > <strong>'N'</strong> This means the account has <em>no</em> password (the passwords
in the fields <a href="smbpasswd.5.html#LanmanPasswordHash"><strong>Lanman Password Hash</strong></a> and
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html#NTPasswordHash"><strong>NT Password Hash</strong></a> are ignored). Note that this
will only allow users to log on with no password if the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nullpasswords"><strong>null passwords</strong></a> parameter is set
in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> config file.
-<p><br><a name="capD"></a>
+<p><a name="capD"></a>
<li > <strong>'D'</strong> This means the account is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins
will be allowed for this user.
-<p><br><a name="capW"></a>
+<p><a name="capW"></a>
<li > <strong>'W'</strong> This means this account is a <em>"Workstation Trust"</em> account.
This kind of account is used in the Samba PDC code stream to allow Windows
NT Workstations and Servers to join a Domain hosted by a Samba PDC.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future. The rest of
+<p></dl>
+<p>Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future. The rest of
this field space is filled in with spaces.
-<p><br><a name="LastChangeTime"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>Last Change Time</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>This field consists of the time the account was last modified. It consists of
+<p><a name="LastChangeTime"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>Last Change Time</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>This field consists of the time the account was last modified. It consists of
the characters <code>LCT-</code> (standing for <em>"Last Change Time"</em>) followed by a numeric
encoding of the UNIX time in seconds since the epoch (1970) that the last change
was made.
-<p><br><li><strong><strong>Following fields</strong></strong> <br> <br>
-<p><br>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="NOTES"></a>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong><strong>Following fields</strong></strong><dd> <br> <br>
+<p>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="NOTES"></a>
<h2>NOTES</h2>
-<p><br>In previous versions of Samba (notably the 1.9.18 series) this file
+<p>In previous versions of Samba (notably the 1.9.18 series) this file
did not contain the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html#AccountFlags"><strong>Account Flags</strong></a> or
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html#LastChangeTime"><strong>Last Change Time</strong></a> fields. The Samba 2.0
code will read and write these older password files but will not be able to
@@ -147,11 +147,11 @@ modify the old entries to add the new fields. New entries added with
in the added accounts however. Thus an older <strong>smbpasswd</strong> file used
with Samba 2.0 may end up with some accounts containing the new fields
and some not.
-<p><br>In order to convert from an old-style <strong>smbpasswd</strong> file to a new
+<p>In order to convert from an old-style <strong>smbpasswd</strong> file to a new
style, run the script <strong>convert_smbpasswd</strong>, installed in the
Samba <code>bin/</code> directory (the same place that the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> binaries are installed) as follows:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
cat old_smbpasswd_file | convert_smbpasswd &gt; new_smbpasswd_file
@@ -159,36 +159,36 @@ and <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd</strong></a> binaries are installed) as f
</pre>
-<p><br>The <strong>convert_smbpasswd</strong> script reads from stdin and writes to stdout
+<p>The <strong>convert_smbpasswd</strong> script reads from stdin and writes to stdout
so as not to overwrite any files by accident.
-<p><br>Once this script has been run, check the contents of the new smbpasswd
+<p>Once this script has been run, check the contents of the new smbpasswd
file to ensure that it has not been damaged by the conversion script
(which uses <strong>awk</strong>), and then replace the <code>&lt;old smbpasswd file&gt;</code>
with the <code>&lt;new smbpasswd file&gt;</code>.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba
+<p><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><strong>smbpasswd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba
(7)</strong></a>, and the Internet RFC1321 for details on the MD4
algorithm.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy
-Allison, <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+Allison, <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
index 2b2f4660646..a0f4577b08c 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbpasswd (8)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,25 +16,24 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbpasswd - change a users SMB password
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbpasswd</strong> [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusd">-d</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minuse">-e</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusD">-D debug level</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusn">-n</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr">-r remote_machine</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusR">-R name resolve order</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusm">-m</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusj">-j DOMAIN</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusU">-U username</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minuss">-s</a>] <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#username">username</a>
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbpasswd</strong> [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusa">-a</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusx">-x</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusd">-d</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minuse">-e</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusD">-D debug level</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusn">-n</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr">-r remote_machine</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusR">-R name resolve order</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusm">-m</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusj">-j DOMAIN</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusU">-U username</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minuss">-s</a>] <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#username">username</a>
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br>The <strong>smbpasswd</strong> program has several different functions, depending
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p>The <strong>smbpasswd</strong> program has several different functions, depending
on whether it is run by the <em>root</em> user or not. When run as a normal
user it allows the user to change the password used for their SMB
sessions on any machines that store SMB passwords.
-<p><br>By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to change the
+<p>By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to change the
current users SMB password on the local machine. This is similar to
the way the <strong>passwd (1)</strong> program works. <strong>smbpasswd</strong> differs from how
the <strong>passwd</strong> program works however in that it is not <em>setuid root</em>
@@ -42,29 +42,29 @@ running <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>. As a consequence in ord
to succeed the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> daemon must be running on
the local machine. On a UNIX machine the encrypted SMB passwords are
usually stored in the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd (5)</strong></a> file.
-<p><br>When run by an ordinary user with no options. <strong>smbpasswd</strong> will
+<p>When run by an ordinary user with no options. <strong>smbpasswd</strong> will
prompt them for their old smb password and then ask them for their new
password twice, to ensure that the new password was typed
correctly. No passwords will be echoed on the screen whilst being
typed. If you have a blank smb password (specified by the string "NO
PASSWORD" in the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file) then just
press the &lt;Enter&gt; key when asked for your old password.
-<p><br><strong>smbpasswd</strong> can also be used by a normal user to change their SMB
+<p><strong>smbpasswd</strong> can also be used by a normal user to change their SMB
password on remote machines, such as Windows NT Primary Domain
Controllers. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr">(<strong>-r</strong>)</a> and
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusU"><strong>-U</strong></a> options below.
-<p><br>When run by root, <strong>smbpasswd</strong> allows new users to be added and
+<p>When run by root, <strong>smbpasswd</strong> allows new users to be added and
deleted in the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file, as well as
allows changes to the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When
run by root, <strong>smbpasswd</strong> accesses the local
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file directly, thus enabling
changes to be made even if <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> is not running.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusa"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong> This option specifies that the username following should
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minusa"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong><dd> This option specifies that the username following should
be added to the local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file, with
the new password typed (type &lt;Enter&gt; for the old password). This
option is ignored if the username following already exists in the
@@ -72,60 +72,65 @@ option is ignored if the username following already exists in the
regular change password command. Note that the user to be added
<strong>must</strong> already exist in the system password file (usually /etc/passwd)
else the request to add the user will fail.
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as
+root.
+<p><a name="minusx"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-x</strong></strong><dd> This option specifies that the username following should
+be deleted from the local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file.
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as
root.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d</strong></strong> This option specifies that the username following should be
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d</strong></strong><dd> This option specifies that the username following should be
<em>disabled</em> in the local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file.
This is done by writing a <em>'D'</em> flag into the account control space
in the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file. Once this is done
all attempts to authenticate via SMB using this username will fail.
-<p><br>If the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file is in the 'old'
+<p>If the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file is in the 'old'
format (pre-Samba 2.0 format) there is no space in the users password
entry to write this information and so the user is disabled by writing
'X' characters into the password space in the
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file. See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd
(5)</strong></a> for details on the 'old' and new password file
formats.
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
-<p><br><a name="minuse"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-e</strong></strong> This option specifies that the username following should be
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
+<p><a name="minuse"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-e</strong></strong><dd> This option specifies that the username following should be
<em>enabled</em> in the local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file,
if the account was previously disabled. If the account was not
disabled this option has no effect. Once the account is enabled
then the user will be able to authenticate via SMB once again.
-<p><br>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format then <strong>smbpasswd</strong> will
+<p>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format then <strong>smbpasswd</strong> will
prompt for a new password for this user, otherwise the account will be
enabled by removing the <em>'D'</em> flag from account control space in the
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file. See <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd
(5)</strong></a> for details on the 'old' and new password file
formats.
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
-<p><br><a name="minusD"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-D debuglevel</strong></strong> debuglevel is an integer from 0
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
+<p><a name="minusD"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-D debuglevel</strong></strong><dd> debuglevel is an integer from 0
to 10. The default value if this parameter is not specified is zero.
-<p><br>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
+<p>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the log files
about the activities of smbpasswd. At level 0, only critical errors
and serious warnings will be logged.
-<p><br>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
+<p>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log data, and
should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are
designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log
data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
-<p><br><a name="minusn"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-n</strong></strong> This option specifies that the username following should
+<p><a name="minusn"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-n</strong></strong><dd> This option specifies that the username following should
have their password set to null (i.e. a blank password) in the local
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file. This is done by writing the
string "NO PASSWORD" as the first part of the first password stored in
the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file.
-<p><br>Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once the password
+<p>Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once the password
has been set to "NO PASSWORD" in the
<a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file the administrator must set
the following parameter in the [global] section of the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file :
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html#nullpasswords">null passwords = true</a>
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
-<p><br><a name="minusr"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-r remote machine name</strong></strong> This option allows a
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#nullpasswords">null passwords = true</a>
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
+<p><a name="minusr"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-r remote machine name</strong></strong><dd> This option allows a
user to specify what machine they wish to change their password
on. Without this parameter <strong>smbpasswd</strong> defaults to the local
host. The <em>"remote machine name"</em> is the NetBIOS name of the
@@ -134,71 +139,71 @@ is resolved into an IP address using the standard name resolution
mechanism in all programs of the <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>Samba</strong></a>
suite. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusR"><strong>-R name resolve order</strong></a> parameter for details on changing this resolving
mechanism.
-<p><br>The username whose password is changed is that of the current UNIX
+<p>The username whose password is changed is that of the current UNIX
logged on user. See the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusU"><strong>-U username</strong></a>
parameter for details on changing the password for a different
username.
-<p><br>Note that if changing a Windows NT Domain password the remote machine
+<p>Note that if changing a Windows NT Domain password the remote machine
specified must be the Primary Domain Controller for the domain (Backup
Domain Controllers only have a read-only copy of the user account
database and will not allow the password change).
-<p><br><em>Note</em> that Windows 95/98 do not have a real password database
+<p><em>Note</em> that Windows 95/98 do not have a real password database
so it is not possible to change passwords specifying a Win95/98
machine as remote machine target.
-<p><br><a name="minusR"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-R name resolve order</strong></strong> This option allows the user of
+<p><a name="minusR"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-R name resolve order</strong></strong><dd> This option allows the user of
smbclient to determine what name resolution services to use when
looking up the NetBIOS name of the host being connected to.
-<p><br>The options are :<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#lmhosts">"lmhosts"</a>, <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#host">"host"</a>,
+<p>The options are :<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#lmhosts">"lmhosts"</a>, <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#host">"host"</a>,
<a href="smbpasswd.8.html#wins">"wins"</a> and <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#bcast">"bcast"</a>. They cause names to be
resolved as follows :
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="lmhosts"></a>
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="lmhosts"></a>
<li > <strong>lmhosts</strong> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file.
-<p><br><a name="host"></a>
+<p><a name="host"></a>
<li > <strong>host</strong> : Do a standard host name to IP address resolution,
using the system /etc/hosts, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name
resolution is operating system dependent. For instance on IRIX or
Solaris, this may be controlled by the <em>/etc/nsswitch.conf</em> file).
-<p><br><a name="wins"></a>
+<p><a name="wins"></a>
<li > <strong>wins</strong> : Query a name with the IP address listed in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#winsserver"><strong>wins server</strong></a> parameter in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf file</strong></a>. If
no WINS server has been specified this method will be ignored.
-<p><br><a name="bcast"></a>
+<p><a name="bcast"></a>
<li > <strong>bcast</strong> : Do a broadcast on each of the known local interfaces
listed in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#interfaces"><strong>interfaces</strong></a> parameter
in the smb.conf file. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally connected
subnet.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order defined
+<p></dl>
+<p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order defined
in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file parameter
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder"><strong>name resolve order</strong></a>
will be used.
-<p><br>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without this
+<p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without this
parameter or any entry in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>
file the name resolution methods will be attempted in this order.
-<p><br><a name="minusm"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-m</strong></strong> This option tells <strong>smbpasswd</strong> that the account being
+<p><a name="minusm"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-m</strong></strong><dd> This option tells <strong>smbpasswd</strong> that the account being
changed is a <em>MACHINE</em> account. Currently this is used when Samba is
being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller. PDC support is not a
supported feature in Samba2.0 but will become supported in a later
release. If you wish to know more about using Samba as an NT PDC then
please subscribe to the mailing list
<a href="mailto:samba-ntdom@samba.org"><em>samba-ntdom@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
-<p><br><a name="minusj"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-j DOMAIN</strong></strong> This option is used to add a Samba server into a
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
+<p><a name="minusj"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-j DOMAIN</strong></strong><dd> This option is used to add a Samba server into a
Windows NT Domain, as a Domain member capable of authenticating user
accounts to any Domain Controller in the same way as a Windows NT
Server. See the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security=domain</strong></a>
option in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a> man page.
-<p><br>In order to be used in this way, the Administrator for the Windows
+<p>In order to be used in this way, the Administrator for the Windows
NT Domain must have used the program <em>"Server Manager for Domains"</em>
to add the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname">primary NetBIOS name</a> of
the Samba server as a member of the Domain.
-<p><br>After this has been done, to join the Domain invoke <strong>smbpasswd</strong> with
+<p>After this has been done, to join the Domain invoke <strong>smbpasswd</strong> with
this parameter. <strong>smbpasswd</strong> will then look up the Primary Domain
Controller for the Domain (found in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file in the parameter
@@ -208,39 +213,39 @@ communication. This password is then stored by <strong>smbpasswd</strong> in a
file, read only by root, called <code>&lt;Domain&gt;.&lt;Machine&gt;.mac</code> where
<code>&lt;Domain&gt;</code> is the name of the Domain we are joining and <code>&lt;Machine&gt;</code>
is the primary NetBIOS name of the machine we are running on.
-<p><br>Once this operation has been performed the
+<p>Once this operation has been performed the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file may be updated to set the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#security"><strong>security=domain</strong></a> option and all
future logins to the Samba server will be authenticated to the Windows
NT PDC.
-<p><br>Note that even though the authentication is being done to the PDC all
+<p>Note that even though the authentication is being done to the PDC all
users accessing the Samba server must still have a valid UNIX account
on that machine.
-<p><br>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
-<p><br><a name="minusU"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-U username</strong></strong> This option may only be used in
+<p>This option is only available when running <strong>smbpasswd</strong> as root.
+<p><a name="minusU"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-U username</strong></strong><dd> This option may only be used in
conjunction with the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr"><strong>-r</strong></a>
option. When changing a password on a remote machine it allows the
user to specify the user name on that machine whose password will be
changed. It is present to allow users who have different user names on
different systems to change these passwords.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> This option prints the help string for <strong>smbpasswd</strong>,
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> This option prints the help string for <strong>smbpasswd</strong>,
selecting the correct one for running as root or as an ordinary user.
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s</strong></strong> This option causes <strong>smbpasswd</strong> to be silent (i.e. not
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s</strong></strong><dd> This option causes <strong>smbpasswd</strong> to be silent (i.e. not
issue prompts) and to read it's old and new passwords from standard
input, rather than from <code>/dev/tty</code> (like the <strong>passwd (1)</strong> program
does). This option is to aid people writing scripts to drive <strong>smbpasswd</strong>
-<p><br><a name="username"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>username</strong></strong> This specifies the username for all of the <em>root
+<p><a name="username"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>username</strong></strong><dd> This specifies the username for all of the <em>root
only</em> options to operate on. Only root can specify this parameter as
only root has the permission needed to modify attributes directly
in the local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><strong>smbpasswd</strong></a> file.
-<p><br><a name="NOTES"></a>
+<p><a name="NOTES"></a>
<h2>NOTES</h2>
-<p><br>Since <strong>smbpasswd</strong> works in client-server mode communicating with a
+<p>Since <strong>smbpasswd</strong> works in client-server mode communicating with a
local <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> for a non-root user then the <strong>smbd</strong>
daemon must be running for this to work. A common problem is to add a
restriction to the hosts that may access the <strong>smbd</strong> running on the
@@ -249,27 +254,27 @@ hosts"</strong></a> or <a href="smb.conf.5.html#denyhosts"><strong>"deny
hosts"</strong></a> entry in the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file and neglecting to allow
<em>"localhost"</em> access to the <strong>smbd</strong>.
-<p><br>In addition, the <strong>smbpasswd</strong> command is only useful if <strong>Samba</strong> has
+<p>In addition, the <strong>smbpasswd</strong> command is only useful if <strong>Samba</strong> has
been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the file <strong>ENCRYPTION.txt</strong>
in the docs directory for details on how to do this.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbrun.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbrun.1.html
index ccfdd6ff2ab..16133fcb220 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbrun.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbrun.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbrun (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,71 +16,70 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbrun - interface program between smbd and external programs
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbrun</strong> <a href="smbrun.1.html#shellcommand">shell-command</a>
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbrun</strong> <a href="smbrun.1.html#shellcommand">shell-command</a>
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>smbrun</strong> is a very small 'glue' program, which runs shell commands
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>smbrun</strong> is a very small 'glue' program, which runs shell commands
for the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> daemon <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd
(8)</strong></a>.
-<p><br>It first changes to the highest effective user and group ID that it
+<p>It first changes to the highest effective user and group ID that it
can, then runs the command line provided using the system() call. This
program is necessary to allow some operating systems to run external
programs as non-root.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="shellcommand"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>shell-command</strong></strong> The shell command to execute. The command
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="shellcommand"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>shell-command</strong></strong><dd> The shell command to execute. The command
should have a fully-qualified path.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
<h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2>
-<p><br>The <em>PATH</em> variable set for the environment in which <strong>smbrun</strong> is
+<p>The <em>PATH</em> variable set for the environment in which <strong>smbrun</strong> is
executed will affect what executables are located and executed if a
fully-qualified path is not given in the command.
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>If <strong>smbrun</strong> cannot be located or cannot be executed by
+<p>If <strong>smbrun</strong> cannot be located or cannot be executed by
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> then appropriate messages will be found in
the <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> logs. Other diagnostics are dependent
on the shell-command being run. It is advisable for your shell
commands to issue suitable diagnostics to aid trouble-shooting.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
index 1cc65e81587..cdce69cdbf8 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbstatus (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,71 +16,70 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbstatus - report on current Samba connections
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbstatus</strong> [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusb">-b</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusd">-d</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusL">-L</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusp">-p</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusS">-S</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusu">-u username</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbstatus</strong> [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusP">-P</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusb">-b</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusd">-d</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusL">-L</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusp">-p</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusS">-S</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minuss">-s configuration file</a>] [<a href="smbstatus.1.html#minusu">-u username</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>smbstatus</strong> is a very simple program to list the current Samba
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>smbstatus</strong> is a very simple program to list the current Samba
connections.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minusP"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong> If samba has been compiled with the profiling option,
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minusP"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-P</strong></strong><dd> If samba has been compiled with the profiling option,
print only the contents of the profiling shared memory area.
-<p><br><a name="minusb"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-b</strong></strong> gives brief output.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d</strong></strong> gives verbose output.
-<p><br><a name="minusL"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-L</strong></strong> causes smbstatus to only list locks.
-<p><br><a name="minusp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-p</strong></strong> print a list of <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
+<p><a name="minusb"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-b</strong></strong><dd> gives brief output.
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d</strong></strong><dd> gives verbose output.
+<p><a name="minusL"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-L</strong></strong><dd> causes smbstatus to only list locks.
+<p><a name="minusp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-p</strong></strong><dd> print a list of <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
processes and exit. Useful for scripting.
-<p><br><a name="minusS"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-S</strong></strong> causes smbstatus to only list shares.
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong> The default configuration file name is
+<p><a name="minusS"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-S</strong></strong><dd> causes smbstatus to only list shares.
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s configuration file</strong></strong><dd> The default configuration file name is
determined at compile time. The file specified contains the
configuration details required by the server. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a> for more information.
-<p><br><a name="minusu"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-u username</strong></strong> selects information relevant to <em>username</em>
+<p><a name="minusu"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-u username</strong></strong><dd> selects information relevant to <em>username</em>
only.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
index ef416f2e6c3..68aab355ed5 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>smbtar (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,106 +16,105 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
smbtar - shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares directly to UNIX tape drives
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>smbtar</strong> <a href="smbtar.1.html#minuss">-s server</a> [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusp">-p password</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusx">-x service</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusX">-X</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusd">-d directory</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusu">-u user</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minust">-t tape</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusb">-b blocksize</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusN">-N filename</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusi">-i</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusr">-r</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusl">-l log level</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusv">-v</a>] filenames
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>smbtar</strong> <a href="smbtar.1.html#minuss">-s server</a> [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusp">-p password</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusx">-x service</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusX">-X</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusd">-d directory</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusu">-u user</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minust">-t tape</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusb">-b blocksize</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusN">-N filename</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusi">-i</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusr">-r</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusl">-l log level</a>] [<a href="smbtar.1.html#minusv">-v</a>] filenames
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>smbtar</strong> is a very small shell script on top of
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>smbtar</strong> is a very small shell script on top of
<a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a> which dumps SMB shares directly
to tape.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s server</strong></strong> The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides upon.
-<p><br><a name="minusx"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-x service</strong></strong> The share name on the server to connect
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s server</strong></strong><dd> The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides upon.
+<p><a name="minusx"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-x service</strong></strong><dd> The share name on the server to connect
to. The default is <code>backup</code>.
-<p><br><a name="minusX"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-X</strong></strong> Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar create or
+<p><a name="minusX"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-X</strong></strong><dd> Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar create or
restore.
-<p><br><a name="minusd"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-d directory</strong></strong> Change to initial <em>directory</em> before restoring
+<p><a name="minusd"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-d directory</strong></strong><dd> Change to initial <em>directory</em> before restoring
/ backing up files.
-<p><br><a name="minusv"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-v</strong></strong> Verbose mode.
-<p><br><a name="minusp"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-p password</strong></strong> The password to use to access a share. Default:
+<p><a name="minusv"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-v</strong></strong><dd> Verbose mode.
+<p><a name="minusp"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-p password</strong></strong><dd> The password to use to access a share. Default:
none
-<p><br><a name="minusu"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-u user</strong></strong> The user id to connect as. Default: UNIX login name.
-<p><br><a name="minust"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-t tape</strong></strong> Tape device. May be regular file or tape
+<p><a name="minusu"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-u user</strong></strong><dd> The user id to connect as. Default: UNIX login name.
+<p><a name="minust"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-t tape</strong></strong><dd> Tape device. May be regular file or tape
device. Default: <em>TAPE</em> environmental variable; if not set, a file
called <code>tar.out</code>.
-<p><br><a name="minusb"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-b blocksize</strong></strong> Blocking factor. Defaults to 20. See <strong>tar (1)</strong>
+<p><a name="minusb"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-b blocksize</strong></strong><dd> Blocking factor. Defaults to 20. See <strong>tar (1)</strong>
for a fuller explanation.
-<p><br><a name="minusN"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-N filename</strong></strong> Backup only files newer than filename. Could be
+<p><a name="minusN"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-N filename</strong></strong><dd> Backup only files newer than filename. Could be
used (for example) on a log file to implement incremental backups.
-<p><br><a name="minusi"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-i</strong></strong> Incremental mode; tar files are only backed up if they
+<p><a name="minusi"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-i</strong></strong><dd> Incremental mode; tar files are only backed up if they
have the archive bit set. The archive bit is reset after each file is
read.
-<p><br><a name="minusr"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-r</strong></strong> Restore. Files are restored to the share from the tar
+<p><a name="minusr"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-r</strong></strong><dd> Restore. Files are restored to the share from the tar
file.
-<p><br><a name="minusl"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-l log level</strong></strong> Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
+<p><a name="minusl"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-l log level</strong></strong><dd> Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
<a href="smbclient.1.html#minusd"><strong>-d</strong></a> flag of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient
(1)</strong></a>.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="ENVIRONMENTVARIABLES"></a>
<h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2>
-<p><br>The TAPE variable specifies the default tape device to write to. May
+<p>The TAPE variable specifies the default tape device to write to. May
be overridden with the <a href="smbtar.1.html#minust"><strong>-t</strong></a> option.
-<p><br><a name="BUGS"></a>
+<p><a name="BUGS"></a>
<h2>BUGS</h2>
-<p><br>The <strong>smbtar</strong> script has different options from ordinary tar and tar
+<p>The <strong>smbtar</strong> script has different options from ordinary tar and tar
called from <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="CAVEATS"></a>
+<p><a name="CAVEATS"></a>
<h2>CAVEATS</h2>
-<p><br>Sites that are more careful about security may not like the way the
+<p>Sites that are more careful about security may not like the way the
script handles PC passwords. Backup and restore work on entire shares,
should work on file lists. <strong>smbtar</strong> works best with GNU tar and may
not work well with other versions.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
+<p><a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient (1)</strong></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf
(5)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#DIAGNOSTICS"><strong>DIAGNOSTICS</strong></a> section for
+<p>See the <a href="smbclient.1.html#DIAGNOSTICS"><strong>DIAGNOSTICS</strong></a> section for
the <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient</strong></a> command.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>Ricky Poulten <a href="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk"><em>poultenr@logica.co.uk</em></a> wrote the tar extension and
+<p>Ricky Poulten <a href="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk"><em>poultenr@logica.co.uk</em></a> wrote the tar extension and
this man page. The <strong>smbtar</strong> script was heavily rewritten and
improved by Martin Kraemer <a href="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de"><em>Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de</em></a>. Many
thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug fixes,
@@ -122,9 +122,9 @@ etc. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
excellent piece of Open Source software available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison,
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
-<p><br></body>
+<p></body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
index 3a29f17ab5e..12d83247fdd 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>swat (8)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,53 +16,52 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
swat - Samba Web Administration Tool
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>swat</strong> [<a href="swat.8.html#minuss">-s smb config file</a>] [<a href="swat.8.html#minusa">-a</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>swat</strong> [<a href="swat.8.html#minuss">-s smb config file</a>] [<a href="swat.8.html#minusa">-a</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>swat</strong> allows a Samba administrator to configure the complex
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>swat</strong> allows a Samba administrator to configure the complex
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file via a Web browser. In
addition, a swat configuration page has help links to all the
configurable options in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file
allowing an administrator to easily look up the effects of any change.
-<p><br><strong>swat</strong> is run from <strong>inetd</strong>
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><strong>swat</strong> is run from <strong>inetd</strong>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s smb configuration file</strong></strong> The default configuration file path is
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s smb configuration file</strong></strong><dd> The default configuration file path is
determined at compile time.
-<p><br>The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
+<p>The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> server. This is the file that <strong>swat</strong> will
modify. The information in this file includes server-specific
information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions
of all the services that the server is to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html">smb.conf
(5)</a> for more information.
-<p><br><a name="minusa"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong>
-<p><br>This option disables authentication and puts <strong>swat</strong> in demo mode. In
+<p><a name="minusa"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-a</strong></strong><dd>
+<p>This option disables authentication and puts <strong>swat</strong> in demo mode. In
that mode anyone will be able to modify the
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
-<p><br>Do NOT enable this option on a production server.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
+<p>Do NOT enable this option on a production server.
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="INSTALLATION"></a>
<h2>INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>After you compile SWAT you need to run <code>"make install"</code> to install the
+<p>After you compile SWAT you need to run <code>"make install"</code> to install the
swat binary and the various help files and images. A default install
would put these in:
-<p><br><pre>
+<p><pre>
/usr/local/samba/bin/swat
/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*
@@ -69,79 +69,79 @@ would put these in:
</pre>
-<p><br><a name="INETD"></a>
+<p><a name="INETD"></a>
<h2>INETD INSTALLATION</h2>
-<p><br>You need to edit your <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> and <code>/etc/services</code> to
+<p>You need to edit your <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> and <code>/etc/services</code> to
enable <strong>SWAT</strong> to be launched via inetd.
-<p><br>In <code>/etc/services</code> you need to add a line like this:
-<p><br><code>swat 901/tcp</code>
-<p><br>Note for NIS/YP users - you may need to rebuild the NIS service maps
+<p>In <code>/etc/services</code> you need to add a line like this:
+<p><code>swat 901/tcp</code>
+<p>Note for NIS/YP users - you may need to rebuild the NIS service maps
rather than alter your local <code>/etc/services</code> file.
-<p><br>the choice of port number isn't really important except that it should
+<p>the choice of port number isn't really important except that it should
be less than 1024 and not currently used (using a number above 1024
presents an obscure security hole depending on the implementation
details of your <strong>inetd</strong> daemon).
-<p><br>In <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> you should add a line like this:
-<p><br><code>swat stream tcp nowait.400 root /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat</code>
-<p><br>One you have edited <code>/etc/services</code> and <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> you need
+<p>In <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> you should add a line like this:
+<p><code>swat stream tcp nowait.400 root /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat</code>
+<p>One you have edited <code>/etc/services</code> and <code>/etc/inetd.conf</code> you need
to send a HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <code>"kill -1 PID"</code> where
PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon.
-<p><br><a name="LAUNCHING"></a>
+<p><a name="LAUNCHING"></a>
<h2>LAUNCHING</h2>
-<p><br>To launch <strong>swat</strong> just run your favorite web browser and point it at
+<p>To launch <strong>swat</strong> just run your favorite web browser and point it at
<code>http://localhost:901/</code>.
-<p><br><strong>Note that you can attach to <strong>swat</strong> from any IP connected machine but
+<p><strong>Note that you can attach to <strong>swat</strong> from any IP connected machine but
connecting from a remote machine leaves your connection open to
password sniffing as passwords will be sent in the clear over the
wire.</strong>
-<p><br><h2>FILES</h2>
+<p><h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
-<p><br>This file must contain suitable startup information for the
+<p><strong>/etc/inetd.conf</strong>
+<p>This file must contain suitable startup information for the
meta-daemon.
-<p><br><strong>/etc/services</strong>
-<p><br>This file must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., swat) to
+<p><strong>/etc/services</strong>
+<p>This file must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., swat) to
service port (e.g., 901) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
-<p><br><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
-<p><br>This is the default location of the <em>smb.conf</em> server configuration
+<p><strong>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</strong>
+<p>This is the default location of the <em>smb.conf</em> server configuration
file that <strong>swat</strong> edits. Other common places that systems install
this file are <em>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</em> and <em>/etc/smb.conf</em>.
-<p><br>This file describes all the services the server is to make available
+<p>This file describes all the services the server is to make available
to clients. See <strong>smb.conf (5)</strong> for more information.
-<p><br><a name="WARNINGS"></a>
+<p><a name="WARNINGS"></a>
<h2>WARNINGS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>swat</strong> will rewrite your <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file. It
+<p><strong>swat</strong> will rewrite your <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file. It
will rearrange the entries and delete all comments,
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#include"><strong>"include="</strong></a> and
<a href="smb.conf.5.html#copy"><strong>"copy="</strong></a> options. If you have a
carefully crafted <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> then back it up
or don't use <strong>swat</strong>!
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
+<p><strong>inetd (8)</strong>, <a href="nmbd.8.html"><strong>nmbd (8)</strong></a>,
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell (samba-bugs@samba.org). Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell (samba@samba.org). Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
index 1e0396af337..8babecbcfab 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/testparm.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>testparm (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,53 +16,52 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
testparm - check an smb.conf configuration file for internal correctness
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>testparm</strong> [<a href="testparm.1.html#minuss">-s</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#minusL">-L servername</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#configfilename">configfilename</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#hostname">hostname</a> <a href="testparm.1.html#hostIP">hostIP</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>testparm</strong> [<a href="testparm.1.html#minuss">-s</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#minush">-h</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#minusL">-L servername</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#configfilename">configfilename</a>] [<a href="testparm.1.html#hostname">hostname</a> <a href="testparm.1.html#hostIP">hostIP</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>testparm</strong> is a very simple test program to check an
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>testparm</strong> is a very simple test program to check an
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> configuration file for internal
correctness. If this program reports no problems, you can use the
configuration file with confidence that <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>
will successfully load the configuration file.
-<p><br>Note that this is <em>NOT</em> a guarantee that the services specified in the
+<p>Note that this is <em>NOT</em> a guarantee that the services specified in the
configuration file will be available or will operate as expected.
-<p><br>If the optional host name and host IP address are specified on the
+<p>If the optional host name and host IP address are specified on the
command line, this test program will run through the service entries
reporting whether the specified host has access to each service.
-<p><br>If <strong>testparm</strong> finds an error in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>
+<p>If <strong>testparm</strong> finds an error in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>
file it returns an exit code of 1 to the calling program, else it returns
an exit code of 0. This allows shell scripts to test the output from
<strong>testparm</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="minuss"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-s</strong></strong> Without this option, <strong>testparm</strong> will prompt for a
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="minuss"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-s</strong></strong><dd> Without this option, <strong>testparm</strong> will prompt for a
carriage return after printing the service names and before dumping
the service definitions.
-<p><br><a name="minush"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong> Print usage message
-<p><br><a name="minusL"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>-L servername</strong></strong> Sets the value of the %L macro to servername. This
+<p><a name="minush"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-h</strong></strong><dd> Print usage message
+<p><a name="minusL"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>-L servername</strong></strong><dd> Sets the value of the %L macro to servername. This
is useful for testing include files specified with the %L macro.
-<p><br><a name="configfilename"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>configfilename</strong></strong> This is the name of the configuration file to
+<p><a name="configfilename"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>configfilename</strong></strong><dd> This is the name of the configuration file to
check. If this parameter is not present then the default
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file will be checked.
-<p><br><a name="hostname"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hostname</strong></strong> If this parameter and the following are specified,
+<p><a name="hostname"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hostname</strong></strong><dd> If this parameter and the following are specified,
then testparm will examine the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsallow"><strong>"hosts
allow"</strong></a> and <a href="smb.conf.5.html#hostsdeny"><strong>"hosts
deny"</strong></a> parameters in the
@@ -69,45 +69,45 @@ deny"</strong></a> parameters in the
with this IP address would be allowed access to the
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> server. If this parameter is supplied, the
<a href="testparm.1.html#hostIP">hostIP</a> parameter must also be supplied.
-<p><br><a name="hostIP"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>hostIP</strong></strong> This is the IP address of the host specified in the
+<p><a name="hostIP"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>hostIP</strong></strong><dd> This is the IP address of the host specified in the
previous parameter. This address must be supplied if the hostname
parameter is supplied.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="FILES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>. This is usually the name of the
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>. This is usually the name of the
configuration file used by <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>The program will issue a message saying whether the configuration file
+<p>The program will issue a message saying whether the configuration file
loaded OK or not. This message may be preceded by errors and warnings
if the file did not load. If the file was loaded OK, the program then
dumps all known service details to stdout.
-<p><br><a name="VERSION"></a>
+<p><a name="VERSION"></a>
<h2>VERSION</h2>
-<p><br>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>This man page is correct for version 2.0 of the Samba suite.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf (5)</strong></a>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
index 8afbbb7cd48..42f5aebe742 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html
@@ -3,9 +3,10 @@
+
<html><head><title>testprns (1)</title>
-<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org">
+<link rev="made" href="mailto:samba@samba.org">
</head>
<body>
@@ -15,33 +16,32 @@
<h2>Samba</h2>
<h2>23 Oct 1998</h2>
-
-<p><br><a name="NAME"></a>
+<p><a name="NAME"></a>
<h2>NAME</h2>
testprns - check printer name for validity with smbd
-<p><br><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
+<p><a name="SYNOPSIS"></a>
<h2>SYNOPSIS</h2>
-<p><br><strong>testprns</strong> <a href="testprns.1.html#printername">printername</a> [<a href="testprns.1.html#printcapname">printcapname</a>]
-<p><br><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
+<p><strong>testprns</strong> <a href="testprns.1.html#printername">printername</a> [<a href="testprns.1.html#printcapname">printcapname</a>]
+<p><a name="DESCRIPTION"></a>
<h2>DESCRIPTION</h2>
-<p><br>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
-<p><br><strong>testprns</strong> is a very simple test program to determine whether a
+<p>This program is part of the <strong>Samba</strong> suite.
+<p><strong>testprns</strong> is a very simple test program to determine whether a
given printer name is valid for use in a service to be provided by
<a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a>.
-<p><br>"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the printcap
+<p>"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the printcap
specified". This program is very stupid - so stupid in fact that it
would be wisest to always specify the printcap file to use.
-<p><br><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
+<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
-<p><br><ul>
-<p><br><a name="printername"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printername</strong></strong> The printer name to validate.
-<p><br>Printer names are taken from the first field in each record in the
+<p><dl>
+<p><a name="printername"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printername</strong></strong><dd> The printer name to validate.
+<p>Printer names are taken from the first field in each record in the
printcap file, single printer names and sets of aliases separated by
vertical bars ("|") are recognized. Note that no validation or
checking of the printcap syntax is done beyond that required to
@@ -49,49 +49,49 @@ extract the printer name. It may be that the print spooling system is
more forgiving or less forgiving than <strong>testprns</strong>. However, if
<strong>testprns</strong> finds the printer then <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd</strong></a> should
do so as well.
-<p><br><a name="printcapname"></a>
-<li><strong><strong>printcapname</strong></strong> This is the name of the printcap file within
+<p><a name="printcapname"></a>
+<p></p><dt><strong><strong>printcapname</strong></strong><dd> This is the name of the printcap file within
which to search for the given printer name.
-<p><br>If no printcap name is specified <strong>testprns</strong> will attempt to scan the
+<p>If no printcap name is specified <strong>testprns</strong> will attempt to scan the
printcap file name specified at compile time.
-<p><br></ul>
-<p><br><a name="FILES"></a>
+<p></dl>
+<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
-<p><br><strong>/etc/printcap</strong> This is usually the default printcap file to
+<p><strong>/etc/printcap</strong> This is usually the default printcap file to
scan. See <strong>printcap (5)</strong>.
-<p><br><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
+<p><a name="DIAGNOSTICS"></a>
<h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2>
-<p><br>If a printer is found to be valid, the message "Printer name
+<p>If a printer is found to be valid, the message "Printer name
&lt;printername&gt; is valid" will be displayed.
-<p><br>If a printer is found to be invalid, the message "Printer name
+<p>If a printer is found to be invalid, the message "Printer name
&lt;printername&gt; is not valid" will be displayed.
-<p><br>All messages that would normally be logged during operation of the
+<p>All messages that would normally be logged during operation of the
<a href="samba.7.html"><strong>Samba</strong></a> daemons are logged by this program to the
file <code>test.log</code> in the current directory. The program runs at
debuglevel 3, so quite extensive logging information is written. The
log should be checked carefully for errors and warnings.
-<p><br>Other messages are self-explanatory.
-<p><br><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
+<p>Other messages are self-explanatory.
+<p><a name="SEEALSO"></a>
<h2>SEE ALSO</h2>
-<p><br><strong>printcap (5)</strong>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient
+<p><strong>printcap (5)</strong>, <a href="smbd.8.html"><strong>smbd (8)</strong></a>, <a href="smbclient.1.html"><strong>smbclient
(1)</strong></a>
-<p><br><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
+<p><a name="AUTHOR"></a>
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
-<p><br>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
+<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
+Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed.
-<p><br>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
+<p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page
sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
<a href="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/"><strong>ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</strong></a>)
and updated for the Samba2.0 release by Jeremy Allison.
-<a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>.
-<p><br>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
+<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org"><em>samba@samba.org</em></a>.
+<p>See <a href="samba.7.html"><strong>samba (7)</strong></a> to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
comments etc.
</body>
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
index ad0edf32acb..1e6b822d345 100644
--- a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
+++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html
@@ -36,8 +36,10 @@ different databases services such as NIS or DNS. The exact behaviour can
be configured throught the <code>/etc/nsswitch.conf</code> file. Users and groups
are allocated as they are resolved to a range of user and group ids
specified by the administrator of the Samba system.
-<p>The service provided by <strong>winbindd</strong> is called `winbind' and can be used to
-resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server.
+<p>The service provided by <strong>winbindd</strong> is called `winbind' and can be
+used to resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server.
+The service can also provide authentication services via an associated
+PAM module.
<p>The following nsswitch databases are implemented by the <strong>winbindd</strong>
service:
<p><dl>
@@ -52,8 +54,13 @@ service:
<code>/etc/nsswitch.conf</code> file can be used to initially resolve user and group
information from <code>/etc/passwd</code> and <code>/etc/group</code> and then from the
Windows NT server.
-<p><code>passwd: files winbind</code>
-<p><code>group: files winbind</code>
+<p><pre>
+
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+
+</pre>
+
<p><a name="OPTIONS"></a>
<h2>OPTIONS</h2>
@@ -96,6 +103,20 @@ parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a> file.
should be specified in the [global] section of
<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><strong>smb.conf</strong></a>.
<p><dl>
+<p><p></p><dt><strong>winbind separator</strong><dd>
+<p>The winbind separator option allows you to specify how NT domain names
+and user names are combined into unix user names when presented to
+users. By default winbind will use the traditional \ separator so
+that the unix user names look like DOMAIN\username. In some cases
+this separator character may cause problems as the \ character has
+special meaning in unix shells. In that case you can use the winbind
+separator option to specify an alternative sepataror character. Good
+alternatives may be / (although that conflicts with the unix directory
+separator) or a + character. The + character appears to be the best
+choice for 100% compatibility with existing unix utilities, but may be
+an aesthetically bad choice depending on your taste.
+<p><strong>Example:</strong>
+<code> winbind separator = +</code>
<p><p></p><dt><strong>winbind uid</strong><dd>
<p>The winbind uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
allocated by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon. This range of
@@ -117,9 +138,16 @@ conflicts can occur otherwise.
<p><p></p><dt><strong>winbind cache time</strong><dd>
<p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon will cache user and group
-information before querying a Windows NT server again.
+information before querying a Windows NT server again. When a item in
+the cache is older than this time winbindd will ask the domain
+controller for the sequence number of the servers account database. If
+the sequence number has not changed then the cached item is marked as
+valid for a further "winbind cache time" seconds. Otherwise the item
+is fetched from the server. This means that as long as the account
+database is not actively changing winbindd will only have to send one
+sequence number query packet every "winbind cache time" seconds.
<p><strong>Default:</strong>
-<code> winbind cache type = 15</code>
+<code> winbind cache time = 15</code>
<p><p></p><dt><strong>template homedir</strong><dd>
<p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon uses this parameter to fill in
@@ -131,12 +159,85 @@ is present it is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.
<p><p></p><dt><strong>template shell</strong><dd>
<p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
<a href="winbindd.8.html"><strong>winbindd</strong></a> daemon uses this parameter to fill in
-the home directory for that user. If the string <code>%D</code> is present it is
-substituted with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string <code>%U</code>
-is present it is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.
+the shell for that user.
<p><strong>Default:</strong>
-<code> template homedir = /home/%D/%U</code>
+<code> template shell = /bin/false</code>
<p></dl>
+<p><a name="EXAMPLESETUP"></a>
+<h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2>
+
+<p>To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus authentication from
+a domain controller use something like the following setup. This was
+tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box.
+<p>In /etc/nsswitch.conf put the following:
+<pre>
+
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>In /etc/pam.d/* replace the auth lines with something like this:
+<pre>
+
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>Note in particular the use of the sufficient keyword and the
+use_first_pass keyword.
+<p>Now replace the account lines with this:
+<pre>
+
+ account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the samedit
+program like this:
+<pre>
+
+ samedit -S '*' -W DOMAIN -UAdministrator
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>Then within samedit run the command:
+<pre>
+
+ createuser MACHINE$ -j DOMAIN -L
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>This assumes your domain is called DOMAIN and your Samba workstation
+is called MACHINE.
+<p>Next copy libnss_winbind.so.2 to /lib and pam_winbind.so to
+/lib/security.
+<p>Finally, setup a smb.conf containing directives like the following:
+<pre>
+
+ [global]
+ winbind separator = +
+ winbind cache time = 10
+ template shell = /bin/bash
+ template homedir = /home/%D/%U
+ winbind uid = 10000-20000
+ winbind gid = 10000-20000
+ workgroup = DOMAIN
+ security = domain
+ password server = *
+
+</pre>
+
+<p>Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and group
+database is expanded to include your NT users and groups, and that you
+can login to your unix box as a domain user, using the DOMAIN+user
+syntax for the username. You may wish to use the commands "getent
+passwd" and "getent group" to confirm the correct operation of
+winbindd.
+<p>NOTE: nmbd must be running on the local machine for winbindd to work.
<p><a name="FILES"></a>
<h2>FILES</h2>
@@ -170,9 +271,8 @@ is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost.
<h2>AUTHOR</h2>
<p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell <a href="mailto:samba-bugs@samba.org"><em>samba-bugs@samba.org</em></a>. Samba is now developed
-by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
-Linux kernel is developed.
+Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open
+Source project.
<p>Winbindd was written by Tim Potter.
</body>
</html>
diff --git a/docs/manpages/lmhosts.5 b/docs/manpages/lmhosts.5
index 534c2484150..3609ca256f0 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/lmhosts.5
+++ b/docs/manpages/lmhosts.5
@@ -76,7 +76,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/make_smbcodepage.1 b/docs/manpages/make_smbcodepage.1
index 9c134201078..e6c76d9855d 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/make_smbcodepage.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/make_smbcodepage.1
@@ -61,7 +61,7 @@ provided in the Samba distribution for codepages 437 (USA), 737
866 (Cyrillic), 932 (Kanji SJIS), 936 (Simplified Chinese), 949
(Hangul) and 950 (Traditional Chinese)\&. Users are encouraged to write
text codepage definition files for their own code pages and donate
-them to \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. All codepage files in the
+them to samba@samba\&.org\&. All codepage files in the
Samba \fIsource/codepages\fP directory are compiled and installed when a
\fI\'make install\'\fP command is issued there\&.
.PP
@@ -128,7 +128,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/nmbd.8 b/docs/manpages/nmbd.8
index 72aeaf14a77..55930f6629a 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/nmbd.8
+++ b/docs/manpages/nmbd.8
@@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ naming services to clients
.PP
.SH "SYNOPSIS"
.PP
-\fBnmbd\fP [-D] [-a] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-H lmhosts file] [-d debuglevel] [-l log file basename] [-n primary NetBIOS name] [-p port number] [-s configuration file] [-i NetBIOS scope]
+\fBnmbd\fP [-D] [-a] [-o] [-h] [-V] [-H lmhosts file] [-d debuglevel] [-l log file basename] [-n primary NetBIOS name] [-p port number] [-s configuration file]
.PP
.SH "DESCRIPTION"
.PP
@@ -136,14 +136,6 @@ this may be changed when Samba is autoconfigured\&.
The file specified contains the configuration details required by the
server\&. See \fBsmb\&.conf (5)\fP for more information\&.
.IP
-.IP "\fB-i scope\fP"
-This specifies a NetBIOS scope that \fBnmbd\fP will use
-to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names\&. For details on the
-use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001\&.txt and rfc1002\&.txt\&. NetBIOS scopes
-are \fIvery\fP rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
-system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
-communicate with\&.
-.IP
.PP
.SH "FILES"
.PP
@@ -212,7 +204,7 @@ http://samba\&.org/cifs/\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -221,7 +213,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/nmblookup.1 b/docs/manpages/nmblookup.1
index a542e6d5074..3d1491e8788 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/nmblookup.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/nmblookup.1
@@ -139,7 +139,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -148,7 +148,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/samba.7 b/docs/manpages/samba.7
index 96975f34c26..a508093b8b6 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/samba.7
+++ b/docs/manpages/samba.7
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ described in a separate manual page\&. It is strongly recommended that
you read the documentation that comes with Samba and the manual pages
of those components that you use\&. If the manual pages aren\'t clear
enough then please send a patch or bug report
-to \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+to samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
.IP
.IP "\fBsmbd\fP"
@@ -121,13 +121,13 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "CONTRIBUTIONS"
.PP
If you wish to contribute to the Samba project, then I suggest you
-join the Samba mailing list at \fIsamba@samba\&.org\fP\&. See the
+join the Samba mailing list at samba@samba\&.org\&. See the
Web page at
http://samba\&.org/listproc
for details on how to do this\&.
.PP
If you have patches to submit or bugs to report then you may mail them
-directly to \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Note, however, that due to
+directly to samba@samba\&.org\&. Note, however, that due to
the enormous popularity of this package the Samba Team may take some
time to respond to mail\&. We prefer patches in \fIdiff -u\fP format\&.
.PP
@@ -149,7 +149,7 @@ http://samba\&.org/samba/samba-thanks\&.html\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -158,4 +158,4 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smb.conf.5 b/docs/manpages/smb.conf.5
index ac227d91821..3847288a03e 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smb.conf.5
+++ b/docs/manpages/smb.conf.5
@@ -86,7 +86,7 @@ write access to the path \f(CW/home/bar\fP\&. The share is accessed via
the share name "foo":
.PP
-.DS
+.nf
@@ -95,7 +95,7 @@ the share name "foo":
writeable = true
-.DE
+.fi
.PP
@@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ is via calls to open, write to and close a spool file\&. The
as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
.PP
-.DS
+.nf
[aprinter]
@@ -115,7 +115,7 @@ as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
printable = true
guest ok = true
-.DE
+.fi
.PP
@@ -175,13 +175,13 @@ section can specify, though some make more sense than others\&. The
following is a typical and suitable [homes] section:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
[homes]
writeable = yes
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -237,7 +237,7 @@ directory with the sticky bit set on it\&. A typical \fB[printers]\fP entry
would look like this:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
[printers]
@@ -245,7 +245,7 @@ would look like this:
guest ok = yes
printable = yes
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -256,10 +256,10 @@ pseudo-printcap\&. This is a file consisting of one or more lines like
this:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
alias|alias|alias|alias\&.\&.\&.
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -377,7 +377,7 @@ negotiation\&. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS, LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1\&.
machine\&. Only some are recognized, and those may not be 100%
reliable\&. It currently recognizes Samba, WfWg, WinNT and
Win95\&. Anything else will be known as "UNKNOWN"\&. If it gets it wrong
-then sending a level 3 log to \fIsamba@samba\&.org\fP
+then sending a level 3 log to samba@samba\&.org
should allow it to be fixed\&.
.IP
.IP o
@@ -1993,7 +1993,7 @@ interesting things\&.
.IP
\fBExample:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
default service = pub
@@ -2001,7 +2001,7 @@ interesting things\&.
[pub]
path = /%S
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -2138,26 +2138,26 @@ and remaining space will be used\&.\fP
Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
#!/bin/sh
df $1 | tail -1 | awk \'{print $2" "$4}\'
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
#!/bin/sh
/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk \'{print $3" "$5}\'
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -2267,7 +2267,7 @@ Samba NT Domain Controller Code\&. It may be removed in a later release\&.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list \fBSamba-ntdom\fP available by sending email to
-\fIlistproc@samba\&.org\fP
+listproc@samba\&.org
.IP
.IP "\fBdomain admin users (G)\fP"
.IP
@@ -2276,7 +2276,7 @@ Samba NT Domain Controller Code\&. It may be removed in a later release\&.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list \fBSamba-ntdom\fP available by sending email to
-\fIlistproc@samba\&.org\fP
+listproc@samba\&.org
.IP
.IP "\fBdomain groups (G)\fP"
.IP
@@ -2285,7 +2285,7 @@ Samba NT Domain Controller Code\&. It may be removed in a later release\&.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list \fBSamba-ntdom\fP available by sending email to
-\fIlistproc@samba\&.org\fP
+listproc@samba\&.org
.IP
.IP "\fBdomain guest group (G)\fP"
.IP
@@ -2294,7 +2294,7 @@ Samba NT Domain Controller Code\&. It may be removed in a later release\&.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list \fBSamba-ntdom\fP available by sending email to
-\fIlistproc@samba\&.org\fP
+listproc@samba\&.org
.IP
.IP "\fBdomain guest users (G)\fP"
.IP
@@ -2303,7 +2303,7 @@ Samba NT Domain Controller Code\&. It may be removed in a later release\&.
To work with the latest code builds that may have more support for
Samba NT Domain Controller functionality please subscribe to the
mailing list \fBSamba-ntdom\fP available by sending email to
-\fIlistproc@samba\&.org\fP
+listproc@samba\&.org
.IP
.IP "\fBdomain logons (G)\fP"
.IP
@@ -2796,13 +2796,13 @@ files"\fP and \fB"case sensitive"\fP\&.
.IP
\fBDefault\fP
-.DS
+.nf
No files or directories are hidden by this option (dot files are
hidden by default because of the "hide dot files" option)\&.
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -4480,20 +4480,20 @@ debug"\fP\&.
.IP
\fBExample:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\en "*Enter NEW password*" %n\en "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\en "*Password changed*"
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
\fBDefault:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
passwd chat = *old*password* %o\en *new*password* %n\en *new*password* %n\en *changed*
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -4745,12 +4745,12 @@ An interesting example is to send the users a welcome message every
time they log in\&. Maybe a message of the day? Here is an example:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
preexec = csh -c \'echo \e"Welcome to %S!\e" | /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I\' &
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -4923,7 +4923,7 @@ to obtain a printer list\&.
A minimal printcap file would look something like this:
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
print1|My Printer 1
@@ -4932,7 +4932,7 @@ A minimal printcap file would look something like this:
print4|My Printer 4
print5|My Printer 5
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -5807,7 +5807,7 @@ You may find that on some systems Samba will say "Unknown socket
option" when you supply an option\&. This means you either incorrectly
typed it or you need to add an include file to includes\&.h for your OS\&.
If the latter is the case please send the patch to
-\fIsamba@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.IP
Any of the supported socket options may be combined in any way you
like, as long as your OS allows it\&.
@@ -6474,13 +6474,13 @@ information on how this parameter determines access to the services\&.
.IP
\fBExamples:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
username = fred
username = fred, mary, jack, jane, @users, @pcgroup
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -6564,13 +6564,13 @@ and map the rest to guest\&. Note the use of the \f(CW\'!\'\fP to tell Samba
to stop processing if it gets a match on that line\&.
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
!sys = mary fred
guest = *
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -6686,14 +6686,14 @@ is a pointless thing to do as it\'s already there) you could do one of
the following
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
valid chars = Z
valid chars = z:Z
valid chars = 0132:0172
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -6710,13 +6710,13 @@ See also the \fB"client code page"\fP parameter\&.
.IP
\fBDefault:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
Samba defaults to using a reasonable set of valid characters
for English systems
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -6728,7 +6728,7 @@ them\&.
.IP
NOTE: It is actually quite difficult to correctly produce a \fB"valid
chars"\fP line for a particular system\&. To automate the process
-\fItino@augsburg\&.net\fP has written a package called \fB"validchars"\fP
+tino@augsburg\&.net has written a package called \fB"validchars"\fP
which will automatically produce a complete \fB"valid chars"\fP line for
a given client system\&. Look in the examples/validchars/ subdirectory
of your Samba source code distribution for this package\&.
@@ -6792,7 +6792,7 @@ sensitive"\fP\&.
Example 1\&.
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
@@ -6802,14 +6802,14 @@ Example 1\&.
veto files = /*Security*/*\&.tmp/*root*/
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
Example 2\&.
.IP
-.DS
+.nf
Veto the Apple specific files that a NetAtalk server
@@ -6817,7 +6817,7 @@ Example 2\&.
veto files = /\&.AppleDouble/\&.bin/\&.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -7037,14 +7037,14 @@ permitting), but only via spooling operations\&.
.IP
\fBExamples:\fP
-.DS
+.nf
read only = no
writeable = yes
write ok = yes
-.DE
+.fi
.IP
@@ -7083,7 +7083,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -7092,7 +7092,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbclient.1 b/docs/manpages/smbclient.1
index 4346629adbd..6b3edb38fc7 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbclient.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbclient.1
@@ -760,7 +760,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -769,7 +769,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbd.8 b/docs/manpages/smbd.8
index 5efd6794787..5ee6cd53082 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbd.8
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbd.8
@@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ smbd \- server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients
.PP
.SH "SYNOPSIS"
.PP
-\fBsmbd\fP [-D] [-a] [-o] [-P] [-h] [-V] [-d debuglevel] [-l log file] [-p port number] [-O socket options] [-s configuration file] [-i scope]
+\fBsmbd\fP [-D] [-a] [-o] [-P] [-h] [-V] [-d debuglevel] [-l log file] [-p port number] [-O socket options] [-s configuration file]
.PP
.SH "DESCRIPTION"
.PP
@@ -137,14 +137,6 @@ of all the services that the server is to provide\&. See \fBsmb\&.conf
(5)\fP for more information\&.
The default configuration file name is determined at compile time\&.
.IP
-.IP "\fB-i scope\fP"
-This specifies a NetBIOS scope that the server will use
-to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names\&. For details on the
-use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001\&.txt and rfc1002\&.txt\&. NetBIOS scopes
-are \fIvery\fP rarely used, only set this parameter if you are the
-system administrator in charge of all the NetBIOS systems you
-communicate with\&.
-.IP
.PP
.SH "FILES"
.PP
@@ -329,7 +321,7 @@ Lastly, edit the configuration file to provide suitable services\&. To
start with, the following two services should be all you need:
.PP
-.DS
+.nf
@@ -343,7 +335,7 @@ start with, the following two services should be all you need:
public = yes
-.DE
+.fi
.PP
@@ -423,7 +415,7 @@ http://samba\&.org/cifs/\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -432,7 +424,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full list of contributors
and details on how to submit bug reports, comments etc\&.
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.5 b/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.5
index e3fbcf161ee..bc87d134d23 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.5
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.5
@@ -166,14 +166,14 @@ Samba \f(CWbin/\fP directory (the same place that the \fBsmbd\fP
and \fBnmbd\fP binaries are installed) as follows:
.PP
-.DS
+.nf
cat old_smbpasswd_file | convert_smbpasswd > new_smbpasswd_file
-.DE
+.fi
.PP
@@ -198,7 +198,7 @@ algorithm\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -207,7 +207,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy
-Allison, \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+Allison, samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.8 b/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.8
index ad502e01b12..be70fad031d 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.8
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbpasswd.8
@@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ smbpasswd \- change a users SMB password
.PP
.SH "SYNOPSIS"
.PP
-\fBsmbpasswd\fP [-a] [-d] [-e] [-D debug level] [-n] [-r remote_machine] [-R name resolve order] [-m] [-j DOMAIN] [-U username] [-h] [-s] username
+\fBsmbpasswd\fP [-a] [-x] [-d] [-e] [-D debug level] [-n] [-r remote_machine] [-R name resolve order] [-m] [-j DOMAIN] [-U username] [-h] [-s] username
.PP
.SH "DESCRIPTION"
.PP
@@ -62,6 +62,13 @@ else the request to add the user will fail\&.
This option is only available when running \fBsmbpasswd\fP as
root\&.
.IP
+.IP "\fB-x\fP"
+This option specifies that the username following should
+be deleted from the local \fBsmbpasswd\fP file\&.
+.IP
+This option is only available when running \fBsmbpasswd\fP as
+root\&.
+.IP
.IP "\fB-d\fP"
This option specifies that the username following should be
\fIdisabled\fP in the local \fBsmbpasswd\fP file\&.
@@ -199,7 +206,7 @@ being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller\&. PDC support is not a
supported feature in Samba2\&.0 but will become supported in a later
release\&. If you wish to know more about using Samba as an NT PDC then
please subscribe to the mailing list
-\fIsamba-ntdom@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba-ntdom@samba\&.org\&.
.IP
This option is only available when running \fBsmbpasswd\fP as root\&.
.IP
@@ -285,7 +292,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.IP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.IP
@@ -294,7 +301,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.IP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbrun.1 b/docs/manpages/smbrun.1
index d34b408d6bd..24d6efdfcd9 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbrun.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbrun.1
@@ -53,7 +53,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbstatus.1 b/docs/manpages/smbstatus.1
index 7899344d7fb..ac7cba7149d 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbstatus.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbstatus.1
@@ -59,7 +59,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -68,7 +68,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/smbtar.1 b/docs/manpages/smbtar.1
index 2aaa542231e..f7979b76b1e 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/smbtar.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/smbtar.1
@@ -105,19 +105,19 @@ the \fBsmbclient\fP command\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
-Ricky Poulten \fIpoultenr@logica\&.co\&.uk\fP wrote the tar extension and
+Ricky Poulten poultenr@logica\&.co\&.uk wrote the tar extension and
this man page\&. The \fBsmbtar\fP script was heavily rewritten and
-improved by Martin Kraemer \fIMartin\&.Kraemer@mch\&.sni\&.de\fP\&. Many
+improved by Martin Kraemer Martin\&.Kraemer@mch\&.sni\&.de\&. Many
thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug fixes,
etc\&. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
excellent piece of Open Source software available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison,
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/swat.8 b/docs/manpages/swat.8
index 8798c0a566e..3fc450f3854 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/swat.8
+++ b/docs/manpages/swat.8
@@ -49,14 +49,14 @@ swat binary and the various help files and images\&. A default install
would put these in:
.PP
-.DS
+.nf
/usr/local/samba/bin/swat
/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*
/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*
-.DE
+.fi
.PP
@@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell (samba-bugs@samba\&.org)\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell (samba@samba\&.org)\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -146,7 +146,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/testparm.1 b/docs/manpages/testparm.1
index 2d4c03a1641..e02b8873943 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/testparm.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/testparm.1
@@ -88,7 +88,7 @@ This man page is correct for version 2\&.0 of the Samba suite\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -97,7 +97,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/testprns.1 b/docs/manpages/testprns.1
index bb366e329c3..a9753d7637c 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/testprns.1
+++ b/docs/manpages/testprns.1
@@ -71,7 +71,7 @@ Other messages are self-explanatory\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell \fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&. Samba is now developed
+Andrew Tridgell samba@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
Linux kernel is developed\&.
.PP
@@ -80,7 +80,7 @@ sources were converted to YODL format (another excellent piece of Open
Source software, available at
\fBftp://ftp\&.icce\&.rug\&.nl/pub/unix/\fP)
and updated for the Samba2\&.0 release by Jeremy Allison\&.
-\fIsamba-bugs@samba\&.org\fP\&.
+samba@samba\&.org\&.
.PP
See \fBsamba (7)\fP to find out how to get a full
list of contributors and details on how to submit bug reports,
diff --git a/docs/manpages/winbindd.8 b/docs/manpages/winbindd.8
index 0b0c8b4019f..e35fe0815b4 100644
--- a/docs/manpages/winbindd.8
+++ b/docs/manpages/winbindd.8
@@ -20,8 +20,10 @@ be configured throught the \f(CW/etc/nsswitch\&.conf\fP file\&. Users and group
are allocated as they are resolved to a range of user and group ids
specified by the administrator of the Samba system\&.
.PP
-The service provided by \fBwinbindd\fP is called `winbind\' and can be used to
-resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server\&.
+The service provided by \fBwinbindd\fP is called `winbind\' and can be
+used to resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server\&.
+The service can also provide authentication services via an associated
+PAM module\&.
.PP
The following nsswitch databases are implemented by the \fBwinbindd\fP
service:
@@ -43,9 +45,16 @@ For example, the following simple configuration in the
information from \f(CW/etc/passwd\fP and \f(CW/etc/group\fP and then from the
Windows NT server\&.
.PP
-\f(CWpasswd: files winbind\fP
-.PP
-\f(CWgroup: files winbind\fP
+
+.nf
+
+
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+
+.fi
+
+
.PP
.SH "OPTIONS"
.PP
@@ -91,6 +100,23 @@ should be specified in the [global] section of
\fBsmb\&.conf\fP\&.
.PP
.IP
+.IP "winbind separator"
+.IP
+The winbind separator option allows you to specify how NT domain names
+and user names are combined into unix user names when presented to
+users\&. By default winbind will use the traditional \e separator so
+that the unix user names look like DOMAIN\eusername\&. In some cases
+this separator character may cause problems as the \e character has
+special meaning in unix shells\&. In that case you can use the winbind
+separator option to specify an alternative sepataror character\&. Good
+alternatives may be / (although that conflicts with the unix directory
+separator) or a + character\&. The + character appears to be the best
+choice for 100% compatibility with existing unix utilities, but may be
+an aesthetically bad choice depending on your taste\&.
+.IP
+\fBExample:\fP
+\f(CW winbind separator = +\fP
+.IP
.IP "winbind uid"
.IP
The winbind uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
@@ -121,10 +147,17 @@ conflicts can occur otherwise\&.
.IP
This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
\fBwinbindd\fP daemon will cache user and group
-information before querying a Windows NT server again\&.
+information before querying a Windows NT server again\&. When a item in
+the cache is older than this time winbindd will ask the domain
+controller for the sequence number of the servers account database\&. If
+the sequence number has not changed then the cached item is marked as
+valid for a further "winbind cache time" seconds\&. Otherwise the item
+is fetched from the server\&. This means that as long as the account
+database is not actively changing winbindd will only have to send one
+sequence number query packet every "winbind cache time" seconds\&.
.IP
\fBDefault:\fP
-\f(CW winbind cache type = 15\fP
+\f(CW winbind cache time = 15\fP
.IP
.IP "template homedir"
.IP
@@ -141,14 +174,116 @@ is present it is substituted with the user\'s Windows NT user name\&.
.IP
When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
\fBwinbindd\fP daemon uses this parameter to fill in
-the home directory for that user\&. If the string \f(CW%D\fP is present it is
-substituted with the user\'s Windows NT domain name\&. If the string \f(CW%U\fP
-is present it is substituted with the user\'s Windows NT user name\&.
+the shell for that user\&.
.IP
\fBDefault:\fP
-\f(CW template homedir = /home/%D/%U\fP
+\f(CW template shell = /bin/false\fP
.IP
.PP
+.SH "EXAMPLE SETUP"
+.PP
+To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus authentication from
+a domain controller use something like the following setup\&. This was
+tested on a RedHat 6\&.2 Linux box\&.
+.PP
+In /etc/nsswitch\&.conf put the following:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+In /etc/pam\&.d/* replace the auth lines with something like this:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty\&.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin\&.so
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind\&.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb\&.so use_first_pass shadow nullok
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+Note in particular the use of the sufficient keyword and the
+use_first_pass keyword\&.
+.PP
+Now replace the account lines with this:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ account required /lib/security/pam_winbind\&.so
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+The next step is to join the domain\&. To do that use the samedit
+program like this:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ samedit -S \'*\' -W DOMAIN -UAdministrator
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+Then within samedit run the command:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ createuser MACHINE$ -j DOMAIN -L
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+This assumes your domain is called DOMAIN and your Samba workstation
+is called MACHINE\&.
+.PP
+Next copy libnss_winbind\&.so\&.2 to /lib and pam_winbind\&.so to
+/lib/security\&.
+.PP
+Finally, setup a smb\&.conf containing directives like the following:
+
+.nf
+
+
+ [global]
+ winbind separator = +
+ winbind cache time = 10
+ template shell = /bin/bash
+ template homedir = /home/%D/%U
+ winbind uid = 10000-20000
+ winbind gid = 10000-20000
+ workgroup = DOMAIN
+ security = domain
+ password server = *
+
+.fi
+
+
+.PP
+Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and group
+database is expanded to include your NT users and groups, and that you
+can login to your unix box as a domain user, using the DOMAIN+user
+syntax for the username\&. You may wish to use the commands "getent
+passwd" and "getent group" to confirm the correct operation of
+winbindd\&.
+.PP
+NOTE: nmbd must be running on the local machine for winbindd to work\&.
+.PP
.SH "FILES"
.PP
The following files are relevant to the operation of the \fBwinbindd\fP
@@ -192,8 +327,7 @@ Storage for cached user and group information\&.
.SH "AUTHOR"
.PP
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell samba-bugs@samba\&.org\&. Samba is now developed
-by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
-Linux kernel is developed\&.
+Andrew Tridgell\&. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open
+Source project\&.
.PP
Winbindd was written by Tim Potter\&.
diff --git a/docs/textdocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.txt b/docs/textdocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.txt
index 53fd6d94f94..d58a8bc0994 100644
--- a/docs/textdocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.txt
+++ b/docs/textdocs/DOMAIN_MEMBER.txt
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ TITLE INFORMATION: Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.0
AUTHOR INFORMATION: Jeremy Allison, Samba Team
DATE INFORMATION: 7th October 1999
-Contents
+Table of Contents
Joining an NT Domain with Samba 2.0
-----------------------------------
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ command
smbpasswd -j DOM -r DOMPDC
as we are joining the domain DOM and the PDC for that domain (the only
-machine that has write access to the domain SAM database). If this is
+machine that has write access to the domain SAM database) is DOMPDC. If this is
successful you will see the message:
smbpasswd: Joined domain DOM.
@@ -35,8 +35,8 @@ man page for more details.
This command goes through the machine account password change
protocol, then writes the new (random) machine account password for
-this Samba server into the a file in the same directory in which an
-smbpasswd file would be stored (normally :
+this Samba server into a file in the same directory in which an
+smbpasswd file would be stored - normally :
/usr/local/samba/private
diff --git a/docs/yodldocs/winbindd.8.yo b/docs/yodldocs/winbindd.8.yo
index 77e14ad5f44..ce32565755f 100644
--- a/docs/yodldocs/winbindd.8.yo
+++ b/docs/yodldocs/winbindd.8.yo
@@ -23,8 +23,10 @@ be configured throught the tt(/etc/nsswitch.conf) file. Users and groups
are allocated as they are resolved to a range of user and group ids
specified by the administrator of the Samba system.
-The service provided by bf(winbindd) is called `winbind' and can be used to
-resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server.
+The service provided by bf(winbindd) is called `winbind' and can be
+used to resolve user and group information from a Windows NT server.
+The service can also provide authentication services via an associated
+PAM module.
The following nsswitch databases are implemented by the bf(winbindd)
service:
@@ -48,9 +50,10 @@ tt(/etc/nsswitch.conf) file can be used to initially resolve user and group
information from tt(/etc/passwd) and tt(/etc/group) and then from the
Windows NT server.
-tt(passwd: files winbind)
-
-tt(group: files winbind)
+verb(
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+)
label(OPTIONS)
manpageoptions()
@@ -104,6 +107,23 @@ url(bf(smb.conf))(smb.conf.5.html).
startdit()
+dit(winbind separator)
+
+The winbind separator option allows you to specify how NT domain names
+and user names are combined into unix user names when presented to
+users. By default winbind will use the traditional \ separator so
+that the unix user names look like DOMAIN\username. In some cases
+this separator character may cause problems as the \ character has
+special meaning in unix shells. In that case you can use the winbind
+separator option to specify an alternative sepataror character. Good
+alternatives may be / (although that conflicts with the unix directory
+separator) or a + character. The + character appears to be the best
+choice for 100% compatibility with existing unix utilities, but may be
+an aesthetically bad choice depending on your taste.
+
+ bf(Example:)
+tt( winbind separator = +)
+
dit(winbind uid)
The winbind uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are
@@ -134,10 +154,17 @@ dit(winbind cache time)
This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
url(bf(winbindd))(winbindd.8.html) daemon will cache user and group
-information before querying a Windows NT server again.
+information before querying a Windows NT server again. When a item in
+the cache is older than this time winbindd will ask the domain
+controller for the sequence number of the servers account database. If
+the sequence number has not changed then the cached item is marked as
+valid for a further "winbind cache time" seconds. Otherwise the item
+is fetched from the server. This means that as long as the account
+database is not actively changing winbindd will only have to send one
+sequence number query packet every "winbind cache time" seconds.
bf(Default:)
-tt( winbind cache type = 15)
+tt( winbind cache time = 15)
dit(template homedir)
@@ -154,15 +181,83 @@ dit(template shell)
When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the
url(bf(winbindd))(winbindd.8.html) daemon uses this parameter to fill in
-the home directory for that user. If the string tt(%D) is present it is
-substituted with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string tt(%U)
-is present it is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.
+the shell for that user.
bf(Default:)
-tt( template homedir = /home/%D/%U)
+tt( template shell = /bin/false)
enddit()
+
+label(EXAMPLESETUP)
+manpagesection(EXAMPLE SETUP)
+
+To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus authentication from
+a domain controller use something like the following setup. This was
+tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box.
+
+In /etc/nsswitch.conf put the following:
+verb(
+ passwd: files winbind
+ group: files winbind
+)
+
+In /etc/pam.d/* replace the auth lines with something like this:
+verb(
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
+ auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok
+)
+
+Note in particular the use of the sufficient keyword and the
+use_first_pass keyword.
+
+Now replace the account lines with this:
+verb(
+ account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+)
+
+The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the samedit
+program like this:
+verb(
+ samedit -S '*' -W DOMAIN -UAdministrator
+)
+
+Then within samedit run the command:
+verb(
+ createuser MACHINE$ -j DOMAIN -L
+)
+
+This assumes your domain is called DOMAIN and your Samba workstation
+is called MACHINE.
+
+Next copy libnss_winbind.so.2 to /lib and pam_winbind.so to
+/lib/security.
+
+Finally, setup a smb.conf containing directives like the following:
+verb(
+ [global]
+ winbind separator = +
+ winbind cache time = 10
+ template shell = /bin/bash
+ template homedir = /home/%D/%U
+ winbind uid = 10000-20000
+ winbind gid = 10000-20000
+ workgroup = DOMAIN
+ security = domain
+ password server = *
+)
+
+Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and group
+database is expanded to include your NT users and groups, and that you
+can login to your unix box as a domain user, using the DOMAIN+user
+syntax for the username. You may wish to use the commands "getent
+passwd" and "getent group" to confirm the correct operation of
+winbindd.
+
+NOTE: nmbd must be running on the local machine for winbindd to work.
+
label(FILES)
manpagefiles()
@@ -211,8 +306,7 @@ label(AUTHOR)
manpageauthor()
The original Samba software and related utilities were created by
-Andrew Tridgell email(samba-bugs@samba.org). Samba is now developed
-by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
-Linux kernel is developed.
+Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open
+Source project.
Winbindd was written by Tim Potter.